 4a7a67339a
			
		
	
	4a7a67339a
	
	
	
		
			
			Add enum GdkModifierIntent which identifies use cases for modifier masks and GdkKeyMap::get_modifier_mask(). Add a default implementation which returns what is currently hardcoded all over GTK+, and an implementation in the quartz backend. Also add gtk_widget_get_modifier_mask() which simplifies things by doing widget->display->keymap->get_modifier_mask().
		
			
				
	
	
		
			14573 lines
		
	
	
		
			436 KiB
		
	
	
	
		
			C
		
	
	
	
	
	
			
		
		
	
	
			14573 lines
		
	
	
		
			436 KiB
		
	
	
	
		
			C
		
	
	
	
	
	
| /* GTK - The GIMP Toolkit
 | |
|  * Copyright (C) 1995-1997 Peter Mattis, Spencer Kimball and Josh MacDonald
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * This library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
 | |
|  * modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
 | |
|  * License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
 | |
|  * version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * This library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
 | |
|  * but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
 | |
|  * MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.	 See the GNU
 | |
|  * Lesser General Public License for more details.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
 | |
|  * License along with this library; if not, write to the
 | |
|  * Free Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330,
 | |
|  * Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.
 | |
|  */
 | |
| 
 | |
| /*
 | |
|  * Modified by the GTK+ Team and others 1997-2000.  See the AUTHORS
 | |
|  * file for a list of people on the GTK+ Team.  See the ChangeLog
 | |
|  * files for a list of changes.  These files are distributed with
 | |
|  * GTK+ at ftp://ftp.gtk.org/pub/gtk/.
 | |
|  */
 | |
| 
 | |
| #include "config.h"
 | |
| 
 | |
| #include <stdarg.h>
 | |
| #include <string.h>
 | |
| #include <locale.h>
 | |
| 
 | |
| #include <gobject/gvaluecollector.h>
 | |
| #include <gobject/gobjectnotifyqueue.c>
 | |
| #include <cairo-gobject.h>
 | |
| 
 | |
| #include "gtkcontainer.h"
 | |
| #include "gtkaccelmap.h"
 | |
| #include "gtkclipboard.h"
 | |
| #include "gtkiconfactory.h"
 | |
| #include "gtkintl.h"
 | |
| #include "gtkmainprivate.h"
 | |
| #include "gtkmarshalers.h"
 | |
| #include "gtkselectionprivate.h"
 | |
| #include "gtksettingsprivate.h"
 | |
| #include "gtksizegroup-private.h"
 | |
| #include "gtkwidget.h"
 | |
| #include "gtkwidgetprivate.h"
 | |
| #include "gtkwindowprivate.h"
 | |
| #include "gtkcontainerprivate.h"
 | |
| #include "gtkbindings.h"
 | |
| #include "gtkprivate.h"
 | |
| #include "gtkaccessible.h"
 | |
| #include "gtktooltip.h"
 | |
| #include "gtkinvisible.h"
 | |
| #include "gtkbuildable.h"
 | |
| #include "gtkbuilderprivate.h"
 | |
| #include "gtksizerequest.h"
 | |
| #include "gtkstylecontextprivate.h"
 | |
| #include "gtksymboliccolor.h"
 | |
| #include "gtkcssprovider.h"
 | |
| #include "gtkanimationdescription.h"
 | |
| #include "gtkmodifierstyle.h"
 | |
| #include "gtkversion.h"
 | |
| #include "gtkdebug.h"
 | |
| #include "gtkplug.h"
 | |
| #include "gtktypebuiltins.h"
 | |
| #include "a11y/gtkwidgetaccessible.h"
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * SECTION:gtkwidget
 | |
|  * @Short_description: Base class for all widgets
 | |
|  * @Title: GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * GtkWidget is the base class all widgets in GTK+ derive from. It manages the
 | |
|  * widget lifecycle, states and style.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * <refsect2 id="geometry-management">
 | |
|  * <title>Height-for-width Geometry Management</title>
 | |
|  * <para>
 | |
|  * GTK+ uses a height-for-width (and width-for-height) geometry management
 | |
|  * system. Height-for-width means that a widget can change how much
 | |
|  * vertical space it needs, depending on the amount of horizontal space
 | |
|  * that it is given (and similar for width-for-height). The most common
 | |
|  * example is a label that reflows to fill up the available width, wraps
 | |
|  * to fewer lines, and therefore needs less height.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Height-for-width geometry management is implemented in GTK+ by way
 | |
|  * of five virtual methods:
 | |
|  * <itemizedlist>
 | |
|  *   <listitem>#GtkWidgetClass.get_request_mode()</listitem>
 | |
|  *   <listitem>#GtkWidgetClass.get_preferred_width()</listitem>
 | |
|  *   <listitem>#GtkWidgetClass.get_preferred_height()</listitem>
 | |
|  *   <listitem>#GtkWidgetClass.get_preferred_height_for_width()</listitem>
 | |
|  *   <listitem>#GtkWidgetClass.get_preferred_width_for_height()</listitem>
 | |
|  * </itemizedlist>
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * There are some important things to keep in mind when implementing
 | |
|  * height-for-width and when using it in container implementations.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * The geometry management system will query a widget hierarchy in
 | |
|  * only one orientation at a time. When widgets are initially queried
 | |
|  * for their minimum sizes it is generally done in two initial passes
 | |
|  * in the #GtkSizeRequestMode chosen by the toplevel.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * For example, when queried in the normal
 | |
|  * %GTK_SIZE_REQUEST_HEIGHT_FOR_WIDTH mode:
 | |
|  * First, the default minimum and natural width for each widget
 | |
|  * in the interface will be computed using gtk_widget_get_preferred_width().
 | |
|  * Because the preferred widths for each container depend on the preferred
 | |
|  * widths of their children, this information propagates up the hierarchy,
 | |
|  * and finally a minimum and natural width is determined for the entire
 | |
|  * toplevel. Next, the toplevel will use the minimum width to query for the
 | |
|  * minimum height contextual to that width using
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_preferred_height_for_width(), which will also be a highly
 | |
|  * recursive operation. The minimum height for the minimum width is normally
 | |
|  * used to set the minimum size constraint on the toplevel
 | |
|  * (unless gtk_window_set_geometry_hints() is explicitly used instead).
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * After the toplevel window has initially requested its size in both
 | |
|  * dimensions it can go on to allocate itself a reasonable size (or a size
 | |
|  * previously specified with gtk_window_set_default_size()). During the
 | |
|  * recursive allocation process it's important to note that request cycles
 | |
|  * will be recursively executed while container widgets allocate their children.
 | |
|  * Each container widget, once allocated a size, will go on to first share the
 | |
|  * space in one orientation among its children and then request each child's
 | |
|  * height for its target allocated width or its width for allocated height,
 | |
|  * depending. In this way a #GtkWidget will typically be requested its size
 | |
|  * a number of times before actually being allocated a size. The size a
 | |
|  * widget is finally allocated can of course differ from the size it has
 | |
|  * requested. For this reason, #GtkWidget caches a  small number of results
 | |
|  * to avoid re-querying for the same sizes in one allocation cycle.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * See <link linkend="container-geometry-management">GtkContainer's
 | |
|  * geometry management section</link>
 | |
|  * to learn more about how height-for-width allocations are performed
 | |
|  * by container widgets.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * If a widget does move content around to intelligently use up the
 | |
|  * allocated size then it must support the request in both
 | |
|  * #GtkSizeRequestModes even if the widget in question only
 | |
|  * trades sizes in a single orientation.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * For instance, a #GtkLabel that does height-for-width word wrapping
 | |
|  * will not expect to have #GtkWidgetClass.get_preferred_height() called
 | |
|  * because that call is specific to a width-for-height request. In this
 | |
|  * case the label must return the height required for its own minimum
 | |
|  * possible width. By following this rule any widget that handles
 | |
|  * height-for-width or width-for-height requests will always be allocated
 | |
|  * at least enough space to fit its own content.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Here are some examples of how a %GTK_SIZE_REQUEST_HEIGHT_FOR_WIDTH widget
 | |
|  * generally deals with width-for-height requests, for #GtkWidgetClass.get_preferred_height()
 | |
|  * it will do:
 | |
|  * <programlisting><![CDATA[
 | |
|  * static void
 | |
|  * foo_widget_get_preferred_height (GtkWidget *widget, gint *min_height, gint *nat_height)
 | |
|  * {
 | |
|  *    if (i_am_in_height_for_width_mode)
 | |
|  *      {
 | |
|  *        gint min_width;
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  *        GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget)->get_preferred_width (widget, &min_width, NULL);
 | |
|  *        GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget)->get_preferred_height_for_width (widget, min_width,
 | |
|  *                                                                      min_height, nat_height);
 | |
|  *      }
 | |
|  *    else
 | |
|  *      {
 | |
|  *         ... some widgets do both. For instance, if a GtkLabel is rotated to 90 degrees
 | |
|  *         it will return the minimum and natural height for the rotated label here.
 | |
|  *      }
 | |
|  * }
 | |
|  * ]]></programlisting>
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * And in #GtkWidgetClass.get_preferred_width_for_height() it will simply return
 | |
|  * the minimum and natural width:
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * <programlisting><![CDATA[
 | |
|  * static void
 | |
|  * foo_widget_get_preferred_width_for_height (GtkWidget *widget, gint for_height,
 | |
|  *                                            gint *min_width, gint *nat_width)
 | |
|  * {
 | |
|  *    if (i_am_in_height_for_width_mode)
 | |
|  *      {
 | |
|  *        GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget)->get_preferred_width (widget, min_width, nat_width);
 | |
|  *      }
 | |
|  *    else
 | |
|  *      {
 | |
|  *         ... again if a widget is sometimes operating in width-for-height mode
 | |
|  *         (like a rotated GtkLabel) it can go ahead and do its real width for
 | |
|  *         height calculation here.
 | |
|  *      }
 | |
|  * }
 | |
|  * ]]></programlisting>
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Often a widget needs to get its own request during size request or
 | |
|  * allocation. For example, when computing height it may need to also
 | |
|  * compute width. Or when deciding how to use an allocation, the widget
 | |
|  * may need to know its natural size. In these cases, the widget should
 | |
|  * be careful to call its virtual methods directly, like this:
 | |
|  * <example>
 | |
|  *   <title>Widget calling its own size request method.</title>
 | |
|  *   <programlisting>
 | |
|  * GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS(widget)->get_preferred_width (widget),
 | |
|  *                                  &min, &natural);
 | |
|  *   </programlisting>
 | |
|  * </example>
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * It will not work to use the wrapper functions, such as
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_preferred_width() inside your own size request
 | |
|  * implementation. These return a request adjusted by #GtkSizeGroup
 | |
|  * and by the #GtkWidgetClass.adjust_size_request() virtual method. If a
 | |
|  * widget used the wrappers inside its virtual method implementations,
 | |
|  * then the adjustments (such as widget margins) would be applied
 | |
|  * twice. GTK+ therefore does not allow this and will warn if you try
 | |
|  * to do it.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Of course if you are getting the size request for
 | |
|  * <emphasis>another</emphasis> widget, such as a child of a
 | |
|  * container, you <emphasis>must</emphasis> use the wrapper APIs.
 | |
|  * Otherwise, you would not properly consider widget margins,
 | |
|  * #GtkSizeGroup, and so forth.
 | |
|  * </para>
 | |
|  * </refsect2>
 | |
|  * <refsect2 id="style-properties">
 | |
|  * <title>Style Properties</title>
 | |
|  * <para>
 | |
|  * <structname>GtkWidget</structname> introduces <firstterm>style
 | |
|  * properties</firstterm> - these are basically object properties that are stored
 | |
|  * not on the object, but in the style object associated to the widget. Style
 | |
|  * properties are set in <link linkend="gtk-Resource-Files">resource files</link>.
 | |
|  * This mechanism is used for configuring such things as the location of the
 | |
|  * scrollbar arrows through the theme, giving theme authors more control over the
 | |
|  * look of applications without the need to write a theme engine in C.
 | |
|  * </para>
 | |
|  * <para>
 | |
|  * Use gtk_widget_class_install_style_property() to install style properties for
 | |
|  * a widget class, gtk_widget_class_find_style_property() or
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_class_list_style_properties() to get information about existing
 | |
|  * style properties and gtk_widget_style_get_property(), gtk_widget_style_get() or
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_style_get_valist() to obtain the value of a style property.
 | |
|  * </para>
 | |
|  * </refsect2>
 | |
|  * <refsect2 id="GtkWidget-BUILDER-UI">
 | |
|  * <title>GtkWidget as GtkBuildable</title>
 | |
|  * <para>
 | |
|  * The GtkWidget implementation of the GtkBuildable interface supports a
 | |
|  * custom <accelerator> element, which has attributes named key,
 | |
|  * modifiers and signal and allows to specify accelerators.
 | |
|  * </para>
 | |
|  * <example>
 | |
|  * <title>A UI definition fragment specifying an accelerator</title>
 | |
|  * <programlisting><![CDATA[
 | |
|  * <object class="GtkButton">
 | |
|  *   <accelerator key="q" modifiers="GDK_CONTROL_MASK" signal="clicked"/>
 | |
|  * </object>
 | |
|  * ]]></programlisting>
 | |
|  * </example>
 | |
|  * <para>
 | |
|  * In addition to accelerators, <structname>GtkWidget</structname> also support a
 | |
|  * custom <accessible> element, which supports actions and relations.
 | |
|  * Properties on the accessible implementation of an object can be set by accessing the
 | |
|  * internal child "accessible" of a <structname>GtkWidget</structname>.
 | |
|  * </para>
 | |
|  * <example>
 | |
|  * <title>A UI definition fragment specifying an accessible</title>
 | |
|  * <programlisting><![CDATA[
 | |
|  * <object class="GtkButton" id="label1"/>
 | |
|  *   <property name="label">I am a Label for a Button</property>
 | |
|  * </object>
 | |
|  * <object class="GtkButton" id="button1">
 | |
|  *   <accessibility>
 | |
|  *     <action action_name="click" translatable="yes">Click the button.</action>
 | |
|  *     <relation target="label1" type="labelled-by"/>
 | |
|  *   </accessibility>
 | |
|  *   <child internal-child="accessible">
 | |
|  *     <object class="AtkObject" id="a11y-button1">
 | |
|  *       <property name="AtkObject::name">Clickable Button</property>
 | |
|  *     </object>
 | |
|  *   </child>
 | |
|  * </object>
 | |
|  * ]]></programlisting>
 | |
|  * </example>
 | |
|  * <para>
 | |
|  * Finally, GtkWidget allows style information such as style classes to
 | |
|  * be associated with widgets, using the custom <style> element:
 | |
|  * <example>
 | |
|  * <title>A UI definition fragment specifying an style class</title>
 | |
|  * <programlisting><![CDATA[
 | |
|  * <object class="GtkButton" id="button1">
 | |
|  *   <style>
 | |
|  *     <class name="my-special-button-class"/>
 | |
|  *     <class name="dark-button"/>
 | |
|  *   </style>
 | |
|  * </object>
 | |
|  * ]]></programlisting>
 | |
|  * </example>
 | |
|  * </para>
 | |
|  * </refsect2>
 | |
|  */
 | |
| 
 | |
| /* Add flags here that should not be propagated to children. By default,
 | |
|  * all flags will be set on children (think prelight or active), but we
 | |
|  * might want to not do this for some.
 | |
|  */
 | |
| #define GTK_STATE_FLAGS_DONT_PROPAGATE (GTK_STATE_FLAG_FOCUSED)
 | |
| #define GTK_STATE_FLAGS_DO_PROPAGATE (~GTK_STATE_FLAGS_DONT_PROPAGATE)
 | |
| 
 | |
| #define WIDGET_CLASS(w)	 GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (w)
 | |
| #define	INIT_PATH_SIZE	(512)
 | |
| 
 | |
| struct _GtkWidgetPrivate
 | |
| {
 | |
|   /* The state of the widget. There are actually only
 | |
|    * 5 widget states (defined in "gtkenums.h")
 | |
|    * so 3 bits.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   guint state_flags : 6;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   guint direction             : 2;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   guint in_destruction        : 1;
 | |
|   guint toplevel              : 1;
 | |
|   guint anchored              : 1;
 | |
|   guint composite_child       : 1;
 | |
|   guint no_window             : 1;
 | |
|   guint realized              : 1;
 | |
|   guint mapped                : 1;
 | |
|   guint visible               : 1;
 | |
|   guint sensitive             : 1;
 | |
|   guint can_focus             : 1;
 | |
|   guint has_focus             : 1;
 | |
|   guint can_default           : 1;
 | |
|   guint has_default           : 1;
 | |
|   guint receives_default      : 1;
 | |
|   guint has_grab              : 1;
 | |
|   guint shadowed              : 1;
 | |
|   guint rc_style              : 1;
 | |
|   guint style_update_pending  : 1;
 | |
|   guint app_paintable         : 1;
 | |
|   guint double_buffered       : 1;
 | |
|   guint redraw_on_alloc       : 1;
 | |
|   guint no_show_all           : 1;
 | |
|   guint child_visible         : 1;
 | |
|   guint multidevice           : 1;
 | |
|   guint has_shape_mask        : 1;
 | |
|   guint in_reparent           : 1;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /* Queue-resize related flags */
 | |
|   guint resize_pending        : 1;
 | |
|   guint alloc_needed          : 1;
 | |
|   guint width_request_needed  : 1;
 | |
|   guint height_request_needed : 1;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /* Expand-related flags */
 | |
|   guint need_compute_expand   : 1; /* Need to recompute computed_[hv]_expand */
 | |
|   guint computed_hexpand      : 1; /* computed results (composite of child flags) */
 | |
|   guint computed_vexpand      : 1;
 | |
|   guint hexpand               : 1; /* application-forced expand */
 | |
|   guint vexpand               : 1;
 | |
|   guint hexpand_set           : 1; /* whether to use application-forced  */
 | |
|   guint vexpand_set           : 1; /* instead of computing from children */
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /* SizeGroup related flags */
 | |
|   guint sizegroup_visited     : 1;
 | |
|   guint sizegroup_bumping     : 1;
 | |
|   guint have_size_groups      : 1;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /* The widget's name. If the widget does not have a name
 | |
|    * (the name is NULL), then its name (as returned by
 | |
|    * "gtk_widget_get_name") is its class's name.
 | |
|    * Among other things, the widget name is used to determine
 | |
|    * the style to use for a widget.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   gchar *name;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /* The style for the widget. The style contains the
 | |
|    * colors the widget should be drawn in for each state
 | |
|    * along with graphics contexts used to draw with and
 | |
|    * the font to use for text.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   GtkStyle *style;
 | |
|   GtkStyleContext *context;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /* Widget's path for styling */
 | |
|   GtkWidgetPath *path;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /* The widget's allocated size */
 | |
|   GtkAllocation allocation;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /* The widget's requested sizes */
 | |
|   SizeRequestCache requests;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /* The widget's window or its parent window if it does
 | |
|    * not have a window. (Which will be indicated by the
 | |
|    * GTK_NO_WINDOW flag being set).
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   GdkWindow *window;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /* The widget's parent */
 | |
|   GtkWidget *parent;
 | |
| 
 | |
| #ifdef G_ENABLE_DEBUG
 | |
|   /* Number of gtk_widget_push_verify_invariants () */
 | |
|   guint verifying_invariants_count;
 | |
| #endif /* G_ENABLE_DEBUG */
 | |
| };
 | |
| 
 | |
| struct _GtkWidgetClassPrivate
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GType accessible_type;
 | |
|   AtkRole accessible_role;
 | |
| };
 | |
| 
 | |
| enum {
 | |
|   DESTROY,
 | |
|   SHOW,
 | |
|   HIDE,
 | |
|   MAP,
 | |
|   UNMAP,
 | |
|   REALIZE,
 | |
|   UNREALIZE,
 | |
|   SIZE_ALLOCATE,
 | |
|   STATE_FLAGS_CHANGED,
 | |
|   STATE_CHANGED,
 | |
|   PARENT_SET,
 | |
|   HIERARCHY_CHANGED,
 | |
|   STYLE_SET,
 | |
|   DIRECTION_CHANGED,
 | |
|   GRAB_NOTIFY,
 | |
|   CHILD_NOTIFY,
 | |
|   DRAW,
 | |
|   MNEMONIC_ACTIVATE,
 | |
|   GRAB_FOCUS,
 | |
|   FOCUS,
 | |
|   MOVE_FOCUS,
 | |
|   KEYNAV_FAILED,
 | |
|   EVENT,
 | |
|   EVENT_AFTER,
 | |
|   BUTTON_PRESS_EVENT,
 | |
|   BUTTON_RELEASE_EVENT,
 | |
|   SCROLL_EVENT,
 | |
|   MOTION_NOTIFY_EVENT,
 | |
|   DELETE_EVENT,
 | |
|   DESTROY_EVENT,
 | |
|   KEY_PRESS_EVENT,
 | |
|   KEY_RELEASE_EVENT,
 | |
|   ENTER_NOTIFY_EVENT,
 | |
|   LEAVE_NOTIFY_EVENT,
 | |
|   CONFIGURE_EVENT,
 | |
|   FOCUS_IN_EVENT,
 | |
|   FOCUS_OUT_EVENT,
 | |
|   MAP_EVENT,
 | |
|   UNMAP_EVENT,
 | |
|   PROPERTY_NOTIFY_EVENT,
 | |
|   SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT,
 | |
|   SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT,
 | |
|   SELECTION_NOTIFY_EVENT,
 | |
|   SELECTION_GET,
 | |
|   SELECTION_RECEIVED,
 | |
|   PROXIMITY_IN_EVENT,
 | |
|   PROXIMITY_OUT_EVENT,
 | |
|   VISIBILITY_NOTIFY_EVENT,
 | |
|   WINDOW_STATE_EVENT,
 | |
|   DAMAGE_EVENT,
 | |
|   GRAB_BROKEN_EVENT,
 | |
|   DRAG_BEGIN,
 | |
|   DRAG_END,
 | |
|   DRAG_DATA_DELETE,
 | |
|   DRAG_LEAVE,
 | |
|   DRAG_MOTION,
 | |
|   DRAG_DROP,
 | |
|   DRAG_DATA_GET,
 | |
|   DRAG_DATA_RECEIVED,
 | |
|   POPUP_MENU,
 | |
|   SHOW_HELP,
 | |
|   ACCEL_CLOSURES_CHANGED,
 | |
|   SCREEN_CHANGED,
 | |
|   CAN_ACTIVATE_ACCEL,
 | |
|   COMPOSITED_CHANGED,
 | |
|   QUERY_TOOLTIP,
 | |
|   DRAG_FAILED,
 | |
|   STYLE_UPDATED,
 | |
|   LAST_SIGNAL
 | |
| };
 | |
| 
 | |
| enum {
 | |
|   PROP_0,
 | |
|   PROP_NAME,
 | |
|   PROP_PARENT,
 | |
|   PROP_WIDTH_REQUEST,
 | |
|   PROP_HEIGHT_REQUEST,
 | |
|   PROP_VISIBLE,
 | |
|   PROP_SENSITIVE,
 | |
|   PROP_APP_PAINTABLE,
 | |
|   PROP_CAN_FOCUS,
 | |
|   PROP_HAS_FOCUS,
 | |
|   PROP_IS_FOCUS,
 | |
|   PROP_CAN_DEFAULT,
 | |
|   PROP_HAS_DEFAULT,
 | |
|   PROP_RECEIVES_DEFAULT,
 | |
|   PROP_COMPOSITE_CHILD,
 | |
|   PROP_STYLE,
 | |
|   PROP_EVENTS,
 | |
|   PROP_NO_SHOW_ALL,
 | |
|   PROP_HAS_TOOLTIP,
 | |
|   PROP_TOOLTIP_MARKUP,
 | |
|   PROP_TOOLTIP_TEXT,
 | |
|   PROP_WINDOW,
 | |
|   PROP_DOUBLE_BUFFERED,
 | |
|   PROP_HALIGN,
 | |
|   PROP_VALIGN,
 | |
|   PROP_MARGIN_LEFT,
 | |
|   PROP_MARGIN_RIGHT,
 | |
|   PROP_MARGIN_TOP,
 | |
|   PROP_MARGIN_BOTTOM,
 | |
|   PROP_MARGIN,
 | |
|   PROP_HEXPAND,
 | |
|   PROP_VEXPAND,
 | |
|   PROP_HEXPAND_SET,
 | |
|   PROP_VEXPAND_SET,
 | |
|   PROP_EXPAND
 | |
| };
 | |
| 
 | |
| typedef	struct	_GtkStateData	 GtkStateData;
 | |
| 
 | |
| enum {
 | |
|   STATE_CHANGE_REPLACE,
 | |
|   STATE_CHANGE_SET,
 | |
|   STATE_CHANGE_UNSET
 | |
| };
 | |
| 
 | |
| struct _GtkStateData
 | |
| {
 | |
|   guint         flags : 6;
 | |
|   guint         operation : 2;
 | |
|   guint		use_forall : 1;
 | |
| };
 | |
| 
 | |
| /* --- prototypes --- */
 | |
| static void	gtk_widget_base_class_init	(gpointer            g_class);
 | |
| static void	gtk_widget_class_init		(GtkWidgetClass     *klass);
 | |
| static void	gtk_widget_base_class_finalize	(GtkWidgetClass     *klass);
 | |
| static void	gtk_widget_init			(GtkWidget          *widget);
 | |
| static void	gtk_widget_set_property		 (GObject           *object,
 | |
| 						  guint              prop_id,
 | |
| 						  const GValue      *value,
 | |
| 						  GParamSpec        *pspec);
 | |
| static void	gtk_widget_get_property		 (GObject           *object,
 | |
| 						  guint              prop_id,
 | |
| 						  GValue            *value,
 | |
| 						  GParamSpec        *pspec);
 | |
| static void	gtk_widget_dispose		 (GObject	    *object);
 | |
| static void	gtk_widget_real_destroy		 (GtkWidget	    *object);
 | |
| static void	gtk_widget_finalize		 (GObject	    *object);
 | |
| static void	gtk_widget_real_show		 (GtkWidget	    *widget);
 | |
| static void	gtk_widget_real_hide		 (GtkWidget	    *widget);
 | |
| static void	gtk_widget_real_map		 (GtkWidget	    *widget);
 | |
| static void	gtk_widget_real_unmap		 (GtkWidget	    *widget);
 | |
| static void	gtk_widget_real_realize		 (GtkWidget	    *widget);
 | |
| static void	gtk_widget_real_unrealize	 (GtkWidget	    *widget);
 | |
| static void	gtk_widget_real_size_allocate	 (GtkWidget	    *widget,
 | |
|                                                   GtkAllocation	    *allocation);
 | |
| static void	gtk_widget_real_style_set        (GtkWidget         *widget,
 | |
|                                                   GtkStyle          *previous_style);
 | |
| static void	gtk_widget_real_direction_changed(GtkWidget         *widget,
 | |
|                                                   GtkTextDirection   previous_direction);
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void	gtk_widget_real_grab_focus	 (GtkWidget         *focus_widget);
 | |
| static gboolean gtk_widget_real_query_tooltip    (GtkWidget         *widget,
 | |
| 						  gint               x,
 | |
| 						  gint               y,
 | |
| 						  gboolean           keyboard_tip,
 | |
| 						  GtkTooltip        *tooltip);
 | |
| static void     gtk_widget_real_style_updated    (GtkWidget         *widget);
 | |
| static gboolean gtk_widget_real_show_help        (GtkWidget         *widget,
 | |
|                                                   GtkWidgetHelpType  help_type);
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void	gtk_widget_dispatch_child_properties_changed	(GtkWidget        *object,
 | |
| 								 guint             n_pspecs,
 | |
| 								 GParamSpec      **pspecs);
 | |
| static gboolean		gtk_widget_real_key_press_event   	(GtkWidget        *widget,
 | |
| 								 GdkEventKey      *event);
 | |
| static gboolean		gtk_widget_real_key_release_event 	(GtkWidget        *widget,
 | |
| 								 GdkEventKey      *event);
 | |
| static gboolean		gtk_widget_real_focus_in_event   	 (GtkWidget       *widget,
 | |
| 								  GdkEventFocus   *event);
 | |
| static gboolean		gtk_widget_real_focus_out_event   	(GtkWidget        *widget,
 | |
| 								 GdkEventFocus    *event);
 | |
| static gboolean		gtk_widget_real_focus			(GtkWidget        *widget,
 | |
| 								 GtkDirectionType  direction);
 | |
| static void             gtk_widget_real_move_focus              (GtkWidget        *widget,
 | |
|                                                                  GtkDirectionType  direction);
 | |
| static gboolean		gtk_widget_real_keynav_failed		(GtkWidget        *widget,
 | |
| 								 GtkDirectionType  direction);
 | |
| #ifdef G_ENABLE_DEBUG
 | |
| static void             gtk_widget_verify_invariants            (GtkWidget        *widget);
 | |
| static void             gtk_widget_push_verify_invariants       (GtkWidget        *widget);
 | |
| static void             gtk_widget_pop_verify_invariants        (GtkWidget        *widget);
 | |
| #else
 | |
| #define                 gtk_widget_verify_invariants(widget)
 | |
| #define                 gtk_widget_push_verify_invariants(widget)
 | |
| #define                 gtk_widget_pop_verify_invariants(widget)
 | |
| #endif
 | |
| static PangoContext*	gtk_widget_peek_pango_context		(GtkWidget	  *widget);
 | |
| static void     	gtk_widget_update_pango_context		(GtkWidget	  *widget);
 | |
| static void		gtk_widget_propagate_state		(GtkWidget	  *widget,
 | |
| 								 GtkStateData 	  *data);
 | |
| ;
 | |
| static gint		gtk_widget_event_internal		(GtkWidget	  *widget,
 | |
| 								 GdkEvent	  *event);
 | |
| static gboolean		gtk_widget_real_mnemonic_activate	(GtkWidget	  *widget,
 | |
| 								 gboolean	   group_cycling);
 | |
| static void             gtk_widget_real_get_width               (GtkWidget        *widget,
 | |
|                                                                  gint             *minimum_size,
 | |
|                                                                  gint             *natural_size);
 | |
| static void             gtk_widget_real_get_height              (GtkWidget        *widget,
 | |
|                                                                  gint             *minimum_size,
 | |
|                                                                  gint             *natural_size);
 | |
| static void             gtk_widget_real_get_height_for_width    (GtkWidget        *widget,
 | |
|                                                                  gint              width,
 | |
|                                                                  gint             *minimum_height,
 | |
|                                                                  gint             *natural_height);
 | |
| static void             gtk_widget_real_get_width_for_height    (GtkWidget        *widget,
 | |
|                                                                  gint              height,
 | |
|                                                                  gint             *minimum_width,
 | |
|                                                                  gint             *natural_width);
 | |
| static const GtkWidgetAuxInfo* _gtk_widget_get_aux_info_or_defaults (GtkWidget *widget);
 | |
| static GtkWidgetAuxInfo* gtk_widget_get_aux_info                (GtkWidget        *widget,
 | |
|                                                                  gboolean          create);
 | |
| static void		gtk_widget_aux_info_destroy		(GtkWidgetAuxInfo *aux_info);
 | |
| static AtkObject*	gtk_widget_real_get_accessible		(GtkWidget	  *widget);
 | |
| static void		gtk_widget_accessible_interface_init	(AtkImplementorIface *iface);
 | |
| static AtkObject*	gtk_widget_ref_accessible		(AtkImplementor *implementor);
 | |
| static void             gtk_widget_invalidate_widget_windows    (GtkWidget        *widget,
 | |
| 								 cairo_region_t        *region);
 | |
| static GdkScreen *      gtk_widget_get_screen_unchecked         (GtkWidget        *widget);
 | |
| static void		gtk_widget_queue_shallow_draw		(GtkWidget        *widget);
 | |
| static gboolean         gtk_widget_real_can_activate_accel      (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                                                                  guint      signal_id);
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void             gtk_widget_real_set_has_tooltip         (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
| 								 gboolean   has_tooltip,
 | |
| 								 gboolean   force);
 | |
| static void             gtk_widget_buildable_interface_init     (GtkBuildableIface *iface);
 | |
| static void             gtk_widget_buildable_set_name           (GtkBuildable     *buildable,
 | |
|                                                                  const gchar      *name);
 | |
| static const gchar *    gtk_widget_buildable_get_name           (GtkBuildable     *buildable);
 | |
| static GObject *        gtk_widget_buildable_get_internal_child (GtkBuildable *buildable,
 | |
| 								 GtkBuilder   *builder,
 | |
| 								 const gchar  *childname);
 | |
| static void             gtk_widget_buildable_set_buildable_property (GtkBuildable     *buildable,
 | |
| 								     GtkBuilder       *builder,
 | |
| 								     const gchar      *name,
 | |
| 								     const GValue     *value);
 | |
| static gboolean         gtk_widget_buildable_custom_tag_start   (GtkBuildable     *buildable,
 | |
|                                                                  GtkBuilder       *builder,
 | |
|                                                                  GObject          *child,
 | |
|                                                                  const gchar      *tagname,
 | |
|                                                                  GMarkupParser    *parser,
 | |
|                                                                  gpointer         *data);
 | |
| static void             gtk_widget_buildable_custom_finished    (GtkBuildable     *buildable,
 | |
|                                                                  GtkBuilder       *builder,
 | |
|                                                                  GObject          *child,
 | |
|                                                                  const gchar      *tagname,
 | |
|                                                                  gpointer          data);
 | |
| static void             gtk_widget_buildable_parser_finished    (GtkBuildable     *buildable,
 | |
|                                                                  GtkBuilder       *builder);
 | |
| 
 | |
| static GtkSizeRequestMode gtk_widget_real_get_request_mode      (GtkWidget         *widget);
 | |
| static void             gtk_widget_real_get_width               (GtkWidget         *widget,
 | |
|                                                                  gint              *minimum_size,
 | |
|                                                                  gint              *natural_size);
 | |
| static void             gtk_widget_real_get_height              (GtkWidget         *widget,
 | |
|                                                                  gint              *minimum_size,
 | |
|                                                                  gint              *natural_size);
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void             gtk_widget_queue_tooltip_query          (GtkWidget *widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void             gtk_widget_real_adjust_size_request     (GtkWidget         *widget,
 | |
|                                                                  GtkOrientation     orientation,
 | |
|                                                                  gint              *minimum_size,
 | |
|                                                                  gint              *natural_size);
 | |
| static void             gtk_widget_real_adjust_size_allocation  (GtkWidget         *widget,
 | |
|                                                                  GtkOrientation     orientation,
 | |
|                                                                  gint              *minimum_size,
 | |
|                                                                  gint              *natural_size,
 | |
|                                                                  gint              *allocated_pos,
 | |
|                                                                  gint              *allocated_size);
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void gtk_widget_set_usize_internal (GtkWidget          *widget,
 | |
| 					   gint                width,
 | |
| 					   gint                height,
 | |
| 					   GtkQueueResizeFlags flags);
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void gtk_widget_add_events_internal (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                                             GdkDevice *device,
 | |
|                                             gint       events);
 | |
| static void gtk_widget_set_device_enabled_internal (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                                                     GdkDevice *device,
 | |
|                                                     gboolean   recurse,
 | |
|                                                     gboolean   enabled);
 | |
| 
 | |
| /* --- variables --- */
 | |
| static gpointer         gtk_widget_parent_class = NULL;
 | |
| static guint            widget_signals[LAST_SIGNAL] = { 0 };
 | |
| static GtkStyle        *gtk_default_style = NULL;
 | |
| static guint            composite_child_stack = 0;
 | |
| static GtkTextDirection gtk_default_direction = GTK_TEXT_DIR_LTR;
 | |
| static GParamSpecPool  *style_property_spec_pool = NULL;
 | |
| 
 | |
| static GQuark		quark_property_parser = 0;
 | |
| static GQuark		quark_aux_info = 0;
 | |
| static GQuark		quark_accel_path = 0;
 | |
| static GQuark		quark_accel_closures = 0;
 | |
| static GQuark		quark_event_mask = 0;
 | |
| static GQuark           quark_device_event_mask = 0;
 | |
| static GQuark		quark_parent_window = 0;
 | |
| static GQuark		quark_pointer_window = 0;
 | |
| static GQuark		quark_shape_info = 0;
 | |
| static GQuark		quark_input_shape_info = 0;
 | |
| static GQuark		quark_pango_context = 0;
 | |
| static GQuark		quark_rc_style = 0;
 | |
| static GQuark		quark_accessible_object = 0;
 | |
| static GQuark		quark_mnemonic_labels = 0;
 | |
| static GQuark		quark_tooltip_markup = 0;
 | |
| static GQuark		quark_has_tooltip = 0;
 | |
| static GQuark		quark_tooltip_window = 0;
 | |
| static GQuark		quark_visual = 0;
 | |
| static GQuark           quark_modifier_style = 0;
 | |
| static GQuark           quark_enabled_devices = 0;
 | |
| static GQuark           quark_size_groups = 0;
 | |
| GParamSpecPool         *_gtk_widget_child_property_pool = NULL;
 | |
| GObjectNotifyContext   *_gtk_widget_child_property_notify_context = NULL;
 | |
| 
 | |
| /* --- functions --- */
 | |
| GType
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_type (void)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   static GType widget_type = 0;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (G_UNLIKELY (widget_type == 0))
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       const GTypeInfo widget_info =
 | |
|       {
 | |
| 	sizeof (GtkWidgetClass),
 | |
| 	gtk_widget_base_class_init,
 | |
| 	(GBaseFinalizeFunc) gtk_widget_base_class_finalize,
 | |
| 	(GClassInitFunc) gtk_widget_class_init,
 | |
| 	NULL,		/* class_finalize */
 | |
| 	NULL,		/* class_init */
 | |
| 	sizeof (GtkWidget),
 | |
| 	0,		/* n_preallocs */
 | |
| 	(GInstanceInitFunc) gtk_widget_init,
 | |
| 	NULL,		/* value_table */
 | |
|       };
 | |
| 
 | |
|       const GInterfaceInfo accessibility_info =
 | |
|       {
 | |
| 	(GInterfaceInitFunc) gtk_widget_accessible_interface_init,
 | |
| 	(GInterfaceFinalizeFunc) NULL,
 | |
| 	NULL /* interface data */
 | |
|       };
 | |
| 
 | |
|       const GInterfaceInfo buildable_info =
 | |
|       {
 | |
| 	(GInterfaceInitFunc) gtk_widget_buildable_interface_init,
 | |
| 	(GInterfaceFinalizeFunc) NULL,
 | |
| 	NULL /* interface data */
 | |
|       };
 | |
| 
 | |
|       widget_type = g_type_register_static (G_TYPE_INITIALLY_UNOWNED, "GtkWidget",
 | |
|                                             &widget_info, G_TYPE_FLAG_ABSTRACT);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       g_type_add_class_private (widget_type, sizeof (GtkWidgetClassPrivate));
 | |
| 
 | |
|       g_type_add_interface_static (widget_type, ATK_TYPE_IMPLEMENTOR,
 | |
|                                    &accessibility_info) ;
 | |
|       g_type_add_interface_static (widget_type, GTK_TYPE_BUILDABLE,
 | |
|                                    &buildable_info) ;
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return widget_type;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_base_class_init (gpointer g_class)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetClass *klass = g_class;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   klass->priv = G_TYPE_CLASS_GET_PRIVATE (g_class, GTK_TYPE_WIDGET, GtkWidgetClassPrivate);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| child_property_notify_dispatcher (GObject     *object,
 | |
| 				  guint        n_pspecs,
 | |
| 				  GParamSpec **pspecs)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (object)->dispatch_child_properties_changed (GTK_WIDGET (object), n_pspecs, pspecs);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /* We guard against the draw signal callbacks modifying the state of the
 | |
|  * cairo context by surounding it with save/restore.
 | |
|  * Maybe we should also cairo_new_path() just to be sure?
 | |
|  */
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_draw_marshaller (GClosure     *closure,
 | |
|                             GValue       *return_value,
 | |
|                             guint         n_param_values,
 | |
|                             const GValue *param_values,
 | |
|                             gpointer      invocation_hint,
 | |
|                             gpointer      marshal_data)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   cairo_t *cr = g_value_get_boxed (¶m_values[1]);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   cairo_save (cr);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOXED (closure,
 | |
|                                return_value,
 | |
|                                n_param_values,
 | |
|                                param_values,
 | |
|                                invocation_hint,
 | |
|                                marshal_data);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   cairo_restore (cr);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_class_init (GtkWidgetClass *klass)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   static GObjectNotifyContext cpn_context = { 0, NULL, NULL };
 | |
|   GObjectClass *gobject_class = G_OBJECT_CLASS (klass);
 | |
|   GtkBindingSet *binding_set;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gtk_widget_parent_class = g_type_class_peek_parent (klass);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   quark_property_parser = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-rc-property-parser");
 | |
|   quark_aux_info = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-aux-info");
 | |
|   quark_accel_path = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-accel-path");
 | |
|   quark_accel_closures = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-accel-closures");
 | |
|   quark_event_mask = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-event-mask");
 | |
|   quark_device_event_mask = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-device-event-mask");
 | |
|   quark_parent_window = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-parent-window");
 | |
|   quark_pointer_window = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-pointer-window");
 | |
|   quark_shape_info = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-shape-info");
 | |
|   quark_input_shape_info = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-input-shape-info");
 | |
|   quark_pango_context = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-pango-context");
 | |
|   quark_rc_style = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-rc-style");
 | |
|   quark_accessible_object = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-accessible-object");
 | |
|   quark_mnemonic_labels = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-mnemonic-labels");
 | |
|   quark_tooltip_markup = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-tooltip-markup");
 | |
|   quark_has_tooltip = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-has-tooltip");
 | |
|   quark_tooltip_window = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-tooltip-window");
 | |
|   quark_visual = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-widget-visual");
 | |
|   quark_modifier_style = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-widget-modifier-style");
 | |
|   quark_enabled_devices = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-widget-enabled-devices");
 | |
|   quark_size_groups = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-widget-size-groups");
 | |
| 
 | |
|   style_property_spec_pool = g_param_spec_pool_new (FALSE);
 | |
|   _gtk_widget_child_property_pool = g_param_spec_pool_new (TRUE);
 | |
|   cpn_context.quark_notify_queue = g_quark_from_static_string ("GtkWidget-child-property-notify-queue");
 | |
|   cpn_context.dispatcher = child_property_notify_dispatcher;
 | |
|   _gtk_widget_child_property_notify_context = &cpn_context;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gobject_class->dispose = gtk_widget_dispose;
 | |
|   gobject_class->finalize = gtk_widget_finalize;
 | |
|   gobject_class->set_property = gtk_widget_set_property;
 | |
|   gobject_class->get_property = gtk_widget_get_property;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   klass->destroy = gtk_widget_real_destroy;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   klass->activate_signal = 0;
 | |
|   klass->dispatch_child_properties_changed = gtk_widget_dispatch_child_properties_changed;
 | |
|   klass->show = gtk_widget_real_show;
 | |
|   klass->show_all = gtk_widget_show;
 | |
|   klass->hide = gtk_widget_real_hide;
 | |
|   klass->map = gtk_widget_real_map;
 | |
|   klass->unmap = gtk_widget_real_unmap;
 | |
|   klass->realize = gtk_widget_real_realize;
 | |
|   klass->unrealize = gtk_widget_real_unrealize;
 | |
|   klass->size_allocate = gtk_widget_real_size_allocate;
 | |
|   klass->get_request_mode = gtk_widget_real_get_request_mode;
 | |
|   klass->get_preferred_width = gtk_widget_real_get_width;
 | |
|   klass->get_preferred_height = gtk_widget_real_get_height;
 | |
|   klass->get_preferred_width_for_height = gtk_widget_real_get_width_for_height;
 | |
|   klass->get_preferred_height_for_width = gtk_widget_real_get_height_for_width;
 | |
|   klass->state_changed = NULL;
 | |
|   klass->parent_set = NULL;
 | |
|   klass->hierarchy_changed = NULL;
 | |
|   klass->style_set = gtk_widget_real_style_set;
 | |
|   klass->direction_changed = gtk_widget_real_direction_changed;
 | |
|   klass->grab_notify = NULL;
 | |
|   klass->child_notify = NULL;
 | |
|   klass->draw = NULL;
 | |
|   klass->mnemonic_activate = gtk_widget_real_mnemonic_activate;
 | |
|   klass->grab_focus = gtk_widget_real_grab_focus;
 | |
|   klass->focus = gtk_widget_real_focus;
 | |
|   klass->move_focus = gtk_widget_real_move_focus;
 | |
|   klass->keynav_failed = gtk_widget_real_keynav_failed;
 | |
|   klass->event = NULL;
 | |
|   klass->button_press_event = NULL;
 | |
|   klass->button_release_event = NULL;
 | |
|   klass->motion_notify_event = NULL;
 | |
|   klass->delete_event = NULL;
 | |
|   klass->destroy_event = NULL;
 | |
|   klass->key_press_event = gtk_widget_real_key_press_event;
 | |
|   klass->key_release_event = gtk_widget_real_key_release_event;
 | |
|   klass->enter_notify_event = NULL;
 | |
|   klass->leave_notify_event = NULL;
 | |
|   klass->configure_event = NULL;
 | |
|   klass->focus_in_event = gtk_widget_real_focus_in_event;
 | |
|   klass->focus_out_event = gtk_widget_real_focus_out_event;
 | |
|   klass->map_event = NULL;
 | |
|   klass->unmap_event = NULL;
 | |
|   klass->window_state_event = NULL;
 | |
|   klass->property_notify_event = _gtk_selection_property_notify;
 | |
|   klass->selection_clear_event = _gtk_selection_clear;
 | |
|   klass->selection_request_event = _gtk_selection_request;
 | |
|   klass->selection_notify_event = _gtk_selection_notify;
 | |
|   klass->selection_received = NULL;
 | |
|   klass->proximity_in_event = NULL;
 | |
|   klass->proximity_out_event = NULL;
 | |
|   klass->drag_begin = NULL;
 | |
|   klass->drag_end = NULL;
 | |
|   klass->drag_data_delete = NULL;
 | |
|   klass->drag_leave = NULL;
 | |
|   klass->drag_motion = NULL;
 | |
|   klass->drag_drop = NULL;
 | |
|   klass->drag_data_received = NULL;
 | |
|   klass->screen_changed = NULL;
 | |
|   klass->can_activate_accel = gtk_widget_real_can_activate_accel;
 | |
|   klass->grab_broken_event = NULL;
 | |
|   klass->query_tooltip = gtk_widget_real_query_tooltip;
 | |
|   klass->style_updated = gtk_widget_real_style_updated;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   klass->show_help = gtk_widget_real_show_help;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /* Accessibility support */
 | |
|   klass->priv->accessible_type = GTK_TYPE_ACCESSIBLE;
 | |
|   klass->priv->accessible_role = ATK_ROLE_INVALID;
 | |
|   klass->get_accessible = gtk_widget_real_get_accessible;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   klass->adjust_size_request = gtk_widget_real_adjust_size_request;
 | |
|   klass->adjust_size_allocation = gtk_widget_real_adjust_size_allocation;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class,
 | |
| 				   PROP_NAME,
 | |
| 				   g_param_spec_string ("name",
 | |
|  							P_("Widget name"),
 | |
| 							P_("The name of the widget"),
 | |
| 							NULL,
 | |
| 							GTK_PARAM_READWRITE));
 | |
|   g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class,
 | |
| 				   PROP_PARENT,
 | |
| 				   g_param_spec_object ("parent",
 | |
| 							P_("Parent widget"),
 | |
| 							P_("The parent widget of this widget. Must be a Container widget"),
 | |
| 							GTK_TYPE_CONTAINER,
 | |
| 							GTK_PARAM_READWRITE));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class,
 | |
| 				   PROP_WIDTH_REQUEST,
 | |
| 				   g_param_spec_int ("width-request",
 | |
|  						     P_("Width request"),
 | |
|  						     P_("Override for width request of the widget, or -1 if natural request should be used"),
 | |
|  						     -1,
 | |
|  						     G_MAXINT,
 | |
|  						     -1,
 | |
|  						     GTK_PARAM_READWRITE));
 | |
|   g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class,
 | |
| 				   PROP_HEIGHT_REQUEST,
 | |
| 				   g_param_spec_int ("height-request",
 | |
|  						     P_("Height request"),
 | |
|  						     P_("Override for height request of the widget, or -1 if natural request should be used"),
 | |
|  						     -1,
 | |
|  						     G_MAXINT,
 | |
|  						     -1,
 | |
|  						     GTK_PARAM_READWRITE));
 | |
|   g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class,
 | |
| 				   PROP_VISIBLE,
 | |
| 				   g_param_spec_boolean ("visible",
 | |
|  							 P_("Visible"),
 | |
|  							 P_("Whether the widget is visible"),
 | |
|  							 FALSE,
 | |
|  							 GTK_PARAM_READWRITE));
 | |
|   g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class,
 | |
| 				   PROP_SENSITIVE,
 | |
| 				   g_param_spec_boolean ("sensitive",
 | |
|  							 P_("Sensitive"),
 | |
|  							 P_("Whether the widget responds to input"),
 | |
|  							 TRUE,
 | |
|  							 GTK_PARAM_READWRITE));
 | |
|   g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class,
 | |
| 				   PROP_APP_PAINTABLE,
 | |
| 				   g_param_spec_boolean ("app-paintable",
 | |
|  							 P_("Application paintable"),
 | |
|  							 P_("Whether the application will paint directly on the widget"),
 | |
|  							 FALSE,
 | |
|  							 GTK_PARAM_READWRITE));
 | |
|   g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class,
 | |
| 				   PROP_CAN_FOCUS,
 | |
| 				   g_param_spec_boolean ("can-focus",
 | |
|  							 P_("Can focus"),
 | |
|  							 P_("Whether the widget can accept the input focus"),
 | |
|  							 FALSE,
 | |
|  							 GTK_PARAM_READWRITE));
 | |
|   g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class,
 | |
| 				   PROP_HAS_FOCUS,
 | |
| 				   g_param_spec_boolean ("has-focus",
 | |
|  							 P_("Has focus"),
 | |
|  							 P_("Whether the widget has the input focus"),
 | |
|  							 FALSE,
 | |
|  							 GTK_PARAM_READWRITE));
 | |
|   g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class,
 | |
| 				   PROP_IS_FOCUS,
 | |
| 				   g_param_spec_boolean ("is-focus",
 | |
|  							 P_("Is focus"),
 | |
|  							 P_("Whether the widget is the focus widget within the toplevel"),
 | |
|  							 FALSE,
 | |
|  							 GTK_PARAM_READWRITE));
 | |
|   g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class,
 | |
| 				   PROP_CAN_DEFAULT,
 | |
| 				   g_param_spec_boolean ("can-default",
 | |
|  							 P_("Can default"),
 | |
|  							 P_("Whether the widget can be the default widget"),
 | |
|  							 FALSE,
 | |
|  							 GTK_PARAM_READWRITE));
 | |
|   g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class,
 | |
| 				   PROP_HAS_DEFAULT,
 | |
| 				   g_param_spec_boolean ("has-default",
 | |
|  							 P_("Has default"),
 | |
|  							 P_("Whether the widget is the default widget"),
 | |
|  							 FALSE,
 | |
|  							 GTK_PARAM_READWRITE));
 | |
|   g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class,
 | |
| 				   PROP_RECEIVES_DEFAULT,
 | |
| 				   g_param_spec_boolean ("receives-default",
 | |
|  							 P_("Receives default"),
 | |
|  							 P_("If TRUE, the widget will receive the default action when it is focused"),
 | |
|  							 FALSE,
 | |
|  							 GTK_PARAM_READWRITE));
 | |
|   g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class,
 | |
| 				   PROP_COMPOSITE_CHILD,
 | |
| 				   g_param_spec_boolean ("composite-child",
 | |
|  							 P_("Composite child"),
 | |
|  							 P_("Whether the widget is part of a composite widget"),
 | |
|  							 FALSE,
 | |
|  							 GTK_PARAM_READABLE));
 | |
|   g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class,
 | |
| 				   PROP_STYLE,
 | |
| 				   g_param_spec_object ("style",
 | |
|  							P_("Style"),
 | |
|  							P_("The style of the widget, which contains information about how it will look (colors etc)"),
 | |
|  							GTK_TYPE_STYLE,
 | |
|  							GTK_PARAM_READWRITE));
 | |
|   g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class,
 | |
| 				   PROP_EVENTS,
 | |
| 				   g_param_spec_flags ("events",
 | |
|  						       P_("Events"),
 | |
|  						       P_("The event mask that decides what kind of GdkEvents this widget gets"),
 | |
|  						       GDK_TYPE_EVENT_MASK,
 | |
|  						       GDK_STRUCTURE_MASK,
 | |
|  						       GTK_PARAM_READWRITE));
 | |
|   g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class,
 | |
| 				   PROP_NO_SHOW_ALL,
 | |
| 				   g_param_spec_boolean ("no-show-all",
 | |
|  							 P_("No show all"),
 | |
|  							 P_("Whether gtk_widget_show_all() should not affect this widget"),
 | |
|  							 FALSE,
 | |
|  							 GTK_PARAM_READWRITE));
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * GtkWidget:has-tooltip:
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Enables or disables the emission of #GtkWidget::query-tooltip on @widget.
 | |
|  * A value of %TRUE indicates that @widget can have a tooltip, in this case
 | |
|  * the widget will be queried using #GtkWidget::query-tooltip to determine
 | |
|  * whether it will provide a tooltip or not.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Note that setting this property to %TRUE for the first time will change
 | |
|  * the event masks of the GdkWindows of this widget to include leave-notify
 | |
|  * and motion-notify events.  This cannot and will not be undone when the
 | |
|  * property is set to %FALSE again.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.12
 | |
|  */
 | |
|   g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class,
 | |
| 				   PROP_HAS_TOOLTIP,
 | |
| 				   g_param_spec_boolean ("has-tooltip",
 | |
|  							 P_("Has tooltip"),
 | |
|  							 P_("Whether this widget has a tooltip"),
 | |
|  							 FALSE,
 | |
|  							 GTK_PARAM_READWRITE));
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget:tooltip-text:
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Sets the text of tooltip to be the given string.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Also see gtk_tooltip_set_text().
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * This is a convenience property which will take care of getting the
 | |
|    * tooltip shown if the given string is not %NULL: #GtkWidget:has-tooltip
 | |
|    * will automatically be set to %TRUE and there will be taken care of
 | |
|    * #GtkWidget::query-tooltip in the default signal handler.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Since: 2.12
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class,
 | |
|                                    PROP_TOOLTIP_TEXT,
 | |
|                                    g_param_spec_string ("tooltip-text",
 | |
|                                                         P_("Tooltip Text"),
 | |
|                                                         P_("The contents of the tooltip for this widget"),
 | |
|                                                         NULL,
 | |
|                                                         GTK_PARAM_READWRITE));
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget:tooltip-markup:
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Sets the text of tooltip to be the given string, which is marked up
 | |
|    * with the <link linkend="PangoMarkupFormat">Pango text markup language</link>.
 | |
|    * Also see gtk_tooltip_set_markup().
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * This is a convenience property which will take care of getting the
 | |
|    * tooltip shown if the given string is not %NULL: #GtkWidget:has-tooltip
 | |
|    * will automatically be set to %TRUE and there will be taken care of
 | |
|    * #GtkWidget::query-tooltip in the default signal handler.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Since: 2.12
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class,
 | |
| 				   PROP_TOOLTIP_MARKUP,
 | |
| 				   g_param_spec_string ("tooltip-markup",
 | |
|  							P_("Tooltip markup"),
 | |
| 							P_("The contents of the tooltip for this widget"),
 | |
| 							NULL,
 | |
| 							GTK_PARAM_READWRITE));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget:window:
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * The widget's window if it is realized, %NULL otherwise.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Since: 2.14
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class,
 | |
| 				   PROP_WINDOW,
 | |
| 				   g_param_spec_object ("window",
 | |
|  							P_("Window"),
 | |
| 							P_("The widget's window if it is realized"),
 | |
| 							GDK_TYPE_WINDOW,
 | |
| 							GTK_PARAM_READABLE));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget:double-buffered
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Whether the widget is double buffered.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Since: 2.18
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class,
 | |
|                                    PROP_DOUBLE_BUFFERED,
 | |
|                                    g_param_spec_boolean ("double-buffered",
 | |
|                                                          P_("Double Buffered"),
 | |
|                                                          P_("Whether the widget is double buffered"),
 | |
|                                                          TRUE,
 | |
|                                                          GTK_PARAM_READWRITE));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget:halign:
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * How to distribute horizontal space if widget gets extra space, see #GtkAlign
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Since: 3.0
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class,
 | |
|                                    PROP_HALIGN,
 | |
|                                    g_param_spec_enum ("halign",
 | |
|                                                       P_("Horizontal Alignment"),
 | |
|                                                       P_("How to position in extra horizontal space"),
 | |
|                                                       GTK_TYPE_ALIGN,
 | |
|                                                       GTK_ALIGN_FILL,
 | |
|                                                       GTK_PARAM_READWRITE));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget:valign:
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * How to distribute vertical space if widget gets extra space, see #GtkAlign
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Since: 3.0
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class,
 | |
|                                    PROP_VALIGN,
 | |
|                                    g_param_spec_enum ("valign",
 | |
|                                                       P_("Vertical Alignment"),
 | |
|                                                       P_("How to position in extra vertical space"),
 | |
|                                                       GTK_TYPE_ALIGN,
 | |
|                                                       GTK_ALIGN_FILL,
 | |
|                                                       GTK_PARAM_READWRITE));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget:margin-left
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Margin on left side of widget.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * This property adds margin outside of the widget's normal size
 | |
|    * request, the margin will be added in addition to the size from
 | |
|    * gtk_widget_set_size_request() for example.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Since: 3.0
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class,
 | |
|                                    PROP_MARGIN_LEFT,
 | |
|                                    g_param_spec_int ("margin-left",
 | |
|                                                      P_("Margin on Left"),
 | |
|                                                      P_("Pixels of extra space on the left side"),
 | |
|                                                      0,
 | |
|                                                      G_MAXINT16,
 | |
|                                                      0,
 | |
|                                                      GTK_PARAM_READWRITE));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget:margin-right
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Margin on right side of widget.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * This property adds margin outside of the widget's normal size
 | |
|    * request, the margin will be added in addition to the size from
 | |
|    * gtk_widget_set_size_request() for example.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Since: 3.0
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class,
 | |
|                                    PROP_MARGIN_RIGHT,
 | |
|                                    g_param_spec_int ("margin-right",
 | |
|                                                      P_("Margin on Right"),
 | |
|                                                      P_("Pixels of extra space on the right side"),
 | |
|                                                      0,
 | |
|                                                      G_MAXINT16,
 | |
|                                                      0,
 | |
|                                                      GTK_PARAM_READWRITE));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget:margin-top
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Margin on top side of widget.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * This property adds margin outside of the widget's normal size
 | |
|    * request, the margin will be added in addition to the size from
 | |
|    * gtk_widget_set_size_request() for example.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Since: 3.0
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class,
 | |
|                                    PROP_MARGIN_TOP,
 | |
|                                    g_param_spec_int ("margin-top",
 | |
|                                                      P_("Margin on Top"),
 | |
|                                                      P_("Pixels of extra space on the top side"),
 | |
|                                                      0,
 | |
|                                                      G_MAXINT16,
 | |
|                                                      0,
 | |
|                                                      GTK_PARAM_READWRITE));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget:margin-bottom
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Margin on bottom side of widget.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * This property adds margin outside of the widget's normal size
 | |
|    * request, the margin will be added in addition to the size from
 | |
|    * gtk_widget_set_size_request() for example.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Since: 3.0
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class,
 | |
|                                    PROP_MARGIN_BOTTOM,
 | |
|                                    g_param_spec_int ("margin-bottom",
 | |
|                                                      P_("Margin on Bottom"),
 | |
|                                                      P_("Pixels of extra space on the bottom side"),
 | |
|                                                      0,
 | |
|                                                      G_MAXINT16,
 | |
|                                                      0,
 | |
|                                                      GTK_PARAM_READWRITE));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget:margin
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Sets all four sides' margin at once. If read, returns max
 | |
|    * margin on any side.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Since: 3.0
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class,
 | |
|                                    PROP_MARGIN,
 | |
|                                    g_param_spec_int ("margin",
 | |
|                                                      P_("All Margins"),
 | |
|                                                      P_("Pixels of extra space on all four sides"),
 | |
|                                                      0,
 | |
|                                                      G_MAXINT16,
 | |
|                                                      0,
 | |
|                                                      GTK_PARAM_READWRITE));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::destroy:
 | |
|    * @object: the object which received the signal
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Signals that all holders of a reference to the widget should release
 | |
|    * the reference that they hold. May result in finalization of the widget
 | |
|    * if all references are released.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[DESTROY] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("destroy"),
 | |
|                   G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class),
 | |
|                   G_SIGNAL_RUN_CLEANUP | G_SIGNAL_NO_RECURSE | G_SIGNAL_NO_HOOKS,
 | |
|                   G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, destroy),
 | |
|                   NULL, NULL,
 | |
|                   _gtk_marshal_VOID__VOID,
 | |
|                   G_TYPE_NONE, 0);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget:hexpand
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Whether to expand horizontally. See gtk_widget_set_hexpand().
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Since: 3.0
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class,
 | |
|                                    PROP_HEXPAND,
 | |
|                                    g_param_spec_boolean ("hexpand",
 | |
|                                                          P_("Horizontal Expand"),
 | |
|                                                          P_("Whether widget wants more horizontal space"),
 | |
|                                                          FALSE,
 | |
|                                                          GTK_PARAM_READWRITE));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget:hexpand-set
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Whether to use the #GtkWidget:hexpand property. See gtk_widget_get_hexpand_set().
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Since: 3.0
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class,
 | |
|                                    PROP_HEXPAND_SET,
 | |
|                                    g_param_spec_boolean ("hexpand-set",
 | |
|                                                          P_("Horizontal Expand Set"),
 | |
|                                                          P_("Whether to use the hexpand property"),
 | |
|                                                          FALSE,
 | |
|                                                          GTK_PARAM_READWRITE));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget:vexpand
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Whether to expand vertically. See gtk_widget_set_vexpand().
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Since: 3.0
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class,
 | |
|                                    PROP_VEXPAND,
 | |
|                                    g_param_spec_boolean ("vexpand",
 | |
|                                                          P_("Vertical Expand"),
 | |
|                                                          P_("Whether widget wants more vertical space"),
 | |
|                                                          FALSE,
 | |
|                                                          GTK_PARAM_READWRITE));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget:vexpand-set
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Whether to use the #GtkWidget:vexpand property. See gtk_widget_get_vexpand_set().
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Since: 3.0
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class,
 | |
|                                    PROP_VEXPAND_SET,
 | |
|                                    g_param_spec_boolean ("vexpand-set",
 | |
|                                                          P_("Vertical Expand Set"),
 | |
|                                                          P_("Whether to use the vexpand property"),
 | |
|                                                          FALSE,
 | |
|                                                          GTK_PARAM_READWRITE));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget:expand
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Whether to expand in both directions. Setting this sets both #GtkWidget:hexpand and #GtkWidget:vexpand
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Since: 3.0
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class,
 | |
|                                    PROP_EXPAND,
 | |
|                                    g_param_spec_boolean ("expand",
 | |
|                                                          P_("Expand Both"),
 | |
|                                                          P_("Whether widget wants to expand in both directions"),
 | |
|                                                          FALSE,
 | |
|                                                          GTK_PARAM_READWRITE));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::show:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[SHOW] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("show"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class),
 | |
| 		  G_SIGNAL_RUN_FIRST,
 | |
| 		  G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, show),
 | |
| 		  NULL, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_VOID__VOID,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_NONE, 0);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::hide:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[HIDE] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("hide"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class),
 | |
| 		  G_SIGNAL_RUN_FIRST,
 | |
| 		  G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, hide),
 | |
| 		  NULL, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_VOID__VOID,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_NONE, 0);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::map:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[MAP] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("map"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class),
 | |
| 		  G_SIGNAL_RUN_FIRST,
 | |
| 		  G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, map),
 | |
| 		  NULL, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_VOID__VOID,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_NONE, 0);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::unmap:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[UNMAP] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("unmap"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class),
 | |
| 		  G_SIGNAL_RUN_FIRST,
 | |
| 		  G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, unmap),
 | |
| 		  NULL, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_VOID__VOID,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_NONE, 0);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::realize:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[REALIZE] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("realize"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class),
 | |
| 		  G_SIGNAL_RUN_FIRST,
 | |
| 		  G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, realize),
 | |
| 		  NULL, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_VOID__VOID,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_NONE, 0);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::unrealize:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[UNREALIZE] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("unrealize"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class),
 | |
| 		  G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST,
 | |
| 		  G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, unrealize),
 | |
| 		  NULL, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_VOID__VOID,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_NONE, 0);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::size-allocate:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal.
 | |
|    * @allocation:
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[SIZE_ALLOCATE] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("size-allocate"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class),
 | |
| 		  G_SIGNAL_RUN_FIRST,
 | |
| 		  G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, size_allocate),
 | |
| 		  NULL, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_VOID__BOXED,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_NONE, 1,
 | |
| 		  GDK_TYPE_RECTANGLE | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::state-changed:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal.
 | |
|    * @state: the previous state
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * The ::state-changed signal is emitted when the widget state changes.
 | |
|    * See gtk_widget_get_state().
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Deprecated: 3.0. Use #GtkWidget::state-flags-changed instead.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[STATE_CHANGED] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("state-changed"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class),
 | |
| 		  G_SIGNAL_RUN_FIRST,
 | |
| 		  G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, state_changed),
 | |
| 		  NULL, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_VOID__ENUM,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_NONE, 1,
 | |
| 		  GTK_TYPE_STATE_TYPE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::state-flags-changed:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal.
 | |
|    * @flags: The previous state flags.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * The ::state-flags-changed signal is emitted when the widget state
 | |
|    * changes, see gtk_widget_get_state_flags().
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Since: 3.0
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[STATE_FLAGS_CHANGED] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("state-flags-changed"),
 | |
|                   G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class),
 | |
|                   G_SIGNAL_RUN_FIRST,
 | |
|                   G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, state_flags_changed),
 | |
|                   NULL, NULL,
 | |
|                   _gtk_marshal_VOID__FLAGS,
 | |
|                   G_TYPE_NONE, 1,
 | |
|                   GTK_TYPE_STATE_FLAGS);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::parent-set:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object on which the signal is emitted
 | |
|    * @old_parent: (allow-none): the previous parent, or %NULL if the widget
 | |
|    *   just got its initial parent.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * The ::parent-set signal is emitted when a new parent
 | |
|    * has been set on a widget.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[PARENT_SET] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("parent-set"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class),
 | |
| 		  G_SIGNAL_RUN_FIRST,
 | |
| 		  G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, parent_set),
 | |
| 		  NULL, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_VOID__OBJECT,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_NONE, 1,
 | |
| 		  GTK_TYPE_WIDGET);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::hierarchy-changed:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object on which the signal is emitted
 | |
|    * @previous_toplevel: (allow-none): the previous toplevel ancestor, or %NULL
 | |
|    *   if the widget was previously unanchored
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * The ::hierarchy-changed signal is emitted when the
 | |
|    * anchored state of a widget changes. A widget is
 | |
|    * <firstterm>anchored</firstterm> when its toplevel
 | |
|    * ancestor is a #GtkWindow. This signal is emitted when
 | |
|    * a widget changes from un-anchored to anchored or vice-versa.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[HIERARCHY_CHANGED] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("hierarchy-changed"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class),
 | |
| 		  G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST,
 | |
| 		  G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, hierarchy_changed),
 | |
| 		  NULL, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_VOID__OBJECT,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_NONE, 1,
 | |
| 		  GTK_TYPE_WIDGET);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::style-set:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object on which the signal is emitted
 | |
|    * @previous_style: (allow-none): the previous style, or %NULL if the widget
 | |
|    *   just got its initial style
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * The ::style-set signal is emitted when a new style has been set
 | |
|    * on a widget. Note that style-modifying functions like
 | |
|    * gtk_widget_modify_base() also cause this signal to be emitted.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Note that this signal is emitted for changes to the deprecated
 | |
|    * #GtkStyle. To track changes to the #GtkStyleContext associated
 | |
|    * with a widget, use the #GtkWidget::style-updated signal.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Deprecated:3.0: Use the #GtkWidget::style-updated signal
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[STYLE_SET] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("style-set"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class),
 | |
| 		  G_SIGNAL_RUN_FIRST,
 | |
| 		  G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, style_set),
 | |
| 		  NULL, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_VOID__OBJECT,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_NONE, 1,
 | |
| 		  GTK_TYPE_STYLE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::style-updated:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object on which the signal is emitted
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * The ::style-updated signal is emitted when the #GtkStyleContext
 | |
|    * of a widget is changed. Note that style-modifying functions like
 | |
|    * gtk_widget_override_color() also cause this signal to be emitted.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Since: 3.0
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[STYLE_UPDATED] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("style-updated"),
 | |
|                   G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class),
 | |
|                   G_SIGNAL_RUN_FIRST,
 | |
|                   G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, style_updated),
 | |
|                   NULL, NULL,
 | |
|                   g_cclosure_marshal_VOID__VOID,
 | |
|                   G_TYPE_NONE, 0);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::direction-changed:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object on which the signal is emitted
 | |
|    * @previous_direction: the previous text direction of @widget
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * The ::direction-changed signal is emitted when the text direction
 | |
|    * of a widget changes.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[DIRECTION_CHANGED] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("direction-changed"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class),
 | |
| 		  G_SIGNAL_RUN_FIRST,
 | |
| 		  G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, direction_changed),
 | |
| 		  NULL, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_VOID__ENUM,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_NONE, 1,
 | |
| 		  GTK_TYPE_TEXT_DIRECTION);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::grab-notify:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal
 | |
|    * @was_grabbed: %FALSE if the widget becomes shadowed, %TRUE
 | |
|    *               if it becomes unshadowed
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * The ::grab-notify signal is emitted when a widget becomes
 | |
|    * shadowed by a GTK+ grab (not a pointer or keyboard grab) on
 | |
|    * another widget, or when it becomes unshadowed due to a grab
 | |
|    * being removed.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * A widget is shadowed by a gtk_grab_add() when the topmost
 | |
|    * grab widget in the grab stack of its window group is not
 | |
|    * its ancestor.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[GRAB_NOTIFY] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("grab-notify"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class),
 | |
| 		  G_SIGNAL_RUN_FIRST,
 | |
|                   G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, grab_notify),
 | |
| 		  NULL, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_VOID__BOOLEAN,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_NONE, 1,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_BOOLEAN);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::child-notify:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal
 | |
|    * @pspec: the #GParamSpec of the changed child property
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * The ::child-notify signal is emitted for each
 | |
|    * <link linkend="child-properties">child property</link>  that has
 | |
|    * changed on an object. The signal's detail holds the property name.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[CHILD_NOTIFY] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("child-notify"),
 | |
| 		   G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class),
 | |
| 		   G_SIGNAL_RUN_FIRST | G_SIGNAL_NO_RECURSE | G_SIGNAL_DETAILED | G_SIGNAL_NO_HOOKS,
 | |
| 		   G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, child_notify),
 | |
| 		   NULL, NULL,
 | |
| 		   g_cclosure_marshal_VOID__PARAM,
 | |
| 		   G_TYPE_NONE, 1,
 | |
| 		   G_TYPE_PARAM);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::draw:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal
 | |
|    * @cr: the cairo context to draw to
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * This signal is emitted when a widget is supposed to render itself.
 | |
|    * The @widget's top left corner must be painted at the origin of
 | |
|    * the passed in context and be sized to the values returned by
 | |
|    * gtk_widget_get_allocated_width() and
 | |
|    * gtk_widget_get_allocated_height().
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Signal handlers connected to this signal can modify the cairo
 | |
|    * context passed as @cr in any way they like and don't need to
 | |
|    * restore it. The signal emission takes care of calling cairo_save()
 | |
|    * before and cairo_restore() after invoking the handler.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Since: 3.0
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[DRAW] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("draw"),
 | |
| 		   G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class),
 | |
| 		   G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST,
 | |
| 		   G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, draw),
 | |
|                    _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL,
 | |
|                    gtk_widget_draw_marshaller,
 | |
| 		   G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1,
 | |
| 		   CAIRO_GOBJECT_TYPE_CONTEXT);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::mnemonic-activate:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal.
 | |
|    * @arg1:
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[MNEMONIC_ACTIVATE] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("mnemonic-activate"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class),
 | |
| 		  G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST,
 | |
| 		  G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, mnemonic_activate),
 | |
| 		  _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOOLEAN,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_BOOLEAN);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::grab-focus:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[GRAB_FOCUS] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("grab-focus"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class),
 | |
| 		  G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST | G_SIGNAL_ACTION,
 | |
| 		  G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, grab_focus),
 | |
| 		  NULL, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_VOID__VOID,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_NONE, 0);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::focus:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal.
 | |
|    * @direction:
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event. %FALSE to propagate the event further.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[FOCUS] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("focus"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass),
 | |
| 		  G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST,
 | |
| 		  G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, focus),
 | |
| 		  _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__ENUM,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1,
 | |
| 		  GTK_TYPE_DIRECTION_TYPE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::move-focus:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal.
 | |
|    * @direction:
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[MOVE_FOCUS] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("move-focus"),
 | |
|                   G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass),
 | |
|                   G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST | G_SIGNAL_ACTION,
 | |
|                   G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, move_focus),
 | |
|                   NULL, NULL,
 | |
|                   _gtk_marshal_VOID__ENUM,
 | |
|                   G_TYPE_NONE,
 | |
|                   1,
 | |
|                   GTK_TYPE_DIRECTION_TYPE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::keynav-failed:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal
 | |
|    * @direction: the direction of movement
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Gets emitted if keyboard navigation fails.
 | |
|    * See gtk_widget_keynav_failed() for details.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Returns: %TRUE if stopping keyboard navigation is fine, %FALSE
 | |
|    *          if the emitting widget should try to handle the keyboard
 | |
|    *          navigation attempt in its parent container(s).
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Since: 2.12
 | |
|    **/
 | |
|   widget_signals[KEYNAV_FAILED] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("keynav-failed"),
 | |
|                   G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass),
 | |
|                   G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST,
 | |
|                   G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, keynav_failed),
 | |
|                   _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL,
 | |
|                   _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__ENUM,
 | |
|                   G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1,
 | |
|                   GTK_TYPE_DIRECTION_TYPE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::event:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal.
 | |
|    * @event: the #GdkEvent which triggered this signal
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * The GTK+ main loop will emit three signals for each GDK event delivered
 | |
|    * to a widget: one generic ::event signal, another, more specific,
 | |
|    * signal that matches the type of event delivered (e.g.
 | |
|    * #GtkWidget::key-press-event) and finally a generic
 | |
|    * #GtkWidget::event-after signal.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event
 | |
|    * and to cancel the emission of the second specific ::event signal.
 | |
|    *   %FALSE to propagate the event further and to allow the emission of
 | |
|    *   the second signal. The ::event-after signal is emitted regardless of
 | |
|    *   the return value.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[EVENT] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("event"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass),
 | |
| 		  G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST,
 | |
| 		  G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, event),
 | |
| 		  _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOXED,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1,
 | |
| 		  GDK_TYPE_EVENT | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::event-after:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal.
 | |
|    * @event: the #GdkEvent which triggered this signal
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * After the emission of the #GtkWidget::event signal and (optionally)
 | |
|    * the second more specific signal, ::event-after will be emitted
 | |
|    * regardless of the previous two signals handlers return values.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[EVENT_AFTER] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("event-after"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass),
 | |
| 		  0,
 | |
| 		  0,
 | |
| 		  NULL, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_VOID__BOXED,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_NONE, 1,
 | |
| 		  GDK_TYPE_EVENT | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::button-press-event:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal.
 | |
|    * @event: (type Gdk.EventButton): the #GdkEventButton which triggered
 | |
|    *   this signal.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * The ::button-press-event signal will be emitted when a button
 | |
|    * (typically from a mouse) is pressed.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * To receive this signal, the #GdkWindow associated to the
 | |
|    * widget needs to enable the #GDK_BUTTON_PRESS_MASK mask.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * This signal will be sent to the grab widget if there is one.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event.
 | |
|    *   %FALSE to propagate the event further.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[BUTTON_PRESS_EVENT] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("button-press-event"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass),
 | |
| 		  G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST,
 | |
| 		  G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, button_press_event),
 | |
| 		  _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOXED,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1,
 | |
| 		  GDK_TYPE_EVENT | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::button-release-event:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal.
 | |
|    * @event: (type Gdk.EventButton): the #GdkEventButton which triggered
 | |
|    *   this signal.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * The ::button-release-event signal will be emitted when a button
 | |
|    * (typically from a mouse) is released.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * To receive this signal, the #GdkWindow associated to the
 | |
|    * widget needs to enable the #GDK_BUTTON_RELEASE_MASK mask.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * This signal will be sent to the grab widget if there is one.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event.
 | |
|    *   %FALSE to propagate the event further.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[BUTTON_RELEASE_EVENT] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("button-release-event"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass),
 | |
| 		  G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST,
 | |
| 		  G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, button_release_event),
 | |
| 		  _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOXED,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1,
 | |
| 		  GDK_TYPE_EVENT | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::scroll-event:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal.
 | |
|    * @event: (type Gdk.EventScroll): the #GdkEventScroll which triggered
 | |
|    *   this signal.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * The ::scroll-event signal is emitted when a button in the 4 to 7
 | |
|    * range is pressed. Wheel mice are usually configured to generate
 | |
|    * button press events for buttons 4 and 5 when the wheel is turned.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * To receive this signal, the #GdkWindow associated to the widget needs
 | |
|    * to enable the #GDK_BUTTON_PRESS_MASK mask.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * This signal will be sent to the grab widget if there is one.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event.
 | |
|    *   %FALSE to propagate the event further.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[SCROLL_EVENT] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("scroll-event"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass),
 | |
| 		  G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST,
 | |
| 		  G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, scroll_event),
 | |
| 		  _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOXED,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1,
 | |
| 		  GDK_TYPE_EVENT | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::motion-notify-event:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal.
 | |
|    * @event: (type Gdk.EventMotion): the #GdkEventMotion which triggered
 | |
|    *   this signal.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * The ::motion-notify-event signal is emitted when the pointer moves
 | |
|    * over the widget's #GdkWindow.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * To receive this signal, the #GdkWindow associated to the widget
 | |
|    * needs to enable the #GDK_POINTER_MOTION_MASK mask.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * This signal will be sent to the grab widget if there is one.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event.
 | |
|    *   %FALSE to propagate the event further.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[MOTION_NOTIFY_EVENT] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("motion-notify-event"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass),
 | |
| 		  G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST,
 | |
| 		  G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, motion_notify_event),
 | |
| 		  _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOXED,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1,
 | |
| 		  GDK_TYPE_EVENT | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::composited-changed:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object on which the signal is emitted
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * The ::composited-changed signal is emitted when the composited
 | |
|    * status of @widget<!-- -->s screen changes.
 | |
|    * See gdk_screen_is_composited().
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[COMPOSITED_CHANGED] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("composited-changed"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass),
 | |
| 		  G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST | G_SIGNAL_ACTION,
 | |
| 		  G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, composited_changed),
 | |
| 		  NULL, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_VOID__VOID,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_NONE, 0);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::delete-event:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal
 | |
|    * @event: the event which triggered this signal
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * The ::delete-event signal is emitted if a user requests that
 | |
|    * a toplevel window is closed. The default handler for this signal
 | |
|    * destroys the window. Connecting gtk_widget_hide_on_delete() to
 | |
|    * this signal will cause the window to be hidden instead, so that
 | |
|    * it can later be shown again without reconstructing it.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event.
 | |
|    *   %FALSE to propagate the event further.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[DELETE_EVENT] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("delete-event"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass),
 | |
| 		  G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST,
 | |
| 		  G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, delete_event),
 | |
| 		  _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOXED,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1,
 | |
| 		  GDK_TYPE_EVENT | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::destroy-event:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal.
 | |
|    * @event: the event which triggered this signal
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * The ::destroy-event signal is emitted when a #GdkWindow is destroyed.
 | |
|    * You rarely get this signal, because most widgets disconnect themselves
 | |
|    * from their window before they destroy it, so no widget owns the
 | |
|    * window at destroy time.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * To receive this signal, the #GdkWindow associated to the widget needs
 | |
|    * to enable the #GDK_STRUCTURE_MASK mask. GDK will enable this mask
 | |
|    * automatically for all new windows.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event.
 | |
|    *   %FALSE to propagate the event further.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[DESTROY_EVENT] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("destroy-event"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass),
 | |
| 		  G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST,
 | |
| 		  G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, destroy_event),
 | |
| 		  _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOXED,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1,
 | |
| 		  GDK_TYPE_EVENT | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::key-press-event:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal
 | |
|    * @event: (type Gdk.EventKey): the #GdkEventKey which triggered this signal.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * The ::key-press-event signal is emitted when a key is pressed. The signal
 | |
|    * emission will reoccur at the key-repeat rate when the key is kept pressed.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * To receive this signal, the #GdkWindow associated to the widget needs
 | |
|    * to enable the #GDK_KEY_PRESS_MASK mask.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * This signal will be sent to the grab widget if there is one.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event.
 | |
|    *   %FALSE to propagate the event further.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[KEY_PRESS_EVENT] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("key-press-event"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass),
 | |
| 		  G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST,
 | |
| 		  G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, key_press_event),
 | |
| 		  _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOXED,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1,
 | |
| 		  GDK_TYPE_EVENT | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::key-release-event:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal
 | |
|    * @event: (type Gdk.EventKey): the #GdkEventKey which triggered this signal.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * The ::key-release-event signal is emitted when a key is released.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * To receive this signal, the #GdkWindow associated to the widget needs
 | |
|    * to enable the #GDK_KEY_RELEASE_MASK mask.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * This signal will be sent to the grab widget if there is one.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event.
 | |
|    *   %FALSE to propagate the event further.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[KEY_RELEASE_EVENT] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("key-release-event"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass),
 | |
| 		  G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST,
 | |
| 		  G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, key_release_event),
 | |
| 		  _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOXED,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1,
 | |
| 		  GDK_TYPE_EVENT | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::enter-notify-event:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal
 | |
|    * @event: (type Gdk.EventCrossing): the #GdkEventCrossing which triggered
 | |
|    *   this signal.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * The ::enter-notify-event will be emitted when the pointer enters
 | |
|    * the @widget's window.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * To receive this signal, the #GdkWindow associated to the widget needs
 | |
|    * to enable the #GDK_ENTER_NOTIFY_MASK mask.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * This signal will be sent to the grab widget if there is one.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event.
 | |
|    *   %FALSE to propagate the event further.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[ENTER_NOTIFY_EVENT] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("enter-notify-event"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass),
 | |
| 		  G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST,
 | |
| 		  G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, enter_notify_event),
 | |
| 		  _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOXED,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1,
 | |
| 		  GDK_TYPE_EVENT | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::leave-notify-event:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal
 | |
|    * @event: (type Gdk.EventCrossing): the #GdkEventCrossing which triggered
 | |
|    *   this signal.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * The ::leave-notify-event will be emitted when the pointer leaves
 | |
|    * the @widget's window.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * To receive this signal, the #GdkWindow associated to the widget needs
 | |
|    * to enable the #GDK_LEAVE_NOTIFY_MASK mask.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * This signal will be sent to the grab widget if there is one.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event.
 | |
|    *   %FALSE to propagate the event further.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[LEAVE_NOTIFY_EVENT] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("leave-notify-event"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass),
 | |
| 		  G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST,
 | |
| 		  G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, leave_notify_event),
 | |
| 		  _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOXED,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1,
 | |
| 		  GDK_TYPE_EVENT | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::configure-event:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal
 | |
|    * @event: (type Gdk.EventConfigure): the #GdkEventConfigure which triggered
 | |
|    *   this signal.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * The ::configure-event signal will be emitted when the size, position or
 | |
|    * stacking of the @widget's window has changed.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * To receive this signal, the #GdkWindow associated to the widget needs
 | |
|    * to enable the #GDK_STRUCTURE_MASK mask. GDK will enable this mask
 | |
|    * automatically for all new windows.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event.
 | |
|    *   %FALSE to propagate the event further.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[CONFIGURE_EVENT] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("configure-event"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass),
 | |
| 		  G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST,
 | |
| 		  G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, configure_event),
 | |
| 		  _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOXED,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1,
 | |
| 		  GDK_TYPE_EVENT | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::focus-in-event:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal
 | |
|    * @event: (type Gdk.EventFocus): the #GdkEventFocus which triggered
 | |
|    *   this signal.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * The ::focus-in-event signal will be emitted when the keyboard focus
 | |
|    * enters the @widget's window.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * To receive this signal, the #GdkWindow associated to the widget needs
 | |
|    * to enable the #GDK_FOCUS_CHANGE_MASK mask.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event.
 | |
|    *   %FALSE to propagate the event further.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[FOCUS_IN_EVENT] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("focus-in-event"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass),
 | |
| 		  G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST,
 | |
| 		  G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, focus_in_event),
 | |
| 		  _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOXED,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1,
 | |
| 		  GDK_TYPE_EVENT | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::focus-out-event:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal
 | |
|    * @event: (type Gdk.EventFocus): the #GdkEventFocus which triggered this
 | |
|    *   signal.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * The ::focus-out-event signal will be emitted when the keyboard focus
 | |
|    * leaves the @widget's window.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * To receive this signal, the #GdkWindow associated to the widget needs
 | |
|    * to enable the #GDK_FOCUS_CHANGE_MASK mask.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event.
 | |
|    *   %FALSE to propagate the event further.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[FOCUS_OUT_EVENT] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("focus-out-event"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass),
 | |
| 		  G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST,
 | |
| 		  G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, focus_out_event),
 | |
| 		  _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOXED,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1,
 | |
| 		  GDK_TYPE_EVENT | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::map-event:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal
 | |
|    * @event: (type Gdk.EventAny): the #GdkEventAny which triggered this signal.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * The ::map-event signal will be emitted when the @widget's window is
 | |
|    * mapped. A window is mapped when it becomes visible on the screen.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * To receive this signal, the #GdkWindow associated to the widget needs
 | |
|    * to enable the #GDK_STRUCTURE_MASK mask. GDK will enable this mask
 | |
|    * automatically for all new windows.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event.
 | |
|    *   %FALSE to propagate the event further.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[MAP_EVENT] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("map-event"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass),
 | |
| 		  G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST,
 | |
| 		  G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, map_event),
 | |
| 		  _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOXED,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1,
 | |
| 		  GDK_TYPE_EVENT | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::unmap-event:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal
 | |
|    * @event: (type Gdk.EventAny): the #GdkEventAny which triggered this signal
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * The ::unmap-event signal will be emitted when the @widget's window is
 | |
|    * unmapped. A window is unmapped when it becomes invisible on the screen.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * To receive this signal, the #GdkWindow associated to the widget needs
 | |
|    * to enable the #GDK_STRUCTURE_MASK mask. GDK will enable this mask
 | |
|    * automatically for all new windows.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event.
 | |
|    *   %FALSE to propagate the event further.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[UNMAP_EVENT] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("unmap-event"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass),
 | |
| 		  G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST,
 | |
| 		  G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, unmap_event),
 | |
| 		  _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOXED,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1,
 | |
| 		  GDK_TYPE_EVENT | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::property-notify-event:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal
 | |
|    * @event: (type Gdk.EventProperty): the #GdkEventProperty which triggered
 | |
|    *   this signal.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * The ::property-notify-event signal will be emitted when a property on
 | |
|    * the @widget's window has been changed or deleted.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * To receive this signal, the #GdkWindow associated to the widget needs
 | |
|    * to enable the #GDK_PROPERTY_CHANGE_MASK mask.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event.
 | |
|    *   %FALSE to propagate the event further.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[PROPERTY_NOTIFY_EVENT] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("property-notify-event"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass),
 | |
| 		  G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST,
 | |
| 		  G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, property_notify_event),
 | |
| 		  _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOXED,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1,
 | |
| 		  GDK_TYPE_EVENT | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::selection-clear-event:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal
 | |
|    * @event: (type Gdk.EventSelection): the #GdkEventSelection which triggered
 | |
|    *   this signal.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * The ::selection-clear-event signal will be emitted when the
 | |
|    * the @widget's window has lost ownership of a selection.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event.
 | |
|    *   %FALSE to propagate the event further.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("selection-clear-event"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass),
 | |
| 		  G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST,
 | |
| 		  G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, selection_clear_event),
 | |
| 		  _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOXED,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1,
 | |
| 		  GDK_TYPE_EVENT | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::selection-request-event:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal
 | |
|    * @event: (type Gdk.EventSelection): the #GdkEventSelection which triggered
 | |
|    *   this signal.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * The ::selection-request-event signal will be emitted when
 | |
|    * another client requests ownership of the selection owned by
 | |
|    * the @widget's window.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event.
 | |
|    *   %FALSE to propagate the event further.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("selection-request-event"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass),
 | |
| 		  G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST,
 | |
| 		  G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, selection_request_event),
 | |
| 		  _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOXED,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1,
 | |
| 		  GDK_TYPE_EVENT | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::selection-notify-event:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal.
 | |
|    * @event: (type Gdk.EventSelection):
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event. %FALSE to propagate the event further.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[SELECTION_NOTIFY_EVENT] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("selection-notify-event"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass),
 | |
| 		  G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST,
 | |
| 		  G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, selection_notify_event),
 | |
| 		  _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOXED,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1,
 | |
| 		  GDK_TYPE_EVENT | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::selection-received:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal.
 | |
|    * @data:
 | |
|    * @time:
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[SELECTION_RECEIVED] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("selection-received"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass),
 | |
| 		  G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST,
 | |
| 		  G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, selection_received),
 | |
| 		  NULL, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_VOID__BOXED_UINT,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_NONE, 2,
 | |
| 		  GTK_TYPE_SELECTION_DATA | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_UINT);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::selection-get:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal.
 | |
|    * @data:
 | |
|    * @info:
 | |
|    * @time:
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[SELECTION_GET] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("selection-get"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass),
 | |
| 		  G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST,
 | |
| 		  G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, selection_get),
 | |
| 		  NULL, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_VOID__BOXED_UINT_UINT,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_NONE, 3,
 | |
| 		  GTK_TYPE_SELECTION_DATA | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_UINT,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_UINT);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::proximity-in-event:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal
 | |
|    * @event: (type Gdk.EventProximity): the #GdkEventProximity which triggered
 | |
|    *   this signal.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * To receive this signal the #GdkWindow associated to the widget needs
 | |
|    * to enable the #GDK_PROXIMITY_IN_MASK mask.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * This signal will be sent to the grab widget if there is one.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event.
 | |
|    *   %FALSE to propagate the event further.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[PROXIMITY_IN_EVENT] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("proximity-in-event"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass),
 | |
| 		  G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST,
 | |
| 		  G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, proximity_in_event),
 | |
| 		  _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOXED,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1,
 | |
| 		  GDK_TYPE_EVENT | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::proximity-out-event:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal
 | |
|    * @event: (type Gdk.EventProximity): the #GdkEventProximity which triggered
 | |
|    *   this signal.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * To receive this signal the #GdkWindow associated to the widget needs
 | |
|    * to enable the #GDK_PROXIMITY_OUT_MASK mask.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * This signal will be sent to the grab widget if there is one.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event.
 | |
|    *   %FALSE to propagate the event further.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[PROXIMITY_OUT_EVENT] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("proximity-out-event"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass),
 | |
| 		  G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST,
 | |
| 		  G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, proximity_out_event),
 | |
| 		  _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOXED,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1,
 | |
| 		  GDK_TYPE_EVENT | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::drag-leave:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal.
 | |
|    * @drag_context: the drag context
 | |
|    * @time: the timestamp of the motion event
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * The ::drag-leave signal is emitted on the drop site when the cursor
 | |
|    * leaves the widget. A typical reason to connect to this signal is to
 | |
|    * undo things done in #GtkWidget::drag-motion, e.g. undo highlighting
 | |
|    * with gtk_drag_unhighlight()
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[DRAG_LEAVE] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("drag-leave"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass),
 | |
| 		  G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST,
 | |
| 		  G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, drag_leave),
 | |
| 		  NULL, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_VOID__OBJECT_UINT,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_NONE, 2,
 | |
| 		  GDK_TYPE_DRAG_CONTEXT,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_UINT);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::drag-begin:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal
 | |
|    * @drag_context: the drag context
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * The ::drag-begin signal is emitted on the drag source when a drag is
 | |
|    * started. A typical reason to connect to this signal is to set up a
 | |
|    * custom drag icon with gtk_drag_source_set_icon().
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Note that some widgets set up a drag icon in the default handler of
 | |
|    * this signal, so you may have to use g_signal_connect_after() to
 | |
|    * override what the default handler did.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[DRAG_BEGIN] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("drag-begin"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass),
 | |
| 		  G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST,
 | |
| 		  G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, drag_begin),
 | |
| 		  NULL, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_VOID__OBJECT,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_NONE, 1,
 | |
| 		  GDK_TYPE_DRAG_CONTEXT);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::drag-end:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal
 | |
|    * @drag_context: the drag context
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * The ::drag-end signal is emitted on the drag source when a drag is
 | |
|    * finished.  A typical reason to connect to this signal is to undo
 | |
|    * things done in #GtkWidget::drag-begin.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[DRAG_END] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("drag-end"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass),
 | |
| 		  G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST,
 | |
| 		  G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, drag_end),
 | |
| 		  NULL, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_VOID__OBJECT,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_NONE, 1,
 | |
| 		  GDK_TYPE_DRAG_CONTEXT);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::drag-data-delete:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal
 | |
|    * @drag_context: the drag context
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * The ::drag-data-delete signal is emitted on the drag source when a drag
 | |
|    * with the action %GDK_ACTION_MOVE is successfully completed. The signal
 | |
|    * handler is responsible for deleting the data that has been dropped. What
 | |
|    * "delete" means depends on the context of the drag operation.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[DRAG_DATA_DELETE] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("drag-data-delete"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass),
 | |
| 		  G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST,
 | |
| 		  G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, drag_data_delete),
 | |
| 		  NULL, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_VOID__OBJECT,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_NONE, 1,
 | |
| 		  GDK_TYPE_DRAG_CONTEXT);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::drag-failed:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal
 | |
|    * @drag_context: the drag context
 | |
|    * @result: the result of the drag operation
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * The ::drag-failed signal is emitted on the drag source when a drag has
 | |
|    * failed. The signal handler may hook custom code to handle a failed DND
 | |
|    * operation based on the type of error, it returns %TRUE is the failure has
 | |
|    * been already handled (not showing the default "drag operation failed"
 | |
|    * animation), otherwise it returns %FALSE.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Return value: %TRUE if the failed drag operation has been already handled.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Since: 2.12
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[DRAG_FAILED] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("drag-failed"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass),
 | |
| 		  G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST,
 | |
| 		  G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, drag_failed),
 | |
| 		  _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__OBJECT_ENUM,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 2,
 | |
| 		  GDK_TYPE_DRAG_CONTEXT,
 | |
| 		  GTK_TYPE_DRAG_RESULT);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::drag-motion:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal
 | |
|    * @drag_context: the drag context
 | |
|    * @x: the x coordinate of the current cursor position
 | |
|    * @y: the y coordinate of the current cursor position
 | |
|    * @time: the timestamp of the motion event
 | |
|    * @returns: whether the cursor position is in a drop zone
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * The drag-motion signal is emitted on the drop site when the user
 | |
|    * moves the cursor over the widget during a drag. The signal handler
 | |
|    * must determine whether the cursor position is in a drop zone or not.
 | |
|    * If it is not in a drop zone, it returns %FALSE and no further processing
 | |
|    * is necessary. Otherwise, the handler returns %TRUE. In this case, the
 | |
|    * handler is responsible for providing the necessary information for
 | |
|    * displaying feedback to the user, by calling gdk_drag_status().
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * If the decision whether the drop will be accepted or rejected can't be
 | |
|    * made based solely on the cursor position and the type of the data, the
 | |
|    * handler may inspect the dragged data by calling gtk_drag_get_data() and
 | |
|    * defer the gdk_drag_status() call to the #GtkWidget::drag-data-received
 | |
|    * handler. Note that you cannot not pass #GTK_DEST_DEFAULT_DROP,
 | |
|    * #GTK_DEST_DEFAULT_MOTION or #GTK_DEST_DEFAULT_ALL to gtk_drag_dest_set()
 | |
|    * when using the drag-motion signal that way.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Also note that there is no drag-enter signal. The drag receiver has to
 | |
|    * keep track of whether he has received any drag-motion signals since the
 | |
|    * last #GtkWidget::drag-leave and if not, treat the drag-motion signal as
 | |
|    * an "enter" signal. Upon an "enter", the handler will typically highlight
 | |
|    * the drop site with gtk_drag_highlight().
 | |
|    * |[
 | |
|    * static void
 | |
|    * drag_motion (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|    *              GdkDragContext *context,
 | |
|    *              gint x,
 | |
|    *              gint y,
 | |
|    *              guint time)
 | |
|    * {
 | |
|    *   GdkAtom target;
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    *   PrivateData *private_data = GET_PRIVATE_DATA (widget);
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    *   if (!private_data->drag_highlight)
 | |
|    *    {
 | |
|    *      private_data->drag_highlight = 1;
 | |
|    *      gtk_drag_highlight (widget);
 | |
|    *    }
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    *   target = gtk_drag_dest_find_target (widget, context, NULL);
 | |
|    *   if (target == GDK_NONE)
 | |
|    *     gdk_drag_status (context, 0, time);
 | |
|    *   else
 | |
|    *    {
 | |
|    *      private_data->pending_status = context->suggested_action;
 | |
|    *      gtk_drag_get_data (widget, context, target, time);
 | |
|    *    }
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    *   return TRUE;
 | |
|    * }
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * static void
 | |
|    * drag_data_received (GtkWidget        *widget,
 | |
|    *                     GdkDragContext   *context,
 | |
|    *                     gint              x,
 | |
|    *                     gint              y,
 | |
|    *                     GtkSelectionData *selection_data,
 | |
|    *                     guint             info,
 | |
|    *                     guint             time)
 | |
|    * {
 | |
|    *   PrivateData *private_data = GET_PRIVATE_DATA (widget);
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    *   if (private_data->suggested_action)
 | |
|    *    {
 | |
|    *      private_data->suggested_action = 0;
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    *     /* We are getting this data due to a request in drag_motion,
 | |
|    *      * rather than due to a request in drag_drop, so we are just
 | |
|    *      * supposed to call gdk_drag_status (), not actually paste in
 | |
|    *      * the data.
 | |
|    *      */
 | |
|    *      str = gtk_selection_data_get_text (selection_data);
 | |
|    *      if (!data_is_acceptable (str))
 | |
|    *        gdk_drag_status (context, 0, time);
 | |
|    *      else
 | |
|    *        gdk_drag_status (context, private_data->suggested_action, time);
 | |
|    *    }
 | |
|    *   else
 | |
|    *    {
 | |
|    *      /* accept the drop */
 | |
|    *    }
 | |
|    * }
 | |
|    * ]|
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[DRAG_MOTION] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("drag-motion"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass),
 | |
| 		  G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST,
 | |
| 		  G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, drag_motion),
 | |
| 		  _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__OBJECT_INT_INT_UINT,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 4,
 | |
| 		  GDK_TYPE_DRAG_CONTEXT,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_INT,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_INT,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_UINT);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::drag-drop:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal
 | |
|    * @drag_context: the drag context
 | |
|    * @x: the x coordinate of the current cursor position
 | |
|    * @y: the y coordinate of the current cursor position
 | |
|    * @time: the timestamp of the motion event
 | |
|    * @returns: whether the cursor position is in a drop zone
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * The ::drag-drop signal is emitted on the drop site when the user drops
 | |
|    * the data onto the widget. The signal handler must determine whether
 | |
|    * the cursor position is in a drop zone or not. If it is not in a drop
 | |
|    * zone, it returns %FALSE and no further processing is necessary.
 | |
|    * Otherwise, the handler returns %TRUE. In this case, the handler must
 | |
|    * ensure that gtk_drag_finish() is called to let the source know that
 | |
|    * the drop is done. The call to gtk_drag_finish() can be done either
 | |
|    * directly or in a #GtkWidget::drag-data-received handler which gets
 | |
|    * triggered by calling gtk_drag_get_data() to receive the data for one
 | |
|    * or more of the supported targets.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[DRAG_DROP] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("drag-drop"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass),
 | |
| 		  G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST,
 | |
| 		  G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, drag_drop),
 | |
| 		  _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__OBJECT_INT_INT_UINT,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 4,
 | |
| 		  GDK_TYPE_DRAG_CONTEXT,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_INT,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_INT,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_UINT);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::drag-data-get:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal
 | |
|    * @drag_context: the drag context
 | |
|    * @data: the #GtkSelectionData to be filled with the dragged data
 | |
|    * @info: the info that has been registered with the target in the
 | |
|    *        #GtkTargetList
 | |
|    * @time: the timestamp at which the data was requested
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * The ::drag-data-get signal is emitted on the drag source when the drop
 | |
|    * site requests the data which is dragged. It is the responsibility of
 | |
|    * the signal handler to fill @data with the data in the format which
 | |
|    * is indicated by @info. See gtk_selection_data_set() and
 | |
|    * gtk_selection_data_set_text().
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[DRAG_DATA_GET] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("drag-data-get"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass),
 | |
| 		  G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST,
 | |
| 		  G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, drag_data_get),
 | |
| 		  NULL, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_VOID__OBJECT_BOXED_UINT_UINT,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_NONE, 4,
 | |
| 		  GDK_TYPE_DRAG_CONTEXT,
 | |
| 		  GTK_TYPE_SELECTION_DATA | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_UINT,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_UINT);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::drag-data-received:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal
 | |
|    * @drag_context: the drag context
 | |
|    * @x: where the drop happened
 | |
|    * @y: where the drop happened
 | |
|    * @data: the received data
 | |
|    * @info: the info that has been registered with the target in the
 | |
|    *        #GtkTargetList
 | |
|    * @time: the timestamp at which the data was received
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * The ::drag-data-received signal is emitted on the drop site when the
 | |
|    * dragged data has been received. If the data was received in order to
 | |
|    * determine whether the drop will be accepted, the handler is expected
 | |
|    * to call gdk_drag_status() and <emphasis>not</emphasis> finish the drag.
 | |
|    * If the data was received in response to a #GtkWidget::drag-drop signal
 | |
|    * (and this is the last target to be received), the handler for this
 | |
|    * signal is expected to process the received data and then call
 | |
|    * gtk_drag_finish(), setting the @success parameter depending on whether
 | |
|    * the data was processed successfully.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * The handler may inspect and modify @drag_context->action before calling
 | |
|    * gtk_drag_finish(), e.g. to implement %GDK_ACTION_ASK as shown in the
 | |
|    * following example:
 | |
|    * |[
 | |
|    * void
 | |
|    * drag_data_received (GtkWidget          *widget,
 | |
|    *                     GdkDragContext     *drag_context,
 | |
|    *                     gint                x,
 | |
|    *                     gint                y,
 | |
|    *                     GtkSelectionData   *data,
 | |
|    *                     guint               info,
 | |
|    *                     guint               time)
 | |
|    * {
 | |
|    *   if ((data->length >= 0) && (data->format == 8))
 | |
|    *     {
 | |
|    *       if (drag_context->action == GDK_ACTION_ASK)
 | |
|    *         {
 | |
|    *           GtkWidget *dialog;
 | |
|    *           gint response;
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    *           dialog = gtk_message_dialog_new (NULL,
 | |
|    *                                            GTK_DIALOG_MODAL |
 | |
|    *                                            GTK_DIALOG_DESTROY_WITH_PARENT,
 | |
|    *                                            GTK_MESSAGE_INFO,
 | |
|    *                                            GTK_BUTTONS_YES_NO,
 | |
|    *                                            "Move the data ?\n");
 | |
|    *           response = gtk_dialog_run (GTK_DIALOG (dialog));
 | |
|    *           gtk_widget_destroy (dialog);
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    *           if (response == GTK_RESPONSE_YES)
 | |
|    *             drag_context->action = GDK_ACTION_MOVE;
 | |
|    *           else
 | |
|    *             drag_context->action = GDK_ACTION_COPY;
 | |
|    *          }
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    *       gtk_drag_finish (drag_context, TRUE, FALSE, time);
 | |
|    *       return;
 | |
|    *     }
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    *    gtk_drag_finish (drag_context, FALSE, FALSE, time);
 | |
|    *  }
 | |
|    * ]|
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[DRAG_DATA_RECEIVED] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("drag-data-received"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass),
 | |
| 		  G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST,
 | |
| 		  G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, drag_data_received),
 | |
| 		  NULL, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_VOID__OBJECT_INT_INT_BOXED_UINT_UINT,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_NONE, 6,
 | |
| 		  GDK_TYPE_DRAG_CONTEXT,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_INT,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_INT,
 | |
| 		  GTK_TYPE_SELECTION_DATA | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_UINT,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_UINT);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::visibility-notify-event:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal
 | |
|    * @event: (type Gdk.EventVisibility): the #GdkEventVisibility which
 | |
|    *   triggered this signal.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * The ::visibility-notify-event will be emitted when the @widget's window
 | |
|    * is obscured or unobscured.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * To receive this signal the #GdkWindow associated to the widget needs
 | |
|    * to enable the #GDK_VISIBILITY_NOTIFY_MASK mask.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event.
 | |
|    *   %FALSE to propagate the event further.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[VISIBILITY_NOTIFY_EVENT] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("visibility-notify-event"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass),
 | |
| 		  G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST,
 | |
| 		  G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, visibility_notify_event),
 | |
| 		  _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOXED,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1,
 | |
| 		  GDK_TYPE_EVENT | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::window-state-event:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal
 | |
|    * @event: (type Gdk.EventWindowState): the #GdkEventWindowState which
 | |
|    *   triggered this signal.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * The ::window-state-event will be emitted when the state of the
 | |
|    * toplevel window associated to the @widget changes.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * To receive this signal the #GdkWindow associated to the widget
 | |
|    * needs to enable the #GDK_STRUCTURE_MASK mask. GDK will enable
 | |
|    * this mask automatically for all new windows.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the
 | |
|    *   event. %FALSE to propagate the event further.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[WINDOW_STATE_EVENT] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("window-state-event"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass),
 | |
| 		  G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST,
 | |
| 		  G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, window_state_event),
 | |
| 		  _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOXED,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1,
 | |
| 		  GDK_TYPE_EVENT | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::damage-event:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal
 | |
|    * @event: (type Gdk.EventExpose): the #GdkEventExpose event
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Emitted when a redirected window belonging to @widget gets drawn into.
 | |
|    * The region/area members of the event shows what area of the redirected
 | |
|    * drawable was drawn into.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event.
 | |
|    *   %FALSE to propagate the event further.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Since: 2.14
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[DAMAGE_EVENT] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("damage-event"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass),
 | |
| 		  G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST,
 | |
| 		  G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, damage_event),
 | |
| 		  _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOXED,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1,
 | |
| 		  GDK_TYPE_EVENT | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE);
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::grab-broken-event:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal
 | |
|    * @event: (type Gdk.EventGrabBroken): the #GdkEventGrabBroken event
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Emitted when a pointer or keyboard grab on a window belonging
 | |
|    * to @widget gets broken.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * On X11, this happens when the grab window becomes unviewable
 | |
|    * (i.e. it or one of its ancestors is unmapped), or if the same
 | |
|    * application grabs the pointer or keyboard again.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for
 | |
|    *   the event. %FALSE to propagate the event further.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Since: 2.8
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[GRAB_BROKEN_EVENT] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("grab-broken-event"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass),
 | |
| 		  G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST,
 | |
| 		  G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, grab_broken_event),
 | |
| 		  _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOXED,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1,
 | |
| 		  GDK_TYPE_EVENT | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::query-tooltip:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal
 | |
|    * @x: the x coordinate of the cursor position where the request has
 | |
|    *     been emitted, relative to @widget's left side
 | |
|    * @y: the y coordinate of the cursor position where the request has
 | |
|    *     been emitted, relative to @widget's top
 | |
|    * @keyboard_mode: %TRUE if the tooltip was trigged using the keyboard
 | |
|    * @tooltip: a #GtkTooltip
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Emitted when #GtkWidget:has-tooltip is %TRUE and the #GtkSettings:gtk-tooltip-timeout
 | |
|    * has expired with the cursor hovering "above" @widget; or emitted when @widget got
 | |
|    * focus in keyboard mode.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Using the given coordinates, the signal handler should determine
 | |
|    * whether a tooltip should be shown for @widget. If this is the case
 | |
|    * %TRUE should be returned, %FALSE otherwise.  Note that if
 | |
|    * @keyboard_mode is %TRUE, the values of @x and @y are undefined and
 | |
|    * should not be used.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * The signal handler is free to manipulate @tooltip with the therefore
 | |
|    * destined function calls.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Returns: %TRUE if @tooltip should be shown right now, %FALSE otherwise.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Since: 2.12
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[QUERY_TOOLTIP] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("query-tooltip"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass),
 | |
| 		  G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST,
 | |
| 		  G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, query_tooltip),
 | |
| 		  _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__INT_INT_BOOLEAN_OBJECT,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 4,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_INT,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_INT,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_BOOLEAN,
 | |
| 		  GTK_TYPE_TOOLTIP);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::popup-menu
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * This signal gets emitted whenever a widget should pop up a context
 | |
|    * menu. This usually happens through the standard key binding mechanism;
 | |
|    * by pressing a certain key while a widget is focused, the user can cause
 | |
|    * the widget to pop up a menu.  For example, the #GtkEntry widget creates
 | |
|    * a menu with clipboard commands. See <xref linkend="checklist-popup-menu"/>
 | |
|    * for an example of how to use this signal.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Returns: %TRUE if a menu was activated
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[POPUP_MENU] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("popup-menu"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass),
 | |
| 		  G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST | G_SIGNAL_ACTION,
 | |
| 		  G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, popup_menu),
 | |
| 		  _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__VOID,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 0);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::show-help:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal.
 | |
|    * @help_type:
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[SHOW_HELP] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("show-help"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass),
 | |
| 		  G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST | G_SIGNAL_ACTION,
 | |
| 		  G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, show_help),
 | |
| 		  _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__ENUM,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1,
 | |
| 		  GTK_TYPE_WIDGET_HELP_TYPE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::accel-closures-changed:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[ACCEL_CLOSURES_CHANGED] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("accel-closures-changed"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass),
 | |
| 		  0,
 | |
| 		  0,
 | |
| 		  NULL, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_VOID__VOID,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_NONE, 0);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::screen-changed:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object on which the signal is emitted
 | |
|    * @previous_screen: (allow-none): the previous screen, or %NULL if the
 | |
|    *   widget was not associated with a screen before
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * The ::screen-changed signal gets emitted when the
 | |
|    * screen of a widget has changed.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[SCREEN_CHANGED] =
 | |
|     g_signal_new (I_("screen-changed"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass),
 | |
| 		  G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST,
 | |
| 		  G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, screen_changed),
 | |
| 		  NULL, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_VOID__OBJECT,
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_NONE, 1,
 | |
| 		  GDK_TYPE_SCREEN);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget::can-activate-accel:
 | |
|    * @widget: the object which received the signal
 | |
|    * @signal_id: the ID of a signal installed on @widget
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Determines whether an accelerator that activates the signal
 | |
|    * identified by @signal_id can currently be activated.
 | |
|    * This signal is present to allow applications and derived
 | |
|    * widgets to override the default #GtkWidget handling
 | |
|    * for determining whether an accelerator can be activated.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Returns: %TRUE if the signal can be activated.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   widget_signals[CAN_ACTIVATE_ACCEL] =
 | |
|      g_signal_new (I_("can-activate-accel"),
 | |
| 		  G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass),
 | |
| 		  G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST,
 | |
| 		  G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, can_activate_accel),
 | |
|                   _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL,
 | |
| 		  _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__UINT,
 | |
|                   G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, G_TYPE_UINT);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   binding_set = gtk_binding_set_by_class (klass);
 | |
|   gtk_binding_entry_add_signal (binding_set, GDK_KEY_F10, GDK_SHIFT_MASK,
 | |
|                                 "popup-menu", 0);
 | |
|   gtk_binding_entry_add_signal (binding_set, GDK_KEY_Menu, 0,
 | |
|                                 "popup-menu", 0);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gtk_binding_entry_add_signal (binding_set, GDK_KEY_F1, GDK_CONTROL_MASK,
 | |
|                                 "show-help", 1,
 | |
|                                 GTK_TYPE_WIDGET_HELP_TYPE,
 | |
|                                 GTK_WIDGET_HELP_TOOLTIP);
 | |
|   gtk_binding_entry_add_signal (binding_set, GDK_KEY_KP_F1, GDK_CONTROL_MASK,
 | |
|                                 "show-help", 1,
 | |
|                                 GTK_TYPE_WIDGET_HELP_TYPE,
 | |
|                                 GTK_WIDGET_HELP_TOOLTIP);
 | |
|   gtk_binding_entry_add_signal (binding_set, GDK_KEY_F1, GDK_SHIFT_MASK,
 | |
|                                 "show-help", 1,
 | |
|                                 GTK_TYPE_WIDGET_HELP_TYPE,
 | |
|                                 GTK_WIDGET_HELP_WHATS_THIS);
 | |
|   gtk_binding_entry_add_signal (binding_set, GDK_KEY_KP_F1, GDK_SHIFT_MASK,
 | |
|                                 "show-help", 1,
 | |
|                                 GTK_TYPE_WIDGET_HELP_TYPE,
 | |
|                                 GTK_WIDGET_HELP_WHATS_THIS);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gtk_widget_class_install_style_property (klass,
 | |
| 					   g_param_spec_boolean ("interior-focus",
 | |
| 								 P_("Interior Focus"),
 | |
| 								 P_("Whether to draw the focus indicator inside widgets"),
 | |
| 								 TRUE,
 | |
| 								 GTK_PARAM_READABLE));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gtk_widget_class_install_style_property (klass,
 | |
| 					   g_param_spec_int ("focus-line-width",
 | |
| 							     P_("Focus linewidth"),
 | |
| 							     P_("Width, in pixels, of the focus indicator line"),
 | |
| 							     0, G_MAXINT, 1,
 | |
| 							     GTK_PARAM_READABLE));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gtk_widget_class_install_style_property (klass,
 | |
| 					   g_param_spec_string ("focus-line-pattern",
 | |
| 								P_("Focus line dash pattern"),
 | |
| 								P_("Dash pattern used to draw the focus indicator"),
 | |
| 								"\1\1",
 | |
| 								GTK_PARAM_READABLE));
 | |
|   gtk_widget_class_install_style_property (klass,
 | |
| 					   g_param_spec_int ("focus-padding",
 | |
| 							     P_("Focus padding"),
 | |
| 							     P_("Width, in pixels, between focus indicator and the widget 'box'"),
 | |
| 							     0, G_MAXINT, 1,
 | |
| 							     GTK_PARAM_READABLE));
 | |
|   gtk_widget_class_install_style_property (klass,
 | |
| 					   g_param_spec_boxed ("cursor-color",
 | |
| 							       P_("Cursor color"),
 | |
| 							       P_("Color with which to draw insertion cursor"),
 | |
| 							       GDK_TYPE_COLOR,
 | |
| 							       GTK_PARAM_READABLE));
 | |
|   gtk_widget_class_install_style_property (klass,
 | |
| 					   g_param_spec_boxed ("secondary-cursor-color",
 | |
| 							       P_("Secondary cursor color"),
 | |
| 							       P_("Color with which to draw the secondary insertion cursor when editing mixed right-to-left and left-to-right text"),
 | |
| 							       GDK_TYPE_COLOR,
 | |
| 							       GTK_PARAM_READABLE));
 | |
|   gtk_widget_class_install_style_property (klass,
 | |
| 					   g_param_spec_float ("cursor-aspect-ratio",
 | |
| 							       P_("Cursor line aspect ratio"),
 | |
| 							       P_("Aspect ratio with which to draw insertion cursor"),
 | |
| 							       0.0, 1.0, 0.04,
 | |
| 							       GTK_PARAM_READABLE));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gtk_widget_class_install_style_property (klass,
 | |
|                                            g_param_spec_boolean ("window-dragging",
 | |
|                                                                  P_("Window dragging"),
 | |
|                                                                  P_("Whether windows can be dragged by clicking on empty areas"),
 | |
|                                                                  FALSE,
 | |
|                                                                  GTK_PARAM_READABLE));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget:link-color:
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * The "link-color" style property defines the color of unvisited links.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Since: 2.10
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   gtk_widget_class_install_style_property (klass,
 | |
| 					   g_param_spec_boxed ("link-color",
 | |
| 							       P_("Unvisited Link Color"),
 | |
| 							       P_("Color of unvisited links"),
 | |
| 							       GDK_TYPE_COLOR,
 | |
| 							       GTK_PARAM_READABLE));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget:visited-link-color:
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * The "visited-link-color" style property defines the color of visited links.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Since: 2.10
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   gtk_widget_class_install_style_property (klass,
 | |
| 					   g_param_spec_boxed ("visited-link-color",
 | |
| 							       P_("Visited Link Color"),
 | |
| 							       P_("Color of visited links"),
 | |
| 							       GDK_TYPE_COLOR,
 | |
| 							       GTK_PARAM_READABLE));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget:wide-separators:
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * The "wide-separators" style property defines whether separators have
 | |
|    * configurable width and should be drawn using a box instead of a line.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Since: 2.10
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   gtk_widget_class_install_style_property (klass,
 | |
|                                            g_param_spec_boolean ("wide-separators",
 | |
|                                                                  P_("Wide Separators"),
 | |
|                                                                  P_("Whether separators have configurable width and should be drawn using a box instead of a line"),
 | |
|                                                                  FALSE,
 | |
|                                                                  GTK_PARAM_READABLE));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget:separator-width:
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * The "separator-width" style property defines the width of separators.
 | |
|    * This property only takes effect if #GtkWidget:wide-separators is %TRUE.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Since: 2.10
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   gtk_widget_class_install_style_property (klass,
 | |
|                                            g_param_spec_int ("separator-width",
 | |
|                                                              P_("Separator Width"),
 | |
|                                                              P_("The width of separators if wide-separators is TRUE"),
 | |
|                                                              0, G_MAXINT, 0,
 | |
|                                                              GTK_PARAM_READABLE));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget:separator-height:
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * The "separator-height" style property defines the height of separators.
 | |
|    * This property only takes effect if #GtkWidget:wide-separators is %TRUE.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Since: 2.10
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   gtk_widget_class_install_style_property (klass,
 | |
|                                            g_param_spec_int ("separator-height",
 | |
|                                                              P_("Separator Height"),
 | |
|                                                              P_("The height of separators if \"wide-separators\" is TRUE"),
 | |
|                                                              0, G_MAXINT, 0,
 | |
|                                                              GTK_PARAM_READABLE));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget:scroll-arrow-hlength:
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * The "scroll-arrow-hlength" style property defines the length of
 | |
|    * horizontal scroll arrows.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Since: 2.10
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   gtk_widget_class_install_style_property (klass,
 | |
|                                            g_param_spec_int ("scroll-arrow-hlength",
 | |
|                                                              P_("Horizontal Scroll Arrow Length"),
 | |
|                                                              P_("The length of horizontal scroll arrows"),
 | |
|                                                              1, G_MAXINT, 16,
 | |
|                                                              GTK_PARAM_READABLE));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /**
 | |
|    * GtkWidget:scroll-arrow-vlength:
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * The "scroll-arrow-vlength" style property defines the length of
 | |
|    * vertical scroll arrows.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * Since: 2.10
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   gtk_widget_class_install_style_property (klass,
 | |
|                                            g_param_spec_int ("scroll-arrow-vlength",
 | |
|                                                              P_("Vertical Scroll Arrow Length"),
 | |
|                                                              P_("The length of vertical scroll arrows"),
 | |
|                                                              1, G_MAXINT, 16,
 | |
|                                                              GTK_PARAM_READABLE));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_type_class_add_private (klass, sizeof (GtkWidgetPrivate));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gtk_widget_class_set_accessible_type (klass, GTK_TYPE_WIDGET_ACCESSIBLE);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_base_class_finalize (GtkWidgetClass *klass)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GList *list, *node;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   list = g_param_spec_pool_list_owned (style_property_spec_pool, G_OBJECT_CLASS_TYPE (klass));
 | |
|   for (node = list; node; node = node->next)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       GParamSpec *pspec = node->data;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       g_param_spec_pool_remove (style_property_spec_pool, pspec);
 | |
|       g_param_spec_unref (pspec);
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   g_list_free (list);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_set_property (GObject         *object,
 | |
| 			 guint            prop_id,
 | |
| 			 const GValue    *value,
 | |
| 			 GParamSpec      *pspec)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidget *widget = GTK_WIDGET (object);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   switch (prop_id)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       gboolean tmp;
 | |
|       gchar *tooltip_markup;
 | |
|       const gchar *tooltip_text;
 | |
|       GtkWindow *tooltip_window;
 | |
| 
 | |
|     case PROP_NAME:
 | |
|       gtk_widget_set_name (widget, g_value_get_string (value));
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_PARENT:
 | |
|       gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (g_value_get_object (value)), widget);
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_WIDTH_REQUEST:
 | |
|       gtk_widget_set_usize_internal (widget, g_value_get_int (value), -2, 0);
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_HEIGHT_REQUEST:
 | |
|       gtk_widget_set_usize_internal (widget, -2, g_value_get_int (value), 0);
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_VISIBLE:
 | |
|       gtk_widget_set_visible (widget, g_value_get_boolean (value));
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_SENSITIVE:
 | |
|       gtk_widget_set_sensitive (widget, g_value_get_boolean (value));
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_APP_PAINTABLE:
 | |
|       gtk_widget_set_app_paintable (widget, g_value_get_boolean (value));
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_CAN_FOCUS:
 | |
|       gtk_widget_set_can_focus (widget, g_value_get_boolean (value));
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_HAS_FOCUS:
 | |
|       if (g_value_get_boolean (value))
 | |
| 	gtk_widget_grab_focus (widget);
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_IS_FOCUS:
 | |
|       if (g_value_get_boolean (value))
 | |
| 	gtk_widget_grab_focus (widget);
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_CAN_DEFAULT:
 | |
|       gtk_widget_set_can_default (widget, g_value_get_boolean (value));
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_HAS_DEFAULT:
 | |
|       if (g_value_get_boolean (value))
 | |
| 	gtk_widget_grab_default (widget);
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_RECEIVES_DEFAULT:
 | |
|       gtk_widget_set_receives_default (widget, g_value_get_boolean (value));
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_STYLE:
 | |
|       gtk_widget_set_style (widget, g_value_get_object (value));
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_EVENTS:
 | |
|       if (!gtk_widget_get_realized (widget) && gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget))
 | |
| 	gtk_widget_set_events (widget, g_value_get_flags (value));
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_NO_SHOW_ALL:
 | |
|       gtk_widget_set_no_show_all (widget, g_value_get_boolean (value));
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_HAS_TOOLTIP:
 | |
|       gtk_widget_real_set_has_tooltip (widget,
 | |
| 				       g_value_get_boolean (value), FALSE);
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_TOOLTIP_MARKUP:
 | |
|       tooltip_window = g_object_get_qdata (object, quark_tooltip_window);
 | |
|       tooltip_markup = g_value_dup_string (value);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       /* Treat an empty string as a NULL string,
 | |
|        * because an empty string would be useless for a tooltip:
 | |
|        */
 | |
|       if (tooltip_markup && (strlen (tooltip_markup) == 0))
 | |
|         {
 | |
| 	  g_free (tooltip_markup);
 | |
|           tooltip_markup = NULL;
 | |
|         }
 | |
| 
 | |
|       g_object_set_qdata_full (object, quark_tooltip_markup,
 | |
| 			       tooltip_markup, g_free);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       tmp = (tooltip_window != NULL || tooltip_markup != NULL);
 | |
|       gtk_widget_real_set_has_tooltip (widget, tmp, FALSE);
 | |
|       if (gtk_widget_get_visible (widget))
 | |
|         gtk_widget_queue_tooltip_query (widget);
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_TOOLTIP_TEXT:
 | |
|       tooltip_window = g_object_get_qdata (object, quark_tooltip_window);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       tooltip_text = g_value_get_string (value);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       /* Treat an empty string as a NULL string,
 | |
|        * because an empty string would be useless for a tooltip:
 | |
|        */
 | |
|       if (tooltip_text && (strlen (tooltip_text) == 0))
 | |
|         tooltip_text = NULL;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       tooltip_markup = tooltip_text ? g_markup_escape_text (tooltip_text, -1) : NULL;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       g_object_set_qdata_full (object, quark_tooltip_markup,
 | |
|                                tooltip_markup, g_free);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       tmp = (tooltip_window != NULL || tooltip_markup != NULL);
 | |
|       gtk_widget_real_set_has_tooltip (widget, tmp, FALSE);
 | |
|       if (gtk_widget_get_visible (widget))
 | |
|         gtk_widget_queue_tooltip_query (widget);
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_DOUBLE_BUFFERED:
 | |
|       gtk_widget_set_double_buffered (widget, g_value_get_boolean (value));
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_HALIGN:
 | |
|       gtk_widget_set_halign (widget, g_value_get_enum (value));
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_VALIGN:
 | |
|       gtk_widget_set_valign (widget, g_value_get_enum (value));
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_MARGIN_LEFT:
 | |
|       gtk_widget_set_margin_left (widget, g_value_get_int (value));
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_MARGIN_RIGHT:
 | |
|       gtk_widget_set_margin_right (widget, g_value_get_int (value));
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_MARGIN_TOP:
 | |
|       gtk_widget_set_margin_top (widget, g_value_get_int (value));
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_MARGIN_BOTTOM:
 | |
|       gtk_widget_set_margin_bottom (widget, g_value_get_int (value));
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_MARGIN:
 | |
|       g_object_freeze_notify (G_OBJECT (widget));
 | |
|       gtk_widget_set_margin_left (widget, g_value_get_int (value));
 | |
|       gtk_widget_set_margin_right (widget, g_value_get_int (value));
 | |
|       gtk_widget_set_margin_top (widget, g_value_get_int (value));
 | |
|       gtk_widget_set_margin_bottom (widget, g_value_get_int (value));
 | |
|       g_object_thaw_notify (G_OBJECT (widget));
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_HEXPAND:
 | |
|       gtk_widget_set_hexpand (widget, g_value_get_boolean (value));
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_HEXPAND_SET:
 | |
|       gtk_widget_set_hexpand_set (widget, g_value_get_boolean (value));
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_VEXPAND:
 | |
|       gtk_widget_set_vexpand (widget, g_value_get_boolean (value));
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_VEXPAND_SET:
 | |
|       gtk_widget_set_vexpand_set (widget, g_value_get_boolean (value));
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_EXPAND:
 | |
|       g_object_freeze_notify (G_OBJECT (widget));
 | |
|       gtk_widget_set_hexpand (widget, g_value_get_boolean (value));
 | |
|       gtk_widget_set_vexpand (widget, g_value_get_boolean (value));
 | |
|       g_object_thaw_notify (G_OBJECT (widget));
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     default:
 | |
|       G_OBJECT_WARN_INVALID_PROPERTY_ID (object, prop_id, pspec);
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_property (GObject         *object,
 | |
| 			 guint            prop_id,
 | |
| 			 GValue          *value,
 | |
| 			 GParamSpec      *pspec)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidget *widget = GTK_WIDGET (object);
 | |
|   GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   switch (prop_id)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       gpointer *eventp;
 | |
| 
 | |
|     case PROP_NAME:
 | |
|       if (priv->name)
 | |
| 	g_value_set_string (value, priv->name);
 | |
|       else
 | |
| 	g_value_set_static_string (value, "");
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_PARENT:
 | |
|       g_value_set_object (value, priv->parent);
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_WIDTH_REQUEST:
 | |
|       {
 | |
|         int w;
 | |
|         gtk_widget_get_size_request (widget, &w, NULL);
 | |
|         g_value_set_int (value, w);
 | |
|       }
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_HEIGHT_REQUEST:
 | |
|       {
 | |
|         int h;
 | |
|         gtk_widget_get_size_request (widget, NULL, &h);
 | |
|         g_value_set_int (value, h);
 | |
|       }
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_VISIBLE:
 | |
|       g_value_set_boolean (value, (gtk_widget_get_visible (widget) != FALSE));
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_SENSITIVE:
 | |
|       g_value_set_boolean (value, (gtk_widget_get_sensitive (widget) != FALSE));
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_APP_PAINTABLE:
 | |
|       g_value_set_boolean (value, (gtk_widget_get_app_paintable (widget) != FALSE));
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_CAN_FOCUS:
 | |
|       g_value_set_boolean (value, (gtk_widget_get_can_focus (widget) != FALSE));
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_HAS_FOCUS:
 | |
|       g_value_set_boolean (value, (gtk_widget_has_focus (widget) != FALSE));
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_IS_FOCUS:
 | |
|       g_value_set_boolean (value, (gtk_widget_is_focus (widget)));
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_CAN_DEFAULT:
 | |
|       g_value_set_boolean (value, (gtk_widget_get_can_default (widget) != FALSE));
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_HAS_DEFAULT:
 | |
|       g_value_set_boolean (value, (gtk_widget_has_default (widget) != FALSE));
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_RECEIVES_DEFAULT:
 | |
|       g_value_set_boolean (value, (gtk_widget_get_receives_default (widget) != FALSE));
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_COMPOSITE_CHILD:
 | |
|       g_value_set_boolean (value, widget->priv->composite_child);
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_STYLE:
 | |
|       g_value_set_object (value, gtk_widget_get_style (widget));
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_EVENTS:
 | |
|       eventp = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_event_mask);
 | |
|       g_value_set_flags (value, GPOINTER_TO_INT (eventp));
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_NO_SHOW_ALL:
 | |
|       g_value_set_boolean (value, gtk_widget_get_no_show_all (widget));
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_HAS_TOOLTIP:
 | |
|       g_value_set_boolean (value, GPOINTER_TO_UINT (g_object_get_qdata (object, quark_has_tooltip)));
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_TOOLTIP_TEXT:
 | |
|       {
 | |
|         gchar *escaped = g_object_get_qdata (object, quark_tooltip_markup);
 | |
|         gchar *text = NULL;
 | |
| 
 | |
|         if (escaped && !pango_parse_markup (escaped, -1, 0, NULL, &text, NULL, NULL))
 | |
|           g_assert (NULL == text); /* text should still be NULL in case of markup errors */
 | |
| 
 | |
|         g_value_take_string (value, text);
 | |
|       }
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_TOOLTIP_MARKUP:
 | |
|       g_value_set_string (value, g_object_get_qdata (object, quark_tooltip_markup));
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_WINDOW:
 | |
|       g_value_set_object (value, gtk_widget_get_window (widget));
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_DOUBLE_BUFFERED:
 | |
|       g_value_set_boolean (value, gtk_widget_get_double_buffered (widget));
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_HALIGN:
 | |
|       g_value_set_enum (value, gtk_widget_get_halign (widget));
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_VALIGN:
 | |
|       g_value_set_enum (value, gtk_widget_get_valign (widget));
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_MARGIN_LEFT:
 | |
|       g_value_set_int (value, gtk_widget_get_margin_left (widget));
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_MARGIN_RIGHT:
 | |
|       g_value_set_int (value, gtk_widget_get_margin_right (widget));
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_MARGIN_TOP:
 | |
|       g_value_set_int (value, gtk_widget_get_margin_top (widget));
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_MARGIN_BOTTOM:
 | |
|       g_value_set_int (value, gtk_widget_get_margin_bottom (widget));
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_MARGIN:
 | |
|       {
 | |
|         GtkWidgetAuxInfo *aux_info = gtk_widget_get_aux_info (widget, FALSE);
 | |
|         if (aux_info == NULL)
 | |
|           {
 | |
|             g_value_set_int (value, 0);
 | |
|           }
 | |
|         else
 | |
|           {
 | |
|             g_value_set_int (value, MAX (MAX (aux_info->margin.left,
 | |
|                                               aux_info->margin.right),
 | |
|                                          MAX (aux_info->margin.top,
 | |
|                                               aux_info->margin.bottom)));
 | |
|           }
 | |
|       }
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_HEXPAND:
 | |
|       g_value_set_boolean (value, gtk_widget_get_hexpand (widget));
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_HEXPAND_SET:
 | |
|       g_value_set_boolean (value, gtk_widget_get_hexpand_set (widget));
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_VEXPAND:
 | |
|       g_value_set_boolean (value, gtk_widget_get_vexpand (widget));
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_VEXPAND_SET:
 | |
|       g_value_set_boolean (value, gtk_widget_get_vexpand_set (widget));
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case PROP_EXPAND:
 | |
|       g_value_set_boolean (value,
 | |
|                            gtk_widget_get_hexpand (widget) &&
 | |
|                            gtk_widget_get_vexpand (widget));
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     default:
 | |
|       G_OBJECT_WARN_INVALID_PROPERTY_ID (object, prop_id, pspec);
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_init (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetPrivate *priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   widget->priv = G_TYPE_INSTANCE_GET_PRIVATE (widget,
 | |
|                                               GTK_TYPE_WIDGET,
 | |
|                                               GtkWidgetPrivate);
 | |
|   priv = widget->priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   priv->child_visible = TRUE;
 | |
|   priv->name = NULL;
 | |
|   priv->allocation.x = -1;
 | |
|   priv->allocation.y = -1;
 | |
|   priv->allocation.width = 1;
 | |
|   priv->allocation.height = 1;
 | |
|   priv->window = NULL;
 | |
|   priv->parent = NULL;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   priv->sensitive = TRUE;
 | |
|   priv->composite_child = composite_child_stack != 0;
 | |
|   priv->double_buffered = TRUE;
 | |
|   priv->redraw_on_alloc = TRUE;
 | |
|   priv->width_request_needed = TRUE;
 | |
|   priv->height_request_needed = TRUE;
 | |
|   priv->alloc_needed = TRUE;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /* this will be set to TRUE if the widget gets a child or if the
 | |
|    * expand flag is set on the widget, but until one of those happen
 | |
|    * we know the expand is already properly FALSE.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * We really want to default FALSE here to avoid computing expand
 | |
|    * all over the place while initially building a widget tree.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   priv->need_compute_expand = FALSE;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   priv->style = gtk_widget_get_default_style ();
 | |
|   g_object_ref (priv->style);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_dispatch_child_properties_changed (GtkWidget   *widget,
 | |
| 					      guint        n_pspecs,
 | |
| 					      GParamSpec **pspecs)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv;
 | |
|   GtkWidget *container = priv->parent;
 | |
|   guint i;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   for (i = 0; widget->priv->parent == container && i < n_pspecs; i++)
 | |
|     g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[CHILD_NOTIFY], g_quark_from_string (pspecs[i]->name), pspecs[i]);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_freeze_child_notify:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Stops emission of #GtkWidget::child-notify signals on @widget. The
 | |
|  * signals are queued until gtk_widget_thaw_child_notify() is called
 | |
|  * on @widget.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * This is the analogue of g_object_freeze_notify() for child properties.
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_freeze_child_notify (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (!G_OBJECT (widget)->ref_count)
 | |
|     return;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_object_ref (widget);
 | |
|   g_object_notify_queue_freeze (G_OBJECT (widget), _gtk_widget_child_property_notify_context);
 | |
|   g_object_unref (widget);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_child_notify:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @child_property: the name of a child property installed on the
 | |
|  *                  class of @widget<!-- -->'s parent
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Emits a #GtkWidget::child-notify signal for the
 | |
|  * <link linkend="child-properties">child property</link> @child_property
 | |
|  * on @widget.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * This is the analogue of g_object_notify() for child properties.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Also see gtk_container_child_notify().
 | |
|  */
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_child_notify (GtkWidget    *widget,
 | |
|                          const gchar  *child_property)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   if (widget->priv->parent == NULL)
 | |
|     return;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gtk_container_child_notify (GTK_CONTAINER (widget->priv->parent), widget, child_property);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_thaw_child_notify:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Reverts the effect of a previous call to gtk_widget_freeze_child_notify().
 | |
|  * This causes all queued #GtkWidget::child-notify signals on @widget to be
 | |
|  * emitted.
 | |
|  */
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_thaw_child_notify (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GObjectNotifyQueue *nqueue;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (!G_OBJECT (widget)->ref_count)
 | |
|     return;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_object_ref (widget);
 | |
|   nqueue = g_object_notify_queue_from_object (G_OBJECT (widget), _gtk_widget_child_property_notify_context);
 | |
|   if (!nqueue || !nqueue->freeze_count)
 | |
|     g_warning (G_STRLOC ": child-property-changed notification for %s(%p) is not frozen",
 | |
| 	       G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget);
 | |
|   else
 | |
|     g_object_notify_queue_thaw (G_OBJECT (widget), nqueue);
 | |
|   g_object_unref (widget);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_new:
 | |
|  * @type: type ID of the widget to create
 | |
|  * @first_property_name: name of first property to set
 | |
|  * @...: value of first property, followed by more properties,
 | |
|  *     %NULL-terminated
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * This is a convenience function for creating a widget and setting
 | |
|  * its properties in one go. For example you might write:
 | |
|  * <literal>gtk_widget_new (GTK_TYPE_LABEL, "label", "Hello World", "xalign",
 | |
|  * 0.0, NULL)</literal> to create a left-aligned label. Equivalent to
 | |
|  * g_object_new(), but returns a widget so you don't have to
 | |
|  * cast the object yourself.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: a new #GtkWidget of type @widget_type
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| GtkWidget*
 | |
| gtk_widget_new (GType        type,
 | |
| 		const gchar *first_property_name,
 | |
| 		...)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidget *widget;
 | |
|   va_list var_args;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (g_type_is_a (type, GTK_TYPE_WIDGET), NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   va_start (var_args, first_property_name);
 | |
|   widget = (GtkWidget *)g_object_new_valist (type, first_property_name, var_args);
 | |
|   va_end (var_args);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return widget;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static inline void
 | |
| gtk_widget_queue_draw_child (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv;
 | |
|   GtkWidget *parent;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   parent = priv->parent;
 | |
|   if (parent && gtk_widget_is_drawable (parent))
 | |
|     gtk_widget_queue_draw_area (parent,
 | |
| 				priv->allocation.x,
 | |
| 				priv->allocation.y,
 | |
| 				priv->allocation.width,
 | |
| 				priv->allocation.height);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_unparent:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * This function is only for use in widget implementations.
 | |
|  * Should be called by implementations of the remove method
 | |
|  * on #GtkContainer, to dissociate a child from the container.
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_unparent (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetPrivate *priv;
 | |
|   GObjectNotifyQueue *nqueue;
 | |
|   GtkWidget *toplevel;
 | |
|   GtkWidget *old_parent;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   priv = widget->priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (priv->parent == NULL)
 | |
|     return;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /* keep this function in sync with gtk_menu_detach() */
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gtk_widget_push_verify_invariants (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_object_freeze_notify (G_OBJECT (widget));
 | |
|   nqueue = g_object_notify_queue_freeze (G_OBJECT (widget), _gtk_widget_child_property_notify_context);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   toplevel = gtk_widget_get_toplevel (widget);
 | |
|   if (gtk_widget_is_toplevel (toplevel))
 | |
|     _gtk_window_unset_focus_and_default (GTK_WINDOW (toplevel), widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (gtk_container_get_focus_child (GTK_CONTAINER (priv->parent)) == widget)
 | |
|     gtk_container_set_focus_child (GTK_CONTAINER (priv->parent), NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gtk_widget_queue_draw_child (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /* Reset the width and height here, to force reallocation if we
 | |
|    * get added back to a new parent. This won't work if our new
 | |
|    * allocation is smaller than 1x1 and we actually want a size of 1x1...
 | |
|    * (would 0x0 be OK here?)
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   priv->allocation.width = 1;
 | |
|   priv->allocation.height = 1;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (gtk_widget_get_realized (widget))
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       if (priv->in_reparent)
 | |
| 	gtk_widget_unmap (widget);
 | |
|       else
 | |
| 	gtk_widget_unrealize (widget);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /* If we are unanchoring the child, we save around the toplevel
 | |
|    * to emit hierarchy changed
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   if (priv->parent->priv->anchored)
 | |
|     g_object_ref (toplevel);
 | |
|   else
 | |
|     toplevel = NULL;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /* Removing a widget from a container restores the child visible
 | |
|    * flag to the default state, so it doesn't affect the child
 | |
|    * in the next parent.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   priv->child_visible = TRUE;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   old_parent = priv->parent;
 | |
|   priv->parent = NULL;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /* parent may no longer expand if the removed
 | |
|    * child was expand=TRUE and could therefore
 | |
|    * be forcing it to.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   if (gtk_widget_get_visible (widget) &&
 | |
|       (priv->need_compute_expand ||
 | |
|        priv->computed_hexpand ||
 | |
|        priv->computed_vexpand))
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       gtk_widget_queue_compute_expand (old_parent);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[PARENT_SET], 0, old_parent);
 | |
|   if (toplevel)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       _gtk_widget_propagate_hierarchy_changed (widget, toplevel);
 | |
|       g_object_unref (toplevel);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /* Now that the parent pointer is nullified and the hierarchy-changed
 | |
|    * already passed, go ahead and unset the parent window, if we are unparenting
 | |
|    * an embeded GtkWindow the window will become toplevel again and hierarchy-changed
 | |
|    * will fire again for the new subhierarchy.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   gtk_widget_set_parent_window (widget, NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), "parent");
 | |
|   g_object_thaw_notify (G_OBJECT (widget));
 | |
|   if (!priv->parent)
 | |
|     g_object_notify_queue_clear (G_OBJECT (widget), nqueue);
 | |
|   g_object_notify_queue_thaw (G_OBJECT (widget), nqueue);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gtk_widget_pop_verify_invariants (widget);
 | |
|   g_object_unref (widget);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_destroy:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Destroys a widget.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * When a widget is
 | |
|  * destroyed, it will break any references it holds to other objects.
 | |
|  * If the widget is inside a container, the widget will be removed
 | |
|  * from the container. If the widget is a toplevel (derived from
 | |
|  * #GtkWindow), it will be removed from the list of toplevels, and the
 | |
|  * reference GTK+ holds to it will be removed. Removing a
 | |
|  * widget from its container or the list of toplevels results in the
 | |
|  * widget being finalized, unless you've added additional references
 | |
|  * to the widget with g_object_ref().
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * In most cases, only toplevel widgets (windows) require explicit
 | |
|  * destruction, because when you destroy a toplevel its children will
 | |
|  * be destroyed as well.
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_destroy (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (!widget->priv->in_destruction)
 | |
|     g_object_run_dispose (G_OBJECT (widget));
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_destroyed:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @widget_pointer: (inout) (transfer none): address of a variable that contains @widget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * This function sets *@widget_pointer to %NULL if @widget_pointer !=
 | |
|  * %NULL.  It's intended to be used as a callback connected to the
 | |
|  * "destroy" signal of a widget. You connect gtk_widget_destroyed()
 | |
|  * as a signal handler, and pass the address of your widget variable
 | |
|  * as user data. Then when the widget is destroyed, the variable will
 | |
|  * be set to %NULL. Useful for example to avoid multiple copies
 | |
|  * of the same dialog.
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_destroyed (GtkWidget      *widget,
 | |
| 		      GtkWidget      **widget_pointer)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   /* Don't make any assumptions about the
 | |
|    *  value of widget!
 | |
|    *  Even check widget_pointer.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   if (widget_pointer)
 | |
|     *widget_pointer = NULL;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_show:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Flags a widget to be displayed. Any widget that isn't shown will
 | |
|  * not appear on the screen. If you want to show all the widgets in a
 | |
|  * container, it's easier to call gtk_widget_show_all() on the
 | |
|  * container, instead of individually showing the widgets.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Remember that you have to show the containers containing a widget,
 | |
|  * in addition to the widget itself, before it will appear onscreen.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * When a toplevel container is shown, it is immediately realized and
 | |
|  * mapped; other shown widgets are realized and mapped when their
 | |
|  * toplevel container is realized and mapped.
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_show (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (!gtk_widget_get_visible (widget))
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       g_object_ref (widget);
 | |
|       gtk_widget_push_verify_invariants (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (!gtk_widget_is_toplevel (widget))
 | |
|         gtk_widget_queue_resize (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       /* see comment in set_parent() for why this should and can be
 | |
|        * conditional
 | |
|        */
 | |
|       if (widget->priv->need_compute_expand ||
 | |
|           widget->priv->computed_hexpand ||
 | |
|           widget->priv->computed_vexpand)
 | |
|         {
 | |
|           if (widget->priv->parent != NULL)
 | |
|             gtk_widget_queue_compute_expand (widget->priv->parent);
 | |
|         }
 | |
| 
 | |
|       g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[SHOW], 0);
 | |
|       g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), "visible");
 | |
| 
 | |
|       gtk_widget_pop_verify_invariants (widget);
 | |
|       g_object_unref (widget);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_real_show (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (!gtk_widget_get_visible (widget))
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       priv->visible = TRUE;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (priv->parent &&
 | |
| 	  gtk_widget_get_mapped (priv->parent) &&
 | |
|           gtk_widget_get_child_visible (widget) &&
 | |
| 	  !gtk_widget_get_mapped (widget))
 | |
| 	gtk_widget_map (widget);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_show_map_callback (GtkWidget *widget, GdkEvent *event, gint *flag)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   *flag = TRUE;
 | |
|   g_signal_handlers_disconnect_by_func (widget,
 | |
| 					gtk_widget_show_map_callback,
 | |
| 					flag);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_show_now:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Shows a widget. If the widget is an unmapped toplevel widget
 | |
|  * (i.e. a #GtkWindow that has not yet been shown), enter the main
 | |
|  * loop and wait for the window to actually be mapped. Be careful;
 | |
|  * because the main loop is running, anything can happen during
 | |
|  * this function.
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_show_now (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   gint flag = FALSE;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /* make sure we will get event */
 | |
|   if (!gtk_widget_get_mapped (widget) &&
 | |
|       gtk_widget_is_toplevel (widget))
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       gtk_widget_show (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       g_signal_connect (widget, "map-event",
 | |
| 			G_CALLBACK (gtk_widget_show_map_callback),
 | |
| 			&flag);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       while (!flag)
 | |
| 	gtk_main_iteration ();
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   else
 | |
|     gtk_widget_show (widget);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_hide:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Reverses the effects of gtk_widget_show(), causing the widget to be
 | |
|  * hidden (invisible to the user).
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_hide (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (gtk_widget_get_visible (widget))
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       GtkWidget *toplevel = gtk_widget_get_toplevel (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       g_object_ref (widget);
 | |
|       gtk_widget_push_verify_invariants (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (toplevel != widget && gtk_widget_is_toplevel (toplevel))
 | |
|         _gtk_window_unset_focus_and_default (GTK_WINDOW (toplevel), widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       /* a parent may now be expand=FALSE since we're hidden. */
 | |
|       if (widget->priv->need_compute_expand ||
 | |
|           widget->priv->computed_hexpand ||
 | |
|           widget->priv->computed_vexpand)
 | |
|         {
 | |
|           gtk_widget_queue_compute_expand (widget);
 | |
|         }
 | |
| 
 | |
|       g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[HIDE], 0);
 | |
|       if (!gtk_widget_is_toplevel (widget))
 | |
| 	gtk_widget_queue_resize (widget);
 | |
|       g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), "visible");
 | |
| 
 | |
|       gtk_widget_pop_verify_invariants (widget);
 | |
|       g_object_unref (widget);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_real_hide (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   if (gtk_widget_get_visible (widget))
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       widget->priv->visible = FALSE;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (gtk_widget_get_mapped (widget))
 | |
| 	gtk_widget_unmap (widget);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_hide_on_delete:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Utility function; intended to be connected to the #GtkWidget::delete-event
 | |
|  * signal on a #GtkWindow. The function calls gtk_widget_hide() on its
 | |
|  * argument, then returns %TRUE. If connected to ::delete-event, the
 | |
|  * result is that clicking the close button for a window (on the
 | |
|  * window frame, top right corner usually) will hide but not destroy
 | |
|  * the window. By default, GTK+ destroys windows when ::delete-event
 | |
|  * is received.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: %TRUE
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| gboolean
 | |
| gtk_widget_hide_on_delete (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gtk_widget_hide (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return TRUE;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_show_all:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Recursively shows a widget, and any child widgets (if the widget is
 | |
|  * a container).
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_show_all (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetClass *class;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (gtk_widget_get_no_show_all (widget))
 | |
|     return;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   class = GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (class->show_all)
 | |
|     class->show_all (widget);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| _gtk_widget_notify_state_change (GtkWidget     *widget,
 | |
|                                  GtkStateFlags  flag,
 | |
|                                  gboolean       target)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkStateType state;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   switch (flag)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|     case GTK_STATE_FLAG_ACTIVE:
 | |
|       state = GTK_STATE_ACTIVE;
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case GTK_STATE_FLAG_PRELIGHT:
 | |
|       state = GTK_STATE_PRELIGHT;
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case GTK_STATE_FLAG_SELECTED:
 | |
|       state = GTK_STATE_SELECTED;
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE:
 | |
|       state = GTK_STATE_INSENSITIVE;
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case GTK_STATE_FLAG_INCONSISTENT:
 | |
|       state = GTK_STATE_INCONSISTENT;
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case GTK_STATE_FLAG_FOCUSED:
 | |
|       state = GTK_STATE_FOCUSED;
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     default:
 | |
|       return;
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gtk_style_context_notify_state_change (widget->priv->context,
 | |
|                                          gtk_widget_get_window (widget),
 | |
|                                          NULL, state, target);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /* Initializes state transitions for those states that
 | |
|  * were enabled before mapping and have a looping animation.
 | |
|  */
 | |
| static void
 | |
| _gtk_widget_start_state_transitions (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkStateFlags state, flag;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (!widget->priv->context)
 | |
|     return;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   state = gtk_widget_get_state_flags (widget);
 | |
|   flag = GTK_STATE_FLAG_FOCUSED;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   while (flag)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       GtkAnimationDescription *animation_desc;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if ((state & flag) == 0)
 | |
|         {
 | |
|           flag >>= 1;
 | |
|           continue;
 | |
|         }
 | |
| 
 | |
|       gtk_style_context_get (widget->priv->context, state,
 | |
|                              "transition", &animation_desc,
 | |
|                              NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (animation_desc)
 | |
|         {
 | |
|           if (_gtk_animation_description_get_loop (animation_desc))
 | |
|             _gtk_widget_notify_state_change (widget, flag, TRUE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|           _gtk_animation_description_unref (animation_desc);
 | |
|         }
 | |
| 
 | |
|       flag >>= 1;
 | |
|     }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_map:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * This function is only for use in widget implementations. Causes
 | |
|  * a widget to be mapped if it isn't already.
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_map (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetPrivate *priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (gtk_widget_get_visible (widget));
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (gtk_widget_get_child_visible (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   priv = widget->priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (!gtk_widget_get_mapped (widget))
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       gtk_widget_push_verify_invariants (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (!gtk_widget_get_realized (widget))
 | |
|         gtk_widget_realize (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[MAP], 0);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (!gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget))
 | |
|         gdk_window_invalidate_rect (priv->window, &priv->allocation, FALSE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       gtk_widget_pop_verify_invariants (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       _gtk_widget_start_state_transitions (widget);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_unmap:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * This function is only for use in widget implementations. Causes
 | |
|  * a widget to be unmapped if it's currently mapped.
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_unmap (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetPrivate *priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   priv = widget->priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (gtk_widget_get_mapped (widget))
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       gtk_widget_push_verify_invariants (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (!gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget))
 | |
| 	gdk_window_invalidate_rect (priv->window, &priv->allocation, FALSE);
 | |
|       _gtk_tooltip_hide (widget);
 | |
|       g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[UNMAP], 0);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       gtk_widget_pop_verify_invariants (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (priv->context)
 | |
|         gtk_style_context_cancel_animations (priv->context, NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       /* Unset pointer/window info */
 | |
|       g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_pointer_window, NULL);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| _gtk_widget_enable_device_events (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GHashTable *device_events;
 | |
|   GHashTableIter iter;
 | |
|   gpointer key, value;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   device_events = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_device_event_mask);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (!device_events)
 | |
|     return;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_hash_table_iter_init (&iter, device_events);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   while (g_hash_table_iter_next (&iter, &key, &value))
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       GdkDevice *device;
 | |
|       GdkEventMask event_mask;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       device = key;
 | |
|       event_mask = GPOINTER_TO_UINT (value);
 | |
|       gtk_widget_add_events_internal (widget, device, event_mask);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static GList *
 | |
| get_widget_windows (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GList *window_list, *last, *l, *children, *ret;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget))
 | |
|     window_list = g_list_prepend (NULL, gtk_widget_get_window (widget));
 | |
|   else
 | |
|     window_list = gdk_window_peek_children (gtk_widget_get_window (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   last = g_list_last (window_list);
 | |
|   ret = NULL;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   for (l = window_list; l; l = l->next)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       GtkWidget *window_widget = NULL;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       gdk_window_get_user_data (l->data, (gpointer *) &window_widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (widget != window_widget)
 | |
|         continue;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       ret = g_list_prepend (ret, l->data);
 | |
|       children = gdk_window_peek_children (GDK_WINDOW (l->data));
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (children)
 | |
|         {
 | |
|           last = g_list_concat (last, children);
 | |
|           last = g_list_last (last);
 | |
|         }
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_list_free (window_list);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return ret;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| device_enable_foreach (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                        gpointer   user_data)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GdkDevice *device = user_data;
 | |
|   gtk_widget_set_device_enabled_internal (widget, device, TRUE, TRUE);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| device_disable_foreach (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                         gpointer   user_data)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GdkDevice *device = user_data;
 | |
|   gtk_widget_set_device_enabled_internal (widget, device, TRUE, FALSE);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_set_device_enabled_internal (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                                         GdkDevice *device,
 | |
|                                         gboolean   recurse,
 | |
|                                         gboolean   enabled)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GList *window_list, *l;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   window_list = get_widget_windows (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   for (l = window_list; l; l = l->next)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       GdkEventMask events = 0;
 | |
|       GdkWindow *window;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       window = l->data;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (enabled)
 | |
|         events = gdk_window_get_events (window);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       gdk_window_set_device_events (window, device, events);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (recurse && GTK_IS_CONTAINER (widget))
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       if (enabled)
 | |
|         gtk_container_forall (GTK_CONTAINER (widget), device_enable_foreach, device);
 | |
|       else
 | |
|         gtk_container_forall (GTK_CONTAINER (widget), device_disable_foreach, device);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_list_free (window_list);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_update_devices_mask (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                                 gboolean   recurse)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GList *enabled_devices, *l;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   enabled_devices = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_enabled_devices);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   for (l = enabled_devices; l; l = l->next)
 | |
|     gtk_widget_set_device_enabled_internal (widget, GDK_DEVICE (l->data), recurse, TRUE);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_realize:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Creates the GDK (windowing system) resources associated with a
 | |
|  * widget.  For example, @widget->window will be created when a widget
 | |
|  * is realized.  Normally realization happens implicitly; if you show
 | |
|  * a widget and all its parent containers, then the widget will be
 | |
|  * realized and mapped automatically.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Realizing a widget requires all
 | |
|  * the widget's parent widgets to be realized; calling
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_realize() realizes the widget's parents in addition to
 | |
|  * @widget itself. If a widget is not yet inside a toplevel window
 | |
|  * when you realize it, bad things will happen.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * This function is primarily used in widget implementations, and
 | |
|  * isn't very useful otherwise. Many times when you think you might
 | |
|  * need it, a better approach is to connect to a signal that will be
 | |
|  * called after the widget is realized automatically, such as
 | |
|  * #GtkWidget::draw. Or simply g_signal_connect () to the
 | |
|  * #GtkWidget::realize signal.
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_realize (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetPrivate *priv;
 | |
|   cairo_region_t *region;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (widget->priv->anchored ||
 | |
| 		    GTK_IS_INVISIBLE (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   priv = widget->priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (!gtk_widget_get_realized (widget))
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       gtk_widget_push_verify_invariants (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       /*
 | |
| 	if (GTK_IS_CONTAINER (widget) && gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget))
 | |
| 	  g_message ("gtk_widget_realize(%s)", G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget));
 | |
|       */
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (priv->parent == NULL &&
 | |
|           !gtk_widget_is_toplevel (widget))
 | |
|         g_warning ("Calling gtk_widget_realize() on a widget that isn't "
 | |
|                    "inside a toplevel window is not going to work very well. "
 | |
|                    "Widgets must be inside a toplevel container before realizing them.");
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (priv->parent && !gtk_widget_get_realized (priv->parent))
 | |
| 	gtk_widget_realize (priv->parent);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       gtk_widget_ensure_style (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (priv->style_update_pending)
 | |
|         g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[STYLE_UPDATED], 0);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[REALIZE], 0);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       gtk_widget_real_set_has_tooltip (widget,
 | |
| 				       GPOINTER_TO_UINT (g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_has_tooltip)),
 | |
| 				       TRUE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (priv->has_shape_mask)
 | |
| 	{
 | |
| 	  region = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_shape_info);
 | |
| 	  gdk_window_shape_combine_region (priv->window, region, 0, 0);
 | |
| 	}
 | |
| 
 | |
|       region = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_input_shape_info);
 | |
|       if (region)
 | |
| 	gdk_window_input_shape_combine_region (priv->window, region, 0, 0);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (priv->multidevice)
 | |
|         gdk_window_set_support_multidevice (priv->window, TRUE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       _gtk_widget_enable_device_events (widget);
 | |
|       gtk_widget_update_devices_mask (widget, TRUE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       gtk_widget_pop_verify_invariants (widget);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_unrealize:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * This function is only useful in widget implementations.
 | |
|  * Causes a widget to be unrealized (frees all GDK resources
 | |
|  * associated with the widget, such as @widget->window).
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_unrealize (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gtk_widget_push_verify_invariants (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (widget->priv->has_shape_mask)
 | |
|     gtk_widget_shape_combine_region (widget, NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_input_shape_info))
 | |
|     gtk_widget_input_shape_combine_region (widget, NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (gtk_widget_get_realized (widget))
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       g_object_ref (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (widget->priv->mapped)
 | |
|         gtk_widget_unmap (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[UNREALIZE], 0);
 | |
|       g_assert (!widget->priv->mapped);
 | |
|       gtk_widget_set_realized (widget, FALSE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       g_object_unref (widget);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gtk_widget_pop_verify_invariants (widget);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /*****************************************
 | |
|  * Draw queueing.
 | |
|  *****************************************/
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_queue_draw_region:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @region: region to draw
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Invalidates the rectangular area of @widget defined by @region by
 | |
|  * calling gdk_window_invalidate_region() on the widget's window and
 | |
|  * all its child windows. Once the main loop becomes idle (after the
 | |
|  * current batch of events has been processed, roughly), the window
 | |
|  * will receive expose events for the union of all regions that have
 | |
|  * been invalidated.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Normally you would only use this function in widget
 | |
|  * implementations. You might also use it to schedule a redraw of a
 | |
|  * #GtkDrawingArea or some portion thereof.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 3.0
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_queue_draw_region (GtkWidget            *widget,
 | |
|                               const cairo_region_t *region)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetPrivate *priv;
 | |
|   GtkWidget *w;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   priv = widget->priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (!gtk_widget_get_realized (widget))
 | |
|     return;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /* Just return if the widget or one of its ancestors isn't mapped */
 | |
|   for (w = widget; w != NULL; w = w->priv->parent)
 | |
|     if (!gtk_widget_get_mapped (w))
 | |
|       return;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gdk_window_invalidate_region (priv->window, region, TRUE);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_queue_draw_area:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @x: x coordinate of upper-left corner of rectangle to redraw
 | |
|  * @y: y coordinate of upper-left corner of rectangle to redraw
 | |
|  * @width: width of region to draw
 | |
|  * @height: height of region to draw
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Convenience function that calls gtk_widget_queue_draw_region() on
 | |
|  * the region created from the given coordinates.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * The region here is specified in widget coordinates.
 | |
|  * Widget coordinates are a bit odd; for historical reasons, they are
 | |
|  * defined as @widget->window coordinates for widgets that are not
 | |
|  * #GTK_NO_WINDOW widgets, and are relative to @widget->allocation.x,
 | |
|  * @widget->allocation.y for widgets that are #GTK_NO_WINDOW widgets.
 | |
|  */
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_queue_draw_area (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
| 			    gint       x,
 | |
| 			    gint       y,
 | |
| 			    gint       width,
 | |
| 			    gint       height)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GdkRectangle rect;
 | |
|   cairo_region_t *region;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   rect.x = x;
 | |
|   rect.y = y;
 | |
|   rect.width = width;
 | |
|   rect.height = height;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   region = cairo_region_create_rectangle (&rect);
 | |
|   gtk_widget_queue_draw_region (widget, region);
 | |
|   cairo_region_destroy (region);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_queue_draw:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Equivalent to calling gtk_widget_queue_draw_area() for the
 | |
|  * entire area of a widget.
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_queue_draw (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GdkRectangle rect;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gtk_widget_get_allocation (widget, &rect);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (!gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget))
 | |
|     gtk_widget_queue_draw_area (widget,
 | |
|                                 rect.x, rect.y, rect.width, rect.height);
 | |
|   else
 | |
|     gtk_widget_queue_draw_area (widget,
 | |
|                                 0, 0, rect.width, rect.height);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_queue_resize:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * This function is only for use in widget implementations.
 | |
|  * Flags a widget to have its size renegotiated; should
 | |
|  * be called when a widget for some reason has a new size request.
 | |
|  * For example, when you change the text in a #GtkLabel, #GtkLabel
 | |
|  * queues a resize to ensure there's enough space for the new text.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * <note><para>You cannot call gtk_widget_queue_resize() on a widget
 | |
|  * from inside its implementation of the GtkWidgetClass::size_allocate 
 | |
|  * virtual method. Calls to gtk_widget_queue_resize() from inside
 | |
|  * GtkWidgetClass::size_allocate will be silently ignored.</para></note>
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_queue_resize (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (gtk_widget_get_realized (widget))
 | |
|     gtk_widget_queue_shallow_draw (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   _gtk_size_group_queue_resize (widget, 0);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_queue_resize_no_redraw:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * This function works like gtk_widget_queue_resize(),
 | |
|  * except that the widget is not invalidated.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.4
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_queue_resize_no_redraw (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   _gtk_size_group_queue_resize (widget, 0);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_size_request:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @requisition: (out): a #GtkRequisition to be filled in
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * This function is typically used when implementing a #GtkContainer
 | |
|  * subclass.  Obtains the preferred size of a widget. The container
 | |
|  * uses this information to arrange its child widgets and decide what
 | |
|  * size allocations to give them with gtk_widget_size_allocate().
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * You can also call this function from an application, with some
 | |
|  * caveats. Most notably, getting a size request requires the widget
 | |
|  * to be associated with a screen, because font information may be
 | |
|  * needed. Multihead-aware applications should keep this in mind.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Also remember that the size request is not necessarily the size
 | |
|  * a widget will actually be allocated.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Deprecated: 3.0: Use gtk_widget_get_preferred_size() instead.
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_size_request (GtkWidget	*widget,
 | |
| 			 GtkRequisition *requisition)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gtk_widget_get_preferred_size (widget, requisition, NULL);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_child_requisition:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @requisition: (out): a #GtkRequisition to be filled in
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * This function is only for use in widget implementations. Obtains
 | |
|  * @widget->requisition, unless someone has forced a particular
 | |
|  * geometry on the widget (e.g. with gtk_widget_set_size_request()),
 | |
|  * in which case it returns that geometry instead of the widget's
 | |
|  * requisition.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * This function differs from gtk_widget_size_request() in that
 | |
|  * it retrieves the last size request value from @widget->requisition,
 | |
|  * while gtk_widget_size_request() actually calls the "size_request" method
 | |
|  * on @widget to compute the size request and fill in @widget->requisition,
 | |
|  * and only then returns @widget->requisition.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Because this function does not call the "size_request" method, it
 | |
|  * can only be used when you know that @widget->requisition is
 | |
|  * up-to-date, that is, gtk_widget_size_request() has been called
 | |
|  * since the last time a resize was queued. In general, only container
 | |
|  * implementations have this information; applications should use
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_size_request().
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Deprecated: 3.0: Use gtk_widget_get_preferred_size() instead.
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_child_requisition (GtkWidget	 *widget,
 | |
| 				  GtkRequisition *requisition)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   gtk_widget_get_preferred_size (widget, requisition, NULL);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static gboolean
 | |
| invalidate_predicate (GdkWindow *window,
 | |
| 		      gpointer   data)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   gpointer user_data;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gdk_window_get_user_data (window, &user_data);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return (user_data == data);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /* Invalidate @region in widget->window and all children
 | |
|  * of widget->window owned by widget. @region is in the
 | |
|  * same coordinates as widget->allocation and will be
 | |
|  * modified by this call.
 | |
|  */
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_invalidate_widget_windows (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
| 				      cairo_region_t *region)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (!gtk_widget_get_realized (widget))
 | |
|     return;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget) && priv->parent)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       int x, y;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       gdk_window_get_position (priv->window, &x, &y);
 | |
|       cairo_region_translate (region, -x, -y);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gdk_window_invalidate_maybe_recurse (priv->window, region,
 | |
| 				       invalidate_predicate, widget);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_queue_shallow_draw:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Like gtk_widget_queue_draw(), but only windows owned
 | |
|  * by @widget are invalidated.
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_queue_shallow_draw (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GdkRectangle rect;
 | |
|   cairo_region_t *region;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (!gtk_widget_get_realized (widget))
 | |
|     return;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gtk_widget_get_allocation (widget, &rect);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   region = cairo_region_create_rectangle (&rect);
 | |
|   gtk_widget_invalidate_widget_windows (widget, region);
 | |
|   cairo_region_destroy (region);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_size_allocate:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @allocation: position and size to be allocated to @widget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * This function is only used by #GtkContainer subclasses, to assign a size
 | |
|  * and position to their child widgets.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * In this function, the allocation may be adjusted. It will be forced
 | |
|  * to a 1x1 minimum size, and the adjust_size_allocation virtual
 | |
|  * method on the child will be used to adjust the allocation. Standard
 | |
|  * adjustments include removing the widget's margins, and applying the
 | |
|  * widget's #GtkWidget:halign and #GtkWidget:valign properties.
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_size_allocate (GtkWidget	*widget,
 | |
| 			  GtkAllocation *allocation)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetPrivate *priv;
 | |
|   GdkRectangle real_allocation;
 | |
|   GdkRectangle old_allocation;
 | |
|   GdkRectangle adjusted_allocation;
 | |
|   gboolean alloc_needed;
 | |
|   gboolean size_changed;
 | |
|   gboolean position_changed;
 | |
|   gint natural_width, natural_height, dummy;
 | |
|   gint min_width, min_height;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   priv = widget->priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gtk_widget_push_verify_invariants (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
| #ifdef G_ENABLE_DEBUG
 | |
|   if (gtk_get_debug_flags () & GTK_DEBUG_GEOMETRY)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       gint depth;
 | |
|       GtkWidget *parent;
 | |
|       const gchar *name;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       depth = 0;
 | |
|       parent = widget;
 | |
|       while (parent)
 | |
| 	{
 | |
| 	  depth++;
 | |
| 	  parent = gtk_widget_get_parent (parent);
 | |
| 	}
 | |
| 
 | |
|       name = g_type_name (G_OBJECT_TYPE (G_OBJECT (widget)));
 | |
|       g_print ("gtk_widget_size_allocate: %*s%s %d %d\n",
 | |
| 	       2 * depth, " ", name,
 | |
| 	       allocation->width, allocation->height);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| #endif /* G_ENABLE_DEBUG */
 | |
| 
 | |
|   alloc_needed = priv->alloc_needed;
 | |
|   if (!priv->width_request_needed && !priv->height_request_needed)
 | |
|     /* Preserve request/allocate ordering */
 | |
|     priv->alloc_needed = FALSE;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   old_allocation = priv->allocation;
 | |
|   real_allocation = *allocation;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   adjusted_allocation = real_allocation;
 | |
|   if (gtk_widget_get_request_mode (widget) == GTK_SIZE_REQUEST_HEIGHT_FOR_WIDTH)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       /* Go ahead and request the height for allocated width, note that the internals
 | |
|        * of get_height_for_width will internally limit the for_size to natural size
 | |
|        * when aligning implicitly.
 | |
|        */
 | |
|       gtk_widget_get_preferred_width (widget, &min_width, &natural_width);
 | |
|       gtk_widget_get_preferred_height_for_width (widget, real_allocation.width, &min_height, &natural_height);
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   else
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       /* Go ahead and request the width for allocated height, note that the internals
 | |
|        * of get_width_for_height will internally limit the for_size to natural size
 | |
|        * when aligning implicitly.
 | |
|        */
 | |
|       gtk_widget_get_preferred_height (widget, &min_height, &natural_height);
 | |
|       gtk_widget_get_preferred_width_for_height (widget, real_allocation.height, &min_width, &natural_width);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
| #ifdef G_ENABLE_DEBUG
 | |
|   if (gtk_get_debug_flags () & GTK_DEBUG_GEOMETRY)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       if ((min_width > real_allocation.width || min_height > real_allocation.height) &&
 | |
|           !GTK_IS_SCROLLABLE (widget))
 | |
|         g_warning ("gtk_widget_size_allocate(): attempt to underallocate %s%s %s %p. "
 | |
|                    "Allocation is %dx%d, but minimum required size is %dx%d.",
 | |
|                    priv->parent ? G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (priv->parent) : "", priv->parent ? "'s child" : "toplevel",
 | |
|                    G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget,
 | |
|                    real_allocation.width, real_allocation.height,
 | |
|                    min_width, min_height);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| #endif
 | |
|   /* Now that we have the right natural height and width, go ahead and remove any margins from the
 | |
|    * allocated sizes and possibly limit them to the natural sizes */
 | |
|   GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget)->adjust_size_allocation (widget,
 | |
| 							 GTK_ORIENTATION_HORIZONTAL,
 | |
| 							 &dummy,
 | |
| 							 &natural_width,
 | |
| 							 &adjusted_allocation.x,
 | |
| 							 &adjusted_allocation.width);
 | |
|   GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget)->adjust_size_allocation (widget,
 | |
| 							 GTK_ORIENTATION_VERTICAL,
 | |
| 							 &dummy,
 | |
| 							 &natural_height,
 | |
| 							 &adjusted_allocation.y,
 | |
| 							 &adjusted_allocation.height);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (adjusted_allocation.x < real_allocation.x ||
 | |
|       adjusted_allocation.y < real_allocation.y ||
 | |
|       (adjusted_allocation.x + adjusted_allocation.width) >
 | |
|       (real_allocation.x + real_allocation.width) ||
 | |
|       (adjusted_allocation.y + adjusted_allocation.height >
 | |
|        real_allocation.y + real_allocation.height))
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       g_warning ("%s %p attempted to adjust its size allocation from %d,%d %dx%d to %d,%d %dx%d. adjust_size_allocation must keep allocation inside original bounds",
 | |
|                  G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget,
 | |
|                  real_allocation.x, real_allocation.y, real_allocation.width, real_allocation.height,
 | |
|                  adjusted_allocation.x, adjusted_allocation.y, adjusted_allocation.width, adjusted_allocation.height);
 | |
|       adjusted_allocation = real_allocation; /* veto it */
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   else
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       real_allocation = adjusted_allocation;
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (real_allocation.width < 0 || real_allocation.height < 0)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       g_warning ("gtk_widget_size_allocate(): attempt to allocate widget with width %d and height %d",
 | |
| 		 real_allocation.width,
 | |
| 		 real_allocation.height);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   real_allocation.width = MAX (real_allocation.width, 1);
 | |
|   real_allocation.height = MAX (real_allocation.height, 1);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   size_changed = (old_allocation.width != real_allocation.width ||
 | |
| 		  old_allocation.height != real_allocation.height);
 | |
|   position_changed = (old_allocation.x != real_allocation.x ||
 | |
| 		      old_allocation.y != real_allocation.y);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (!alloc_needed && !size_changed && !position_changed)
 | |
|     goto out;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[SIZE_ALLOCATE], 0, &real_allocation);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /* Size allocation is god... after consulting god, no further requests or allocations are needed */
 | |
|   priv->width_request_needed  = FALSE;
 | |
|   priv->height_request_needed = FALSE;
 | |
|   priv->alloc_needed          = FALSE;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (gtk_widget_get_mapped (widget))
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       if (!gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget) && priv->redraw_on_alloc && position_changed)
 | |
| 	{
 | |
| 	  /* Invalidate union(old_allaction,priv->allocation) in priv->window
 | |
| 	   */
 | |
| 	  cairo_region_t *invalidate = cairo_region_create_rectangle (&priv->allocation);
 | |
| 	  cairo_region_union_rectangle (invalidate, &old_allocation);
 | |
| 
 | |
| 	  gdk_window_invalidate_region (priv->window, invalidate, FALSE);
 | |
| 	  cairo_region_destroy (invalidate);
 | |
| 	}
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (size_changed)
 | |
| 	{
 | |
| 	  if (priv->redraw_on_alloc)
 | |
| 	    {
 | |
| 	      /* Invalidate union(old_allaction,priv->allocation) in priv->window and descendents owned by widget
 | |
| 	       */
 | |
| 	      cairo_region_t *invalidate = cairo_region_create_rectangle (&priv->allocation);
 | |
| 	      cairo_region_union_rectangle (invalidate, &old_allocation);
 | |
| 
 | |
| 	      gtk_widget_invalidate_widget_windows (widget, invalidate);
 | |
| 	      cairo_region_destroy (invalidate);
 | |
| 	    }
 | |
| 	}
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (size_changed || position_changed)
 | |
|         {
 | |
|           GtkStyleContext *context;
 | |
| 
 | |
|           context = gtk_widget_get_style_context (widget);
 | |
|           _gtk_style_context_invalidate_animation_areas (context);
 | |
|         }
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if ((size_changed || position_changed) && priv->parent &&
 | |
|       gtk_widget_get_realized (priv->parent) && _gtk_container_get_reallocate_redraws (GTK_CONTAINER (priv->parent)))
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       cairo_region_t *invalidate = cairo_region_create_rectangle (&priv->parent->priv->allocation);
 | |
|       gtk_widget_invalidate_widget_windows (priv->parent, invalidate);
 | |
|       cairo_region_destroy (invalidate);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
| out:
 | |
|   gtk_widget_pop_verify_invariants (widget);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_common_ancestor:
 | |
|  * @widget_a: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @widget_b: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Find the common ancestor of @widget_a and @widget_b that
 | |
|  * is closest to the two widgets.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: the closest common ancestor of @widget_a and
 | |
|  *   @widget_b or %NULL if @widget_a and @widget_b do not
 | |
|  *   share a common ancestor.
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| static GtkWidget *
 | |
| gtk_widget_common_ancestor (GtkWidget *widget_a,
 | |
| 			    GtkWidget *widget_b)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidget *parent_a;
 | |
|   GtkWidget *parent_b;
 | |
|   gint depth_a = 0;
 | |
|   gint depth_b = 0;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   parent_a = widget_a;
 | |
|   while (parent_a->priv->parent)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       parent_a = parent_a->priv->parent;
 | |
|       depth_a++;
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   parent_b = widget_b;
 | |
|   while (parent_b->priv->parent)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       parent_b = parent_b->priv->parent;
 | |
|       depth_b++;
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (parent_a != parent_b)
 | |
|     return NULL;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   while (depth_a > depth_b)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       widget_a = widget_a->priv->parent;
 | |
|       depth_a--;
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   while (depth_b > depth_a)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       widget_b = widget_b->priv->parent;
 | |
|       depth_b--;
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   while (widget_a != widget_b)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       widget_a = widget_a->priv->parent;
 | |
|       widget_b = widget_b->priv->parent;
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return widget_a;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_translate_coordinates:
 | |
|  * @src_widget:  a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @dest_widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @src_x: X position relative to @src_widget
 | |
|  * @src_y: Y position relative to @src_widget
 | |
|  * @dest_x: (out): location to store X position relative to @dest_widget
 | |
|  * @dest_y: (out): location to store Y position relative to @dest_widget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Translate coordinates relative to @src_widget's allocation to coordinates
 | |
|  * relative to @dest_widget's allocations. In order to perform this
 | |
|  * operation, both widgets must be realized, and must share a common
 | |
|  * toplevel.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: %FALSE if either widget was not realized, or there
 | |
|  *   was no common ancestor. In this case, nothing is stored in
 | |
|  *   *@dest_x and *@dest_y. Otherwise %TRUE.
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| gboolean
 | |
| gtk_widget_translate_coordinates (GtkWidget  *src_widget,
 | |
| 				  GtkWidget  *dest_widget,
 | |
| 				  gint        src_x,
 | |
| 				  gint        src_y,
 | |
| 				  gint       *dest_x,
 | |
| 				  gint       *dest_y)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetPrivate *src_priv = src_widget->priv;
 | |
|   GtkWidgetPrivate *dest_priv = dest_widget->priv;
 | |
|   GtkWidget *ancestor;
 | |
|   GdkWindow *window;
 | |
|   GList *dest_list = NULL;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (src_widget), FALSE);
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (dest_widget), FALSE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   ancestor = gtk_widget_common_ancestor (src_widget, dest_widget);
 | |
|   if (!ancestor || !gtk_widget_get_realized (src_widget) || !gtk_widget_get_realized (dest_widget))
 | |
|     return FALSE;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /* Translate from allocation relative to window relative */
 | |
|   if (gtk_widget_get_has_window (src_widget) && src_priv->parent)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       gint wx, wy;
 | |
|       gdk_window_get_position (src_priv->window, &wx, &wy);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       src_x -= wx - src_priv->allocation.x;
 | |
|       src_y -= wy - src_priv->allocation.y;
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   else
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       src_x += src_priv->allocation.x;
 | |
|       src_y += src_priv->allocation.y;
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /* Translate to the common ancestor */
 | |
|   window = src_priv->window;
 | |
|   while (window != ancestor->priv->window)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       gdouble dx, dy;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       gdk_window_coords_to_parent (window, src_x, src_y, &dx, &dy);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       src_x = dx;
 | |
|       src_y = dy;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       window = gdk_window_get_effective_parent (window);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (!window)		/* Handle GtkHandleBox */
 | |
| 	return FALSE;
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /* And back */
 | |
|   window = dest_priv->window;
 | |
|   while (window != ancestor->priv->window)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       dest_list = g_list_prepend (dest_list, window);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       window = gdk_window_get_effective_parent (window);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (!window)		/* Handle GtkHandleBox */
 | |
|         {
 | |
|           g_list_free (dest_list);
 | |
|           return FALSE;
 | |
|         }
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   while (dest_list)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       gdouble dx, dy;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       gdk_window_coords_from_parent (dest_list->data, src_x, src_y, &dx, &dy);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       src_x = dx;
 | |
|       src_y = dy;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       dest_list = g_list_remove (dest_list, dest_list->data);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /* Translate from window relative to allocation relative */
 | |
|   if (gtk_widget_get_has_window (dest_widget) && dest_priv->parent)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       gint wx, wy;
 | |
|       gdk_window_get_position (dest_priv->window, &wx, &wy);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       src_x += wx - dest_priv->allocation.x;
 | |
|       src_y += wy - dest_priv->allocation.y;
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   else
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       src_x -= dest_priv->allocation.x;
 | |
|       src_y -= dest_priv->allocation.y;
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (dest_x)
 | |
|     *dest_x = src_x;
 | |
|   if (dest_y)
 | |
|     *dest_y = src_y;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return TRUE;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_real_size_allocate (GtkWidget     *widget,
 | |
| 			       GtkAllocation *allocation)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   priv->allocation = *allocation;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (gtk_widget_get_realized (widget) &&
 | |
|       gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget))
 | |
|      {
 | |
| 	gdk_window_move_resize (priv->window,
 | |
| 				allocation->x, allocation->y,
 | |
| 				allocation->width, allocation->height);
 | |
|      }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /* translate initial/final into start/end */
 | |
| static GtkAlign
 | |
| effective_align (GtkAlign         align,
 | |
|                  GtkTextDirection direction)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   switch (align)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|     case GTK_ALIGN_START:
 | |
|       return direction == GTK_TEXT_DIR_RTL ? GTK_ALIGN_END : GTK_ALIGN_START;
 | |
|     case GTK_ALIGN_END:
 | |
|       return direction == GTK_TEXT_DIR_RTL ? GTK_ALIGN_START : GTK_ALIGN_END;
 | |
|     default:
 | |
|       return align;
 | |
|     }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| adjust_for_align (GtkAlign  align,
 | |
|                   gint     *natural_size,
 | |
|                   gint     *allocated_pos,
 | |
|                   gint     *allocated_size)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   switch (align)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|     case GTK_ALIGN_FILL:
 | |
|       /* change nothing */
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case GTK_ALIGN_START:
 | |
|       /* keep *allocated_pos where it is */
 | |
|       *allocated_size = MIN (*allocated_size, *natural_size);
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case GTK_ALIGN_END:
 | |
|       if (*allocated_size > *natural_size)
 | |
| 	{
 | |
| 	  *allocated_pos += (*allocated_size - *natural_size);
 | |
| 	  *allocated_size = *natural_size;
 | |
| 	}
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case GTK_ALIGN_CENTER:
 | |
|       if (*allocated_size > *natural_size)
 | |
| 	{
 | |
| 	  *allocated_pos += (*allocated_size - *natural_size) / 2;
 | |
| 	  *allocated_size = MIN (*allocated_size, *natural_size);
 | |
| 	}
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| adjust_for_margin(gint               start_margin,
 | |
|                   gint               end_margin,
 | |
|                   gint              *minimum_size,
 | |
|                   gint              *natural_size,
 | |
|                   gint              *allocated_pos,
 | |
|                   gint              *allocated_size)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   *minimum_size -= (start_margin + end_margin);
 | |
|   *natural_size -= (start_margin + end_margin);
 | |
|   *allocated_pos += start_margin;
 | |
|   *allocated_size -= (start_margin + end_margin);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_real_adjust_size_allocation (GtkWidget         *widget,
 | |
|                                         GtkOrientation     orientation,
 | |
|                                         gint              *minimum_size,
 | |
|                                         gint              *natural_size,
 | |
|                                         gint              *allocated_pos,
 | |
|                                         gint              *allocated_size)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   const GtkWidgetAuxInfo *aux_info;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   aux_info = _gtk_widget_get_aux_info_or_defaults (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (orientation == GTK_ORIENTATION_HORIZONTAL)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       adjust_for_margin (aux_info->margin.left,
 | |
|                          aux_info->margin.right,
 | |
|                          minimum_size, natural_size,
 | |
|                          allocated_pos, allocated_size);
 | |
|       adjust_for_align (effective_align (aux_info->halign, gtk_widget_get_direction (widget)),
 | |
|                         natural_size, allocated_pos, allocated_size);
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   else
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       adjust_for_margin (aux_info->margin.top,
 | |
|                          aux_info->margin.bottom,
 | |
|                          minimum_size, natural_size,
 | |
|                          allocated_pos, allocated_size);
 | |
|       adjust_for_align (effective_align (aux_info->valign, GTK_TEXT_DIR_NONE),
 | |
|                         natural_size, allocated_pos, allocated_size);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static gboolean
 | |
| gtk_widget_real_can_activate_accel (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                                     guint      signal_id)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /* widgets must be onscreen for accels to take effect */
 | |
|   return gtk_widget_is_sensitive (widget) &&
 | |
|          gtk_widget_is_drawable (widget) &&
 | |
|          gdk_window_is_viewable (priv->window);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_can_activate_accel:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @signal_id: the ID of a signal installed on @widget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Determines whether an accelerator that activates the signal
 | |
|  * identified by @signal_id can currently be activated.
 | |
|  * This is done by emitting the #GtkWidget::can-activate-accel
 | |
|  * signal on @widget; if the signal isn't overridden by a
 | |
|  * handler or in a derived widget, then the default check is
 | |
|  * that the widget must be sensitive, and the widget and all
 | |
|  * its ancestors mapped.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: %TRUE if the accelerator can be activated.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.4
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| gboolean
 | |
| gtk_widget_can_activate_accel (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                                guint      signal_id)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   gboolean can_activate = FALSE;
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE);
 | |
|   g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[CAN_ACTIVATE_ACCEL], 0, signal_id, &can_activate);
 | |
|   return can_activate;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| typedef struct {
 | |
|   GClosure   closure;
 | |
|   guint      signal_id;
 | |
| } AccelClosure;
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| closure_accel_activate (GClosure     *closure,
 | |
| 			GValue       *return_value,
 | |
| 			guint         n_param_values,
 | |
| 			const GValue *param_values,
 | |
| 			gpointer      invocation_hint,
 | |
| 			gpointer      marshal_data)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   AccelClosure *aclosure = (AccelClosure*) closure;
 | |
|   gboolean can_activate = gtk_widget_can_activate_accel (closure->data, aclosure->signal_id);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (can_activate)
 | |
|     g_signal_emit (closure->data, aclosure->signal_id, 0);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /* whether accelerator was handled */
 | |
|   g_value_set_boolean (return_value, can_activate);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| closures_destroy (gpointer data)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GSList *slist, *closures = data;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   for (slist = closures; slist; slist = slist->next)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       g_closure_invalidate (slist->data);
 | |
|       g_closure_unref (slist->data);
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   g_slist_free (closures);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static GClosure*
 | |
| widget_new_accel_closure (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
| 			  guint      signal_id)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   AccelClosure *aclosure;
 | |
|   GClosure *closure = NULL;
 | |
|   GSList *slist, *closures;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   closures = g_object_steal_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_accel_closures);
 | |
|   for (slist = closures; slist; slist = slist->next)
 | |
|     if (!gtk_accel_group_from_accel_closure (slist->data))
 | |
|       {
 | |
| 	/* reuse this closure */
 | |
| 	closure = slist->data;
 | |
| 	break;
 | |
|       }
 | |
|   if (!closure)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       closure = g_closure_new_object (sizeof (AccelClosure), G_OBJECT (widget));
 | |
|       closures = g_slist_prepend (closures, g_closure_ref (closure));
 | |
|       g_closure_sink (closure);
 | |
|       g_closure_set_marshal (closure, closure_accel_activate);
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_accel_closures, closures, closures_destroy);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   aclosure = (AccelClosure*) closure;
 | |
|   g_assert (closure->data == widget);
 | |
|   g_assert (closure->marshal == closure_accel_activate);
 | |
|   aclosure->signal_id = signal_id;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return closure;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_add_accelerator
 | |
|  * @widget:       widget to install an accelerator on
 | |
|  * @accel_signal: widget signal to emit on accelerator activation
 | |
|  * @accel_group:  accel group for this widget, added to its toplevel
 | |
|  * @accel_key:    GDK keyval of the accelerator
 | |
|  * @accel_mods:   modifier key combination of the accelerator
 | |
|  * @accel_flags:  flag accelerators, e.g. %GTK_ACCEL_VISIBLE
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Installs an accelerator for this @widget in @accel_group that causes
 | |
|  * @accel_signal to be emitted if the accelerator is activated.
 | |
|  * The @accel_group needs to be added to the widget's toplevel via
 | |
|  * gtk_window_add_accel_group(), and the signal must be of type %G_RUN_ACTION.
 | |
|  * Accelerators added through this function are not user changeable during
 | |
|  * runtime. If you want to support accelerators that can be changed by the
 | |
|  * user, use gtk_accel_map_add_entry() and gtk_widget_set_accel_path() or
 | |
|  * gtk_menu_item_set_accel_path() instead.
 | |
|  */
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_add_accelerator (GtkWidget      *widget,
 | |
| 			    const gchar    *accel_signal,
 | |
| 			    GtkAccelGroup  *accel_group,
 | |
| 			    guint           accel_key,
 | |
| 			    GdkModifierType accel_mods,
 | |
| 			    GtkAccelFlags   accel_flags)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GClosure *closure;
 | |
|   GSignalQuery query;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (accel_signal != NULL);
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_ACCEL_GROUP (accel_group));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_signal_query (g_signal_lookup (accel_signal, G_OBJECT_TYPE (widget)), &query);
 | |
|   if (!query.signal_id ||
 | |
|       !(query.signal_flags & G_SIGNAL_ACTION) ||
 | |
|       query.return_type != G_TYPE_NONE ||
 | |
|       query.n_params)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       /* hmm, should be elaborate enough */
 | |
|       g_warning (G_STRLOC ": widget `%s' has no activatable signal \"%s\" without arguments",
 | |
| 		 G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), accel_signal);
 | |
|       return;
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   closure = widget_new_accel_closure (widget, query.signal_id);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_object_ref (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /* install the accelerator. since we don't map this onto an accel_path,
 | |
|    * the accelerator will automatically be locked.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   gtk_accel_group_connect (accel_group,
 | |
| 			   accel_key,
 | |
| 			   accel_mods,
 | |
| 			   accel_flags | GTK_ACCEL_LOCKED,
 | |
| 			   closure);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[ACCEL_CLOSURES_CHANGED], 0);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_object_unref (widget);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_remove_accelerator:
 | |
|  * @widget:       widget to install an accelerator on
 | |
|  * @accel_group:  accel group for this widget
 | |
|  * @accel_key:    GDK keyval of the accelerator
 | |
|  * @accel_mods:   modifier key combination of the accelerator
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Removes an accelerator from @widget, previously installed with
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_add_accelerator().
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns: whether an accelerator was installed and could be removed
 | |
|  */
 | |
| gboolean
 | |
| gtk_widget_remove_accelerator (GtkWidget      *widget,
 | |
| 			       GtkAccelGroup  *accel_group,
 | |
| 			       guint           accel_key,
 | |
| 			       GdkModifierType accel_mods)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkAccelGroupEntry *ag_entry;
 | |
|   GList *slist, *clist;
 | |
|   guint n;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE);
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_ACCEL_GROUP (accel_group), FALSE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   ag_entry = gtk_accel_group_query (accel_group, accel_key, accel_mods, &n);
 | |
|   clist = gtk_widget_list_accel_closures (widget);
 | |
|   for (slist = clist; slist; slist = slist->next)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       guint i;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       for (i = 0; i < n; i++)
 | |
| 	if (slist->data == (gpointer) ag_entry[i].closure)
 | |
| 	  {
 | |
| 	    gboolean is_removed = gtk_accel_group_disconnect (accel_group, slist->data);
 | |
| 
 | |
| 	    g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[ACCEL_CLOSURES_CHANGED], 0);
 | |
| 
 | |
| 	    g_list_free (clist);
 | |
| 
 | |
| 	    return is_removed;
 | |
| 	  }
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   g_list_free (clist);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_warning (G_STRLOC ": no accelerator (%u,%u) installed in accel group (%p) for %s (%p)",
 | |
| 	     accel_key, accel_mods, accel_group,
 | |
| 	     G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return FALSE;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_list_accel_closures:
 | |
|  * @widget:  widget to list accelerator closures for
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Lists the closures used by @widget for accelerator group connections
 | |
|  * with gtk_accel_group_connect_by_path() or gtk_accel_group_connect().
 | |
|  * The closures can be used to monitor accelerator changes on @widget,
 | |
|  * by connecting to the @GtkAccelGroup::accel-changed signal of the
 | |
|  * #GtkAccelGroup of a closure which can be found out with
 | |
|  * gtk_accel_group_from_accel_closure().
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: (transfer container) (element-type GClosure):
 | |
|  *     a newly allocated #GList of closures
 | |
|  */
 | |
| GList*
 | |
| gtk_widget_list_accel_closures (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GSList *slist;
 | |
|   GList *clist = NULL;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   for (slist = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_accel_closures); slist; slist = slist->next)
 | |
|     if (gtk_accel_group_from_accel_closure (slist->data))
 | |
|       clist = g_list_prepend (clist, slist->data);
 | |
|   return clist;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| typedef struct {
 | |
|   GQuark         path_quark;
 | |
|   GtkAccelGroup *accel_group;
 | |
|   GClosure      *closure;
 | |
| } AccelPath;
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| destroy_accel_path (gpointer data)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   AccelPath *apath = data;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gtk_accel_group_disconnect (apath->accel_group, apath->closure);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /* closures_destroy takes care of unrefing the closure */
 | |
|   g_object_unref (apath->accel_group);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_slice_free (AccelPath, apath);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_set_accel_path:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @accel_path: (allow-none): path used to look up the accelerator
 | |
|  * @accel_group: (allow-none): a #GtkAccelGroup.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Given an accelerator group, @accel_group, and an accelerator path,
 | |
|  * @accel_path, sets up an accelerator in @accel_group so whenever the
 | |
|  * key binding that is defined for @accel_path is pressed, @widget
 | |
|  * will be activated.  This removes any accelerators (for any
 | |
|  * accelerator group) installed by previous calls to
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_set_accel_path(). Associating accelerators with
 | |
|  * paths allows them to be modified by the user and the modifications
 | |
|  * to be saved for future use. (See gtk_accel_map_save().)
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * This function is a low level function that would most likely
 | |
|  * be used by a menu creation system like #GtkUIManager. If you
 | |
|  * use #GtkUIManager, setting up accelerator paths will be done
 | |
|  * automatically.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Even when you you aren't using #GtkUIManager, if you only want to
 | |
|  * set up accelerators on menu items gtk_menu_item_set_accel_path()
 | |
|  * provides a somewhat more convenient interface.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Note that @accel_path string will be stored in a #GQuark. Therefore, if you
 | |
|  * pass a static string, you can save some memory by interning it first with
 | |
|  * g_intern_static_string().
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_set_accel_path (GtkWidget     *widget,
 | |
| 			   const gchar   *accel_path,
 | |
| 			   GtkAccelGroup *accel_group)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   AccelPath *apath;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget)->activate_signal != 0);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (accel_path)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_ACCEL_GROUP (accel_group));
 | |
|       g_return_if_fail (_gtk_accel_path_is_valid (accel_path));
 | |
| 
 | |
|       gtk_accel_map_add_entry (accel_path, 0, 0);
 | |
|       apath = g_slice_new (AccelPath);
 | |
|       apath->accel_group = g_object_ref (accel_group);
 | |
|       apath->path_quark = g_quark_from_string (accel_path);
 | |
|       apath->closure = widget_new_accel_closure (widget, GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget)->activate_signal);
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   else
 | |
|     apath = NULL;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /* also removes possible old settings */
 | |
|   g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_accel_path, apath, destroy_accel_path);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (apath)
 | |
|     gtk_accel_group_connect_by_path (apath->accel_group, g_quark_to_string (apath->path_quark), apath->closure);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[ACCEL_CLOSURES_CHANGED], 0);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| const gchar*
 | |
| _gtk_widget_get_accel_path (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
| 			    gboolean  *locked)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   AccelPath *apath;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   apath = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_accel_path);
 | |
|   if (locked)
 | |
|     *locked = apath ? gtk_accel_group_get_is_locked (apath->accel_group) : TRUE;
 | |
|   return apath ? g_quark_to_string (apath->path_quark) : NULL;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_mnemonic_activate:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @group_cycling:  %TRUE if there are other widgets with the same mnemonic
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Emits the #GtkWidget::mnemonic-activate signal.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * The default handler for this signal activates the @widget if
 | |
|  * @group_cycling is %FALSE, and just grabs the focus if @group_cycling
 | |
|  * is %TRUE.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns: %TRUE if the signal has been handled
 | |
|  */
 | |
| gboolean
 | |
| gtk_widget_mnemonic_activate (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                               gboolean   group_cycling)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   gboolean handled;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   group_cycling = group_cycling != FALSE;
 | |
|   if (!gtk_widget_is_sensitive (widget))
 | |
|     handled = TRUE;
 | |
|   else
 | |
|     g_signal_emit (widget,
 | |
| 		   widget_signals[MNEMONIC_ACTIVATE],
 | |
| 		   0,
 | |
| 		   group_cycling,
 | |
| 		   &handled);
 | |
|   return handled;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static gboolean
 | |
| gtk_widget_real_mnemonic_activate (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                                    gboolean   group_cycling)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   if (!group_cycling && GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget)->activate_signal)
 | |
|     gtk_widget_activate (widget);
 | |
|   else if (gtk_widget_get_can_focus (widget))
 | |
|     gtk_widget_grab_focus (widget);
 | |
|   else
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       g_warning ("widget `%s' isn't suitable for mnemonic activation",
 | |
| 		 G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget));
 | |
|       gtk_widget_error_bell (widget);
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   return TRUE;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static const cairo_user_data_key_t event_key;
 | |
| 
 | |
| GdkEventExpose *
 | |
| _gtk_cairo_get_event (cairo_t *cr)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (cr != NULL, NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return cairo_get_user_data (cr, &event_key);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_cairo_set_event (cairo_t        *cr,
 | |
|                      GdkEventExpose *event)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   cairo_set_user_data (cr, &event_key, event, NULL);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_cairo_should_draw_window:
 | |
|  * @cr: a cairo context
 | |
|  * @window: the window to check. @window may not be an input-only
 | |
|  *          window.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * This function is supposed to be called in #GtkWidget::draw
 | |
|  * implementations for widgets that support multiple windows.
 | |
|  * @cr must be untransformed from invoking of the draw function.
 | |
|  * This function will return %TRUE if the contents of the given
 | |
|  * @window are supposed to be drawn and %FALSE otherwise. Note
 | |
|  * that when the drawing was not initiated by the windowing
 | |
|  * system this function will return %TRUE for all windows, so
 | |
|  * you need to draw the bottommost window first. Also, do not
 | |
|  * use "else if" statements to check which window should be drawn.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns: %TRUE if @window should be drawn
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 3.0
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| gboolean
 | |
| gtk_cairo_should_draw_window (cairo_t *cr,
 | |
|                               GdkWindow *window)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GdkEventExpose *event;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (cr != NULL, FALSE);
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GDK_IS_WINDOW (window), FALSE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   event = _gtk_cairo_get_event (cr);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return event == NULL ||
 | |
|          event->window == window;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static gboolean
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_clip_draw (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   /* labels are not clipped, because clipping them would cause
 | |
|    * mnemonics to not appear on characters that go beyond the
 | |
|    * baseline.
 | |
|    * https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=648570
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   if (GTK_IS_LABEL (widget))
 | |
|     return FALSE;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return TRUE;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /* code shared by gtk_container_propagate_draw() and
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_draw()
 | |
|  */
 | |
| void
 | |
| _gtk_widget_draw_internal (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                            cairo_t   *cr,
 | |
|                            gboolean   clip_to_size)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkStyleContext *context;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (!gtk_widget_is_drawable (widget))
 | |
|     return;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   clip_to_size &= gtk_widget_get_clip_draw (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (clip_to_size)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       cairo_rectangle (cr,
 | |
|                        0, 0,
 | |
|                        widget->priv->allocation.width,
 | |
|                        widget->priv->allocation.height);
 | |
|       cairo_clip (cr);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (gdk_cairo_get_clip_rectangle (cr, NULL))
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       gboolean result;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[DRAW],
 | |
|                      0, cr,
 | |
|                      &result);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   context = gtk_widget_get_style_context (widget);
 | |
|   _gtk_style_context_coalesce_animation_areas (context, widget);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_draw:
 | |
|  * @widget: the widget to draw. It must be drawable (see
 | |
|  *   gtk_widget_is_drawable()) and a size must have been allocated.
 | |
|  * @cr: a cairo context to draw to
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Draws @widget to @cr. The top left corner of the widget will be
 | |
|  * drawn to the currently set origin point of @cr.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * You should pass a cairo context as @cr argument that is in an
 | |
|  * original state. Otherwise the resulting drawing is undefined. For
 | |
|  * example changing the operator using cairo_set_operator() or the
 | |
|  * line width using cairo_set_line_width() might have unwanted side
 | |
|  * effects.
 | |
|  * You may however change the context's transform matrix - like with
 | |
|  * cairo_scale(), cairo_translate() or cairo_set_matrix() and clip
 | |
|  * region with cairo_clip() prior to calling this function. Also, it
 | |
|  * is fine to modify the context with cairo_save() and
 | |
|  * cairo_push_group() prior to calling this function.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * <note><para>Special purpose widgets may contain special code for
 | |
|  * rendering to the screen and might appear differently on screen
 | |
|  * and when rendered using gtk_widget_draw().</para></note>
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 3.0
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_draw (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                  cairo_t   *cr)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GdkEventExpose *tmp_event;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (!widget->priv->alloc_needed);
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (cr != NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   cairo_save (cr);
 | |
|   /* We have to reset the event here so that draw functions can call
 | |
|    * gtk_widget_draw() on random other widgets and get the desired
 | |
|    * effect: Drawing all contents, not just the current window.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   tmp_event = _gtk_cairo_get_event (cr);
 | |
|   gtk_cairo_set_event (cr, NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   _gtk_widget_draw_internal (widget, cr, TRUE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gtk_cairo_set_event (cr, tmp_event);
 | |
|   cairo_restore (cr);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static gboolean
 | |
| gtk_widget_real_key_press_event (GtkWidget         *widget,
 | |
| 				 GdkEventKey       *event)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   return gtk_bindings_activate_event (G_OBJECT (widget), event);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static gboolean
 | |
| gtk_widget_real_key_release_event (GtkWidget         *widget,
 | |
| 				   GdkEventKey       *event)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   return gtk_bindings_activate_event (G_OBJECT (widget), event);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static gboolean
 | |
| gtk_widget_real_focus_in_event (GtkWidget     *widget,
 | |
|                                 GdkEventFocus *event)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   gtk_widget_queue_shallow_draw (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return FALSE;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static gboolean
 | |
| gtk_widget_real_focus_out_event (GtkWidget     *widget,
 | |
|                                  GdkEventFocus *event)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   gtk_widget_queue_shallow_draw (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return FALSE;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| #define WIDGET_REALIZED_FOR_EVENT(widget, event) \
 | |
|      (event->type == GDK_FOCUS_CHANGE || gtk_widget_get_realized(widget))
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_event:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @event: a #GdkEvent
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Rarely-used function. This function is used to emit
 | |
|  * the event signals on a widget (those signals should never
 | |
|  * be emitted without using this function to do so).
 | |
|  * If you want to synthesize an event though, don't use this function;
 | |
|  * instead, use gtk_main_do_event() so the event will behave as if
 | |
|  * it were in the event queue. Don't synthesize expose events; instead,
 | |
|  * use gdk_window_invalidate_rect() to invalidate a region of the
 | |
|  * window.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: return from the event signal emission (%TRUE if
 | |
|  *               the event was handled)
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| gboolean
 | |
| gtk_widget_event (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
| 		  GdkEvent  *event)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), TRUE);
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (WIDGET_REALIZED_FOR_EVENT (widget, event), TRUE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (event->type == GDK_EXPOSE)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       g_warning ("Events of type GDK_EXPOSE cannot be synthesized. To get "
 | |
| 		 "the same effect, call gdk_window_invalidate_rect/region(), "
 | |
| 		 "followed by gdk_window_process_updates().");
 | |
|       return TRUE;
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return gtk_widget_event_internal (widget, event);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /* Returns TRUE if a translation should be done */
 | |
| gboolean
 | |
| _gtk_widget_get_translation_to_window (GtkWidget      *widget,
 | |
| 				       GdkWindow      *window,
 | |
| 				       int            *x,
 | |
| 				       int            *y)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GdkWindow *w, *widget_window;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (!gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget))
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       *x = -widget->priv->allocation.x;
 | |
|       *y = -widget->priv->allocation.y;
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   else
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       *x = 0;
 | |
|       *y = 0;
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   widget_window = gtk_widget_get_window (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   for (w = window; w && w != widget_window; w = gdk_window_get_parent (w))
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       int wx, wy;
 | |
|       gdk_window_get_position (w, &wx, &wy);
 | |
|       *x += wx;
 | |
|       *y += wy;
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (w == NULL)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       *x = 0;
 | |
|       *y = 0;
 | |
|       return FALSE;
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return TRUE;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_cairo_transform_to_window:
 | |
|  * @cr: the cairo context to transform
 | |
|  * @widget: the widget the context is currently centered for
 | |
|  * @window: the window to transform the context to
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Transforms the given cairo context @cr that from @widget-relative
 | |
|  * coordinates to @window-relative coordinates.
 | |
|  * If the @widget's window is not an ancestor of @window, no
 | |
|  * modification will be applied.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * This is the inverse to the transformation GTK applies when
 | |
|  * preparing an expose event to be emitted with the #GtkWidget::draw
 | |
|  * signal. It is intended to help porting multiwindow widgets from
 | |
|  * GTK+ 2 to the rendering architecture of GTK+ 3.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 3.0
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_cairo_transform_to_window (cairo_t   *cr,
 | |
|                                GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                                GdkWindow *window)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   int x, y;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (cr != NULL);
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GDK_IS_WINDOW (window));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (_gtk_widget_get_translation_to_window (widget, window, &x, &y))
 | |
|     cairo_translate (cr, x, y);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_send_expose:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @event: a expose #GdkEvent
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Very rarely-used function. This function is used to emit
 | |
|  * an expose event on a widget. This function is not normally used
 | |
|  * directly. The only time it is used is when propagating an expose
 | |
|  * event to a child %NO_WINDOW widget, and that is normally done
 | |
|  * using gtk_container_propagate_draw().
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * If you want to force an area of a window to be redrawn,
 | |
|  * use gdk_window_invalidate_rect() or gdk_window_invalidate_region().
 | |
|  * To cause the redraw to be done immediately, follow that call
 | |
|  * with a call to gdk_window_process_updates().
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: return from the event signal emission (%TRUE if
 | |
|  *               the event was handled)
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| gint
 | |
| gtk_widget_send_expose (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
| 			GdkEvent  *event)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   gboolean result = FALSE;
 | |
|   cairo_t *cr;
 | |
|   int x, y;
 | |
|   gboolean do_clip;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), TRUE);
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (gtk_widget_get_realized (widget), TRUE);
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (event != NULL, TRUE);
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (event->type == GDK_EXPOSE, TRUE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   cr = gdk_cairo_create (event->expose.window);
 | |
|   gtk_cairo_set_event (cr, &event->expose);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gdk_cairo_region (cr, event->expose.region);
 | |
|   cairo_clip (cr);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   do_clip = _gtk_widget_get_translation_to_window (widget,
 | |
| 						   event->expose.window,
 | |
| 						   &x, &y);
 | |
|   cairo_translate (cr, -x, -y);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   _gtk_widget_draw_internal (widget, cr, do_clip);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /* unset here, so if someone keeps a reference to cr we
 | |
|    * don't leak the window. */
 | |
|   gtk_cairo_set_event (cr, NULL);
 | |
|   cairo_destroy (cr);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return result;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static gboolean
 | |
| event_window_is_still_viewable (GdkEvent *event)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   /* Check that we think the event's window is viewable before
 | |
|    * delivering the event, to prevent suprises. We do this here
 | |
|    * at the last moment, since the event may have been queued
 | |
|    * up behind other events, held over a recursive main loop, etc.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   switch (event->type)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|     case GDK_EXPOSE:
 | |
|     case GDK_MOTION_NOTIFY:
 | |
|     case GDK_BUTTON_PRESS:
 | |
|     case GDK_2BUTTON_PRESS:
 | |
|     case GDK_3BUTTON_PRESS:
 | |
|     case GDK_KEY_PRESS:
 | |
|     case GDK_ENTER_NOTIFY:
 | |
|     case GDK_PROXIMITY_IN:
 | |
|     case GDK_SCROLL:
 | |
|       return event->any.window && gdk_window_is_viewable (event->any.window);
 | |
| 
 | |
| #if 0
 | |
|     /* The following events are the second half of paired events;
 | |
|      * we always deliver them to deal with widgets that clean up
 | |
|      * on the second half.
 | |
|      */
 | |
|     case GDK_BUTTON_RELEASE:
 | |
|     case GDK_KEY_RELEASE:
 | |
|     case GDK_LEAVE_NOTIFY:
 | |
|     case GDK_PROXIMITY_OUT:
 | |
| #endif
 | |
| 
 | |
|     default:
 | |
|       /* Remaining events would make sense on an not-viewable window,
 | |
|        * or don't have an associated window.
 | |
|        */
 | |
|       return TRUE;
 | |
|     }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static gint
 | |
| gtk_widget_event_internal (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
| 			   GdkEvent  *event)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   gboolean return_val = FALSE;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /* We check only once for is-still-visible; if someone
 | |
|    * hides the window in on of the signals on the widget,
 | |
|    * they are responsible for returning TRUE to terminate
 | |
|    * handling.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   if (!event_window_is_still_viewable (event))
 | |
|     return TRUE;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_object_ref (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[EVENT], 0, event, &return_val);
 | |
|   return_val |= !WIDGET_REALIZED_FOR_EVENT (widget, event);
 | |
|   if (!return_val)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       gint signal_num;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       switch (event->type)
 | |
| 	{
 | |
| 	case GDK_EXPOSE:
 | |
| 	case GDK_NOTHING:
 | |
| 	  signal_num = -1;
 | |
| 	  break;
 | |
| 	case GDK_BUTTON_PRESS:
 | |
| 	case GDK_2BUTTON_PRESS:
 | |
| 	case GDK_3BUTTON_PRESS:
 | |
| 	  signal_num = BUTTON_PRESS_EVENT;
 | |
| 	  break;
 | |
| 	case GDK_SCROLL:
 | |
| 	  signal_num = SCROLL_EVENT;
 | |
| 	  break;
 | |
| 	case GDK_BUTTON_RELEASE:
 | |
| 	  signal_num = BUTTON_RELEASE_EVENT;
 | |
| 	  break;
 | |
| 	case GDK_MOTION_NOTIFY:
 | |
| 	  signal_num = MOTION_NOTIFY_EVENT;
 | |
| 	  break;
 | |
| 	case GDK_DELETE:
 | |
| 	  signal_num = DELETE_EVENT;
 | |
| 	  break;
 | |
| 	case GDK_DESTROY:
 | |
| 	  signal_num = DESTROY_EVENT;
 | |
| 	  _gtk_tooltip_hide (widget);
 | |
| 	  break;
 | |
| 	case GDK_KEY_PRESS:
 | |
| 	  signal_num = KEY_PRESS_EVENT;
 | |
| 	  break;
 | |
| 	case GDK_KEY_RELEASE:
 | |
| 	  signal_num = KEY_RELEASE_EVENT;
 | |
| 	  break;
 | |
| 	case GDK_ENTER_NOTIFY:
 | |
| 	  signal_num = ENTER_NOTIFY_EVENT;
 | |
| 	  break;
 | |
| 	case GDK_LEAVE_NOTIFY:
 | |
| 	  signal_num = LEAVE_NOTIFY_EVENT;
 | |
| 	  break;
 | |
| 	case GDK_FOCUS_CHANGE:
 | |
| 	  signal_num = event->focus_change.in ? FOCUS_IN_EVENT : FOCUS_OUT_EVENT;
 | |
| 	  if (event->focus_change.in)
 | |
| 	    _gtk_tooltip_focus_in (widget);
 | |
| 	  else
 | |
| 	    _gtk_tooltip_focus_out (widget);
 | |
| 	  break;
 | |
| 	case GDK_CONFIGURE:
 | |
| 	  signal_num = CONFIGURE_EVENT;
 | |
| 	  break;
 | |
| 	case GDK_MAP:
 | |
| 	  signal_num = MAP_EVENT;
 | |
| 	  break;
 | |
| 	case GDK_UNMAP:
 | |
| 	  signal_num = UNMAP_EVENT;
 | |
| 	  break;
 | |
| 	case GDK_WINDOW_STATE:
 | |
| 	  signal_num = WINDOW_STATE_EVENT;
 | |
| 	  break;
 | |
| 	case GDK_PROPERTY_NOTIFY:
 | |
| 	  signal_num = PROPERTY_NOTIFY_EVENT;
 | |
| 	  break;
 | |
| 	case GDK_SELECTION_CLEAR:
 | |
| 	  signal_num = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT;
 | |
| 	  break;
 | |
| 	case GDK_SELECTION_REQUEST:
 | |
| 	  signal_num = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT;
 | |
| 	  break;
 | |
| 	case GDK_SELECTION_NOTIFY:
 | |
| 	  signal_num = SELECTION_NOTIFY_EVENT;
 | |
| 	  break;
 | |
| 	case GDK_PROXIMITY_IN:
 | |
| 	  signal_num = PROXIMITY_IN_EVENT;
 | |
| 	  break;
 | |
| 	case GDK_PROXIMITY_OUT:
 | |
| 	  signal_num = PROXIMITY_OUT_EVENT;
 | |
| 	  break;
 | |
| 	case GDK_VISIBILITY_NOTIFY:
 | |
| 	  signal_num = VISIBILITY_NOTIFY_EVENT;
 | |
| 	  break;
 | |
| 	case GDK_GRAB_BROKEN:
 | |
| 	  signal_num = GRAB_BROKEN_EVENT;
 | |
| 	  break;
 | |
| 	case GDK_DAMAGE:
 | |
| 	  signal_num = DAMAGE_EVENT;
 | |
| 	  break;
 | |
| 	default:
 | |
| 	  g_warning ("gtk_widget_event(): unhandled event type: %d", event->type);
 | |
| 	  signal_num = -1;
 | |
| 	  break;
 | |
| 	}
 | |
|       if (signal_num != -1)
 | |
| 	g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[signal_num], 0, event, &return_val);
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   if (WIDGET_REALIZED_FOR_EVENT (widget, event))
 | |
|     g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[EVENT_AFTER], 0, event);
 | |
|   else
 | |
|     return_val = TRUE;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_object_unref (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return return_val;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_activate:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget that's activatable
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * For widgets that can be "activated" (buttons, menu items, etc.)
 | |
|  * this function activates them. Activation is what happens when you
 | |
|  * press Enter on a widget during key navigation. If @widget isn't
 | |
|  * activatable, the function returns %FALSE.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: %TRUE if the widget was activatable
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| gboolean
 | |
| gtk_widget_activate (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (WIDGET_CLASS (widget)->activate_signal)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       /* FIXME: we should eventually check the signals signature here */
 | |
|       g_signal_emit (widget, WIDGET_CLASS (widget)->activate_signal, 0);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       return TRUE;
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   else
 | |
|     return FALSE;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_reparent_subwindows (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
| 				GdkWindow *new_window)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (!gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget))
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       GList *children = gdk_window_get_children (priv->window);
 | |
|       GList *tmp_list;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       for (tmp_list = children; tmp_list; tmp_list = tmp_list->next)
 | |
| 	{
 | |
| 	  GdkWindow *window = tmp_list->data;
 | |
| 	  gpointer child;
 | |
| 
 | |
| 	  gdk_window_get_user_data (window, &child);
 | |
| 	  while (child && child != widget)
 | |
| 	    child = ((GtkWidget*) child)->priv->parent;
 | |
| 
 | |
| 	  if (child)
 | |
| 	    gdk_window_reparent (window, new_window, 0, 0);
 | |
| 	}
 | |
| 
 | |
|       g_list_free (children);
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   else
 | |
|    {
 | |
|      GdkWindow *parent;
 | |
|      GList *tmp_list, *children;
 | |
| 
 | |
|      parent = gdk_window_get_parent (priv->window);
 | |
| 
 | |
|      if (parent == NULL)
 | |
|        gdk_window_reparent (priv->window, new_window, 0, 0);
 | |
|      else
 | |
|        {
 | |
| 	 children = gdk_window_get_children (parent);
 | |
| 
 | |
| 	 for (tmp_list = children; tmp_list; tmp_list = tmp_list->next)
 | |
| 	   {
 | |
| 	     GdkWindow *window = tmp_list->data;
 | |
| 	     gpointer child;
 | |
| 
 | |
| 	     gdk_window_get_user_data (window, &child);
 | |
| 
 | |
| 	     if (child == widget)
 | |
| 	       gdk_window_reparent (window, new_window, 0, 0);
 | |
| 	   }
 | |
| 
 | |
| 	 g_list_free (children);
 | |
|        }
 | |
|    }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_reparent_fixup_child (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
| 				 gpointer   client_data)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_assert (client_data != NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (!gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget))
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       if (priv->window)
 | |
| 	g_object_unref (priv->window);
 | |
|       priv->window = (GdkWindow*) client_data;
 | |
|       if (priv->window)
 | |
| 	g_object_ref (priv->window);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (GTK_IS_CONTAINER (widget))
 | |
|         gtk_container_forall (GTK_CONTAINER (widget),
 | |
|                               gtk_widget_reparent_fixup_child,
 | |
|                               client_data);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_reparent:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @new_parent: a #GtkContainer to move the widget into
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Moves a widget from one #GtkContainer to another, handling reference
 | |
|  * count issues to avoid destroying the widget.
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_reparent (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
| 		     GtkWidget *new_parent)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetPrivate *priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_CONTAINER (new_parent));
 | |
|   priv = widget->priv;
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (priv->parent != NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (priv->parent != new_parent)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       /* First try to see if we can get away without unrealizing
 | |
|        * the widget as we reparent it. if so we set a flag so
 | |
|        * that gtk_widget_unparent doesn't unrealize widget
 | |
|        */
 | |
|       if (gtk_widget_get_realized (widget) && gtk_widget_get_realized (new_parent))
 | |
| 	priv->in_reparent = TRUE;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       g_object_ref (widget);
 | |
|       gtk_container_remove (GTK_CONTAINER (priv->parent), widget);
 | |
|       gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (new_parent), widget);
 | |
|       g_object_unref (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (priv->in_reparent)
 | |
| 	{
 | |
|           priv->in_reparent = FALSE;
 | |
| 
 | |
| 	  gtk_widget_reparent_subwindows (widget, gtk_widget_get_parent_window (widget));
 | |
| 	  gtk_widget_reparent_fixup_child (widget,
 | |
| 					   gtk_widget_get_parent_window (widget));
 | |
| 	}
 | |
| 
 | |
|       g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), "parent");
 | |
|     }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_intersect:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @area: a rectangle
 | |
|  * @intersection: rectangle to store intersection of @widget and @area
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Computes the intersection of a @widget's area and @area, storing
 | |
|  * the intersection in @intersection, and returns %TRUE if there was
 | |
|  * an intersection.  @intersection may be %NULL if you're only
 | |
|  * interested in whether there was an intersection.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: %TRUE if there was an intersection
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| gboolean
 | |
| gtk_widget_intersect (GtkWidget	         *widget,
 | |
| 		      const GdkRectangle *area,
 | |
| 		      GdkRectangle       *intersection)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetPrivate *priv;
 | |
|   GdkRectangle *dest;
 | |
|   GdkRectangle tmp;
 | |
|   gint return_val;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE);
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (area != NULL, FALSE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   priv = widget->priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (intersection)
 | |
|     dest = intersection;
 | |
|   else
 | |
|     dest = &tmp;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return_val = gdk_rectangle_intersect (&priv->allocation, area, dest);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (return_val && intersection && gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget))
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       intersection->x -= priv->allocation.x;
 | |
|       intersection->y -= priv->allocation.y;
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return return_val;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_region_intersect:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @region: a #cairo_region_t, in the same coordinate system as
 | |
|  *          @widget->allocation. That is, relative to @widget->window
 | |
|  *          for %NO_WINDOW widgets; relative to the parent window
 | |
|  *          of @widget->window for widgets with their own window.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Computes the intersection of a @widget's area and @region, returning
 | |
|  * the intersection. The result may be empty, use cairo_region_is_empty() to
 | |
|  * check.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns: A newly allocated region holding the intersection of @widget
 | |
|  *     and @region. The coordinates of the return value are relative to
 | |
|  *     @widget->window for %NO_WINDOW widgets, and relative to the parent
 | |
|  *     window of @widget->window for widgets with their own window.
 | |
|  */
 | |
| cairo_region_t *
 | |
| gtk_widget_region_intersect (GtkWidget       *widget,
 | |
| 			     const cairo_region_t *region)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GdkRectangle rect;
 | |
|   cairo_region_t *dest;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL);
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (region != NULL, NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gtk_widget_get_allocation (widget, &rect);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   dest = cairo_region_create_rectangle (&rect);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   cairo_region_intersect (dest, region);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return dest;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * _gtk_widget_grab_notify:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @was_grabbed: whether a grab is now in effect
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Emits the #GtkWidget::grab-notify signal on @widget.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.6
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| _gtk_widget_grab_notify (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
| 			 gboolean   was_grabbed)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[GRAB_NOTIFY], 0, was_grabbed);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_grab_focus:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Causes @widget to have the keyboard focus for the #GtkWindow it's
 | |
|  * inside. @widget must be a focusable widget, such as a #GtkEntry;
 | |
|  * something like #GtkFrame won't work.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * More precisely, it must have the %GTK_CAN_FOCUS flag set. Use
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_set_can_focus() to modify that flag.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * The widget also needs to be realized and mapped. This is indicated by the
 | |
|  * related signals. Grabbing the focus immediately after creating the widget
 | |
|  * will likely fail and cause critical warnings.
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_grab_focus (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (!gtk_widget_is_sensitive (widget))
 | |
|     return;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_object_ref (widget);
 | |
|   g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[GRAB_FOCUS], 0);
 | |
|   g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), "has-focus");
 | |
|   g_object_unref (widget);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| reset_focus_recurse (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
| 		     gpointer   data)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   if (GTK_IS_CONTAINER (widget))
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       GtkContainer *container;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       container = GTK_CONTAINER (widget);
 | |
|       gtk_container_set_focus_child (container, NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       gtk_container_foreach (container,
 | |
| 			     reset_focus_recurse,
 | |
| 			     NULL);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_real_grab_focus (GtkWidget *focus_widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   if (gtk_widget_get_can_focus (focus_widget))
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       GtkWidget *toplevel;
 | |
|       GtkWidget *widget;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       /* clear the current focus setting, break if the current widget
 | |
|        * is the focus widget's parent, since containers above that will
 | |
|        * be set by the next loop.
 | |
|        */
 | |
|       toplevel = gtk_widget_get_toplevel (focus_widget);
 | |
|       if (gtk_widget_is_toplevel (toplevel) && GTK_IS_WINDOW (toplevel))
 | |
| 	{
 | |
|           widget = gtk_window_get_focus (GTK_WINDOW (toplevel));
 | |
| 
 | |
| 	  if (widget == focus_widget)
 | |
| 	    {
 | |
| 	      /* We call _gtk_window_internal_set_focus() here so that the
 | |
| 	       * toplevel window can request the focus if necessary.
 | |
| 	       * This is needed when the toplevel is a GtkPlug
 | |
| 	       */
 | |
| 	      if (!gtk_widget_has_focus (widget))
 | |
| 		_gtk_window_internal_set_focus (GTK_WINDOW (toplevel), focus_widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
| 	      return;
 | |
| 	    }
 | |
| 
 | |
| 	  if (widget)
 | |
| 	    {
 | |
| 	      while (widget->priv->parent && widget->priv->parent != focus_widget->priv->parent)
 | |
| 		{
 | |
| 		  widget = widget->priv->parent;
 | |
| 		  gtk_container_set_focus_child (GTK_CONTAINER (widget), NULL);
 | |
| 		}
 | |
| 	    }
 | |
| 	}
 | |
|       else if (toplevel != focus_widget)
 | |
| 	{
 | |
| 	  /* gtk_widget_grab_focus() operates on a tree without window...
 | |
| 	   * actually, this is very questionable behaviour.
 | |
| 	   */
 | |
| 
 | |
| 	  gtk_container_foreach (GTK_CONTAINER (toplevel),
 | |
| 				 reset_focus_recurse,
 | |
| 				 NULL);
 | |
| 	}
 | |
| 
 | |
|       /* now propagate the new focus up the widget tree and finally
 | |
|        * set it on the window
 | |
|        */
 | |
|       widget = focus_widget;
 | |
|       while (widget->priv->parent)
 | |
| 	{
 | |
| 	  gtk_container_set_focus_child (GTK_CONTAINER (widget->priv->parent), widget);
 | |
| 	  widget = widget->priv->parent;
 | |
| 	}
 | |
|       if (GTK_IS_WINDOW (widget))
 | |
| 	_gtk_window_internal_set_focus (GTK_WINDOW (widget), focus_widget);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static gboolean
 | |
| gtk_widget_real_query_tooltip (GtkWidget  *widget,
 | |
| 			       gint        x,
 | |
| 			       gint        y,
 | |
| 			       gboolean    keyboard_tip,
 | |
| 			       GtkTooltip *tooltip)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   gchar *tooltip_markup;
 | |
|   gboolean has_tooltip;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   tooltip_markup = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_tooltip_markup);
 | |
|   has_tooltip = GPOINTER_TO_UINT (g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_has_tooltip));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (has_tooltip && tooltip_markup)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       gtk_tooltip_set_markup (tooltip, tooltip_markup);
 | |
|       return TRUE;
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return FALSE;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_real_style_updated (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gtk_widget_update_pango_context (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (priv->style != NULL &&
 | |
|       priv->style != gtk_widget_get_default_style ())
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       /* Trigger ::style-set for old
 | |
|        * widgets not listening to this
 | |
|        */
 | |
|       g_signal_emit (widget,
 | |
|                      widget_signals[STYLE_SET],
 | |
|                      0,
 | |
|                      widget->priv->style);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (widget->priv->context)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       if (gtk_widget_get_realized (widget) &&
 | |
|           gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget))
 | |
|         gtk_style_context_set_background (widget->priv->context,
 | |
|                                           widget->priv->window);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (widget->priv->anchored)
 | |
|     gtk_widget_queue_resize (widget);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static gboolean
 | |
| gtk_widget_real_show_help (GtkWidget        *widget,
 | |
|                            GtkWidgetHelpType help_type)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   if (help_type == GTK_WIDGET_HELP_TOOLTIP)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       _gtk_tooltip_toggle_keyboard_mode (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       return TRUE;
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   else
 | |
|     return FALSE;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static gboolean
 | |
| gtk_widget_real_focus (GtkWidget         *widget,
 | |
|                        GtkDirectionType   direction)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   if (!gtk_widget_get_can_focus (widget))
 | |
|     return FALSE;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (!gtk_widget_is_focus (widget))
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       gtk_widget_grab_focus (widget);
 | |
|       return TRUE;
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   else
 | |
|     return FALSE;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_real_move_focus (GtkWidget         *widget,
 | |
|                             GtkDirectionType   direction)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidget *toplevel = gtk_widget_get_toplevel (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (widget != toplevel && GTK_IS_WINDOW (toplevel))
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       g_signal_emit (toplevel, widget_signals[MOVE_FOCUS], 0,
 | |
|                      direction);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static gboolean
 | |
| gtk_widget_real_keynav_failed (GtkWidget        *widget,
 | |
|                                GtkDirectionType  direction)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   gboolean cursor_only;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   switch (direction)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|     case GTK_DIR_TAB_FORWARD:
 | |
|     case GTK_DIR_TAB_BACKWARD:
 | |
|       return FALSE;
 | |
| 
 | |
|     case GTK_DIR_UP:
 | |
|     case GTK_DIR_DOWN:
 | |
|     case GTK_DIR_LEFT:
 | |
|     case GTK_DIR_RIGHT:
 | |
|       g_object_get (gtk_widget_get_settings (widget),
 | |
|                     "gtk-keynav-cursor-only", &cursor_only,
 | |
|                     NULL);
 | |
|       if (cursor_only)
 | |
|         return FALSE;
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gtk_widget_error_bell (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return TRUE;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_set_can_focus:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @can_focus: whether or not @widget can own the input focus.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Specifies whether @widget can own the input focus. See
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_grab_focus() for actually setting the input focus on a
 | |
|  * widget.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.18
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_set_can_focus (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                           gboolean   can_focus)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (widget->priv->can_focus != can_focus)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       widget->priv->can_focus = can_focus;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       gtk_widget_queue_resize (widget);
 | |
|       g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), "can-focus");
 | |
|     }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_can_focus:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Determines whether @widget can own the input focus. See
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_set_can_focus().
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: %TRUE if @widget can own the input focus, %FALSE otherwise
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.18
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| gboolean
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_can_focus (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return widget->priv->can_focus;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_has_focus:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Determines if the widget has the global input focus. See
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_is_focus() for the difference between having the global
 | |
|  * input focus, and only having the focus within a toplevel.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: %TRUE if the widget has the global input focus.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.18
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| gboolean
 | |
| gtk_widget_has_focus (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return widget->priv->has_focus;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_has_visible_focus:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Determines if the widget should show a visible indication that
 | |
|  * it has the global input focus. This is a convenience function for
 | |
|  * use in ::draw handlers that takes into account whether focus
 | |
|  * indication should currently be shown in the toplevel window of
 | |
|  * @widget. See gtk_window_get_focus_visible() for more information
 | |
|  * about focus indication.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * To find out if the widget has the global input focus, use
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_has_focus().
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: %TRUE if the widget should display a 'focus rectangle'
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 3.2
 | |
|  */
 | |
| gboolean
 | |
| gtk_widget_has_visible_focus (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   gboolean draw_focus;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (widget->priv->has_focus)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       GtkWidget *toplevel;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       toplevel = gtk_widget_get_toplevel (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (GTK_IS_WINDOW (toplevel))
 | |
|         draw_focus = gtk_window_get_focus_visible (GTK_WINDOW (toplevel));
 | |
|       else
 | |
|         draw_focus = TRUE;
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   else
 | |
|     draw_focus = FALSE;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return draw_focus;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_is_focus:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Determines if the widget is the focus widget within its
 | |
|  * toplevel. (This does not mean that the %HAS_FOCUS flag is
 | |
|  * necessarily set; %HAS_FOCUS will only be set if the
 | |
|  * toplevel widget additionally has the global input focus.)
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: %TRUE if the widget is the focus widget.
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| gboolean
 | |
| gtk_widget_is_focus (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidget *toplevel;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   toplevel = gtk_widget_get_toplevel (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (GTK_IS_WINDOW (toplevel))
 | |
|     return widget == gtk_window_get_focus (GTK_WINDOW (toplevel));
 | |
|   else
 | |
|     return FALSE;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_set_can_default:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @can_default: whether or not @widget can be a default widget.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Specifies whether @widget can be a default widget. See
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_grab_default() for details about the meaning of
 | |
|  * "default".
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.18
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_set_can_default (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                             gboolean   can_default)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (widget->priv->can_default != can_default)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       widget->priv->can_default = can_default;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       gtk_widget_queue_resize (widget);
 | |
|       g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), "can-default");
 | |
|     }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_can_default:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Determines whether @widget can be a default widget. See
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_set_can_default().
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: %TRUE if @widget can be a default widget, %FALSE otherwise
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.18
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| gboolean
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_can_default (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return widget->priv->can_default;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_has_default:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Determines whether @widget is the current default widget within its
 | |
|  * toplevel. See gtk_widget_set_can_default().
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: %TRUE if @widget is the current default widget within
 | |
|  *     its toplevel, %FALSE otherwise
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.18
 | |
|  */
 | |
| gboolean
 | |
| gtk_widget_has_default (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return widget->priv->has_default;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void
 | |
| _gtk_widget_set_has_default (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                              gboolean   has_default)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   widget->priv->has_default = has_default;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_grab_default:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Causes @widget to become the default widget. @widget must have the
 | |
|  * %GTK_CAN_DEFAULT flag set; typically you have to set this flag
 | |
|  * yourself by calling <literal>gtk_widget_set_can_default (@widget,
 | |
|  * %TRUE)</literal>. The default widget is activated when
 | |
|  * the user presses Enter in a window. Default widgets must be
 | |
|  * activatable, that is, gtk_widget_activate() should affect them. Note
 | |
|  * that #GtkEntry widgets require the "activates-default" property
 | |
|  * set to %TRUE before they activate the default widget when Enter
 | |
|  * is pressed and the #GtkEntry is focused.
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_grab_default (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidget *window;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (gtk_widget_get_can_default (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   window = gtk_widget_get_toplevel (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (window && gtk_widget_is_toplevel (window))
 | |
|     gtk_window_set_default (GTK_WINDOW (window), widget);
 | |
|   else
 | |
|     g_warning (G_STRLOC ": widget not within a GtkWindow");
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_set_receives_default:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @receives_default: whether or not @widget can be a default widget.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Specifies whether @widget will be treated as the default widget
 | |
|  * within its toplevel when it has the focus, even if another widget
 | |
|  * is the default.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * See gtk_widget_grab_default() for details about the meaning of
 | |
|  * "default".
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.18
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_set_receives_default (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                                  gboolean   receives_default)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (widget->priv->receives_default != receives_default)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       widget->priv->receives_default = receives_default;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), "receives-default");
 | |
|     }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_receives_default:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Determines whether @widget is alyways treated as default widget
 | |
|  * withing its toplevel when it has the focus, even if another widget
 | |
|  * is the default.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * See gtk_widget_set_receives_default().
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: %TRUE if @widget acts as default widget when focussed,
 | |
|  *               %FALSE otherwise
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.18
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| gboolean
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_receives_default (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return widget->priv->receives_default;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_has_grab:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Determines whether the widget is currently grabbing events, so it
 | |
|  * is the only widget receiving input events (keyboard and mouse).
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * See also gtk_grab_add().
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: %TRUE if the widget is in the grab_widgets stack
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.18
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| gboolean
 | |
| gtk_widget_has_grab (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return widget->priv->has_grab;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void
 | |
| _gtk_widget_set_has_grab (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                           gboolean   has_grab)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   widget->priv->has_grab = has_grab;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_device_is_shadowed:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @device: a #GdkDevice
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns %TRUE if @device has been shadowed by a GTK+
 | |
|  * device grab on another widget, so it would stop sending
 | |
|  * events to @widget. This may be used in the
 | |
|  * #GtkWidget::grab-notify signal to check for specific
 | |
|  * devices. See gtk_device_grab_add().
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns: %TRUE if there is an ongoing grab on @device
 | |
|  *          by another #GtkWidget than @widget.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 3.0
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| gboolean
 | |
| gtk_widget_device_is_shadowed (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                                GdkDevice *device)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWindowGroup *group;
 | |
|   GtkWidget *grab_widget, *toplevel;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE);
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GDK_IS_DEVICE (device), FALSE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (!gtk_widget_get_realized (widget))
 | |
|     return TRUE;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   toplevel = gtk_widget_get_toplevel (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (GTK_IS_WINDOW (toplevel))
 | |
|     group = gtk_window_get_group (GTK_WINDOW (toplevel));
 | |
|   else
 | |
|     group = gtk_window_get_group (NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   grab_widget = gtk_window_group_get_current_device_grab (group, device);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /* Widget not inside the hierarchy of grab_widget */
 | |
|   if (grab_widget &&
 | |
|       widget != grab_widget &&
 | |
|       !gtk_widget_is_ancestor (widget, grab_widget))
 | |
|     return TRUE;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   grab_widget = gtk_window_group_get_current_grab (group);
 | |
|   if (grab_widget && widget != grab_widget &&
 | |
|       !gtk_widget_is_ancestor (widget, grab_widget))
 | |
|     return TRUE;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return FALSE;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_set_name:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @name: name for the widget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Widgets can be named, which allows you to refer to them from a
 | |
|  * CSS file. You can apply a style to widgets with a particular name
 | |
|  * in the CSS file. See the documentation for the CSS syntax (on the
 | |
|  * same page as the docs for #GtkStyleContext).
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Note that the CSS syntax has certain special characters to delimit
 | |
|  * and represent elements in a selector (period, #, >, *...),
 | |
|  * so using these will make your widget impossible to match by name.
 | |
|  * Any combination of alphanumeric symbols, dashes and underscores will
 | |
|  * suffice.
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_set_name (GtkWidget	 *widget,
 | |
| 		     const gchar *name)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetPrivate *priv;
 | |
|   gchar *new_name;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   priv = widget->priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   new_name = g_strdup (name);
 | |
|   g_free (priv->name);
 | |
|   priv->name = new_name;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gtk_widget_reset_style (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), "name");
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_name:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Retrieves the name of a widget. See gtk_widget_set_name() for the
 | |
|  * significance of widget names.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: name of the widget. This string is owned by GTK+ and
 | |
|  * should not be modified or freed
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| const gchar*
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_name (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetPrivate *priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   priv = widget->priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (priv->name)
 | |
|     return priv->name;
 | |
|   return G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| _gtk_widget_update_state_flags (GtkWidget     *widget,
 | |
|                                 GtkStateFlags  flags,
 | |
|                                 guint          operation)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetPrivate *priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   priv = widget->priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /* Handle insensitive first, since it is propagated
 | |
|    * differently throughout the widget hierarchy.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   if ((priv->state_flags & GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE) && (flags & GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE) && (operation == STATE_CHANGE_UNSET))
 | |
|     gtk_widget_set_sensitive (widget, TRUE);
 | |
|   else if (!(priv->state_flags & GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE) && (flags & GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE) && (operation != STATE_CHANGE_UNSET))
 | |
|     gtk_widget_set_sensitive (widget, FALSE);
 | |
|   else if ((priv->state_flags & GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE) && !(flags & GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE) && (operation == STATE_CHANGE_REPLACE))
 | |
|     gtk_widget_set_sensitive (widget, TRUE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (operation != STATE_CHANGE_REPLACE)
 | |
|     flags &= ~(GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (flags != 0 ||
 | |
|       operation == STATE_CHANGE_REPLACE)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       GtkStateData data;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       data.flags = flags;
 | |
|       data.operation = operation;
 | |
|       data.use_forall = FALSE;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       gtk_widget_propagate_state (widget, &data);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       gtk_widget_queue_resize (widget);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_set_state_flags:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @flags: State flags to turn on
 | |
|  * @clear: Whether to clear state before turning on @flags
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * This function is for use in widget implementations. Turns on flag
 | |
|  * values in the current widget state (insensitive, prelighted, etc.).
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * It is worth mentioning that any other state than %GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE,
 | |
|  * will be propagated down to all non-internal children if @widget is a
 | |
|  * #GtkContainer, while %GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE itself will be propagated
 | |
|  * down to all #GtkContainer children by different means than turning on the
 | |
|  * state flag down the hierarchy, both gtk_widget_get_state_flags() and
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_is_sensitive() will make use of these.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 3.0
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_set_state_flags (GtkWidget     *widget,
 | |
|                             GtkStateFlags  flags,
 | |
|                             gboolean       clear)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if ((!clear && (widget->priv->state_flags & flags) == flags) ||
 | |
|       (clear && widget->priv->state_flags == flags))
 | |
|     return;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (clear)
 | |
|     _gtk_widget_update_state_flags (widget, flags, STATE_CHANGE_REPLACE);
 | |
|   else
 | |
|     _gtk_widget_update_state_flags (widget, flags, STATE_CHANGE_SET);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_unset_state_flags:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @flags: State flags to turn off
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * This function is for use in widget implementations. Turns off flag
 | |
|  * values for the current widget state (insensitive, prelighted, etc.).
 | |
|  * See gtk_widget_set_state_flags().
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 3.0
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_unset_state_flags (GtkWidget     *widget,
 | |
|                               GtkStateFlags  flags)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if ((widget->priv->state_flags & flags) == 0)
 | |
|     return;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   _gtk_widget_update_state_flags (widget, flags, STATE_CHANGE_UNSET);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_state_flags:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns the widget state as a flag set. It is worth mentioning
 | |
|  * that the effective %GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE state will be
 | |
|  * returned, that is, also based on parent insensitivity, even if
 | |
|  * @widget itself is sensitive.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns: The state flags for widget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 3.0
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| GtkStateFlags
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_state_flags (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkStateFlags flags;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), 0);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   flags = widget->priv->state_flags;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (gtk_widget_has_focus (widget))
 | |
|     flags |= GTK_STATE_FLAG_FOCUSED;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return flags;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_set_state:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @state: new state for @widget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * This function is for use in widget implementations. Sets the state
 | |
|  * of a widget (insensitive, prelighted, etc.) Usually you should set
 | |
|  * the state using wrapper functions such as gtk_widget_set_sensitive().
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Deprecated: 3.0. Use gtk_widget_set_state_flags() instead.
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_set_state (GtkWidget           *widget,
 | |
| 		      GtkStateType         state)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkStateFlags flags;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (state == gtk_widget_get_state (widget))
 | |
|     return;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   switch (state)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|     case GTK_STATE_ACTIVE:
 | |
|       flags = GTK_STATE_FLAG_ACTIVE;
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case GTK_STATE_PRELIGHT:
 | |
|       flags = GTK_STATE_FLAG_PRELIGHT;
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case GTK_STATE_SELECTED:
 | |
|       flags = GTK_STATE_FLAG_SELECTED;
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case GTK_STATE_INSENSITIVE:
 | |
|       flags = GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE;
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case GTK_STATE_INCONSISTENT:
 | |
|       flags = GTK_STATE_FLAG_INCONSISTENT;
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case GTK_STATE_FOCUSED:
 | |
|       flags = GTK_STATE_FLAG_FOCUSED;
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case GTK_STATE_NORMAL:
 | |
|     default:
 | |
|       flags = 0;
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   _gtk_widget_update_state_flags (widget, flags, STATE_CHANGE_REPLACE);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_state:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns the widget's state. See gtk_widget_set_state().
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns: the state of @widget.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.18
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Deprecated: 3.0. Use gtk_widget_get_state_flags() instead.
 | |
|  */
 | |
| GtkStateType
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_state (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkStateFlags flags;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), GTK_STATE_NORMAL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   flags = gtk_widget_get_state_flags (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (flags & GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE)
 | |
|     return GTK_STATE_INSENSITIVE;
 | |
|   else if (flags & GTK_STATE_FLAG_ACTIVE)
 | |
|     return GTK_STATE_ACTIVE;
 | |
|   else if (flags & GTK_STATE_FLAG_SELECTED)
 | |
|     return GTK_STATE_SELECTED;
 | |
|   else if (flags & GTK_STATE_FLAG_PRELIGHT)
 | |
|     return GTK_STATE_PRELIGHT;
 | |
|   else
 | |
|     return GTK_STATE_NORMAL;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_set_visible:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @visible: whether the widget should be shown or not
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Sets the visibility state of @widget. Note that setting this to
 | |
|  * %TRUE doesn't mean the widget is actually viewable, see
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_visible().
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * This function simply calls gtk_widget_show() or gtk_widget_hide()
 | |
|  * but is nicer to use when the visibility of the widget depends on
 | |
|  * some condition.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.18
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_set_visible (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                         gboolean   visible)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (visible != gtk_widget_get_visible (widget))
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       if (visible)
 | |
|         gtk_widget_show (widget);
 | |
|       else
 | |
|         gtk_widget_hide (widget);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void
 | |
| _gtk_widget_set_visible_flag (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                               gboolean   visible)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   widget->priv->visible = visible;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_visible:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Determines whether the widget is visible. Note that this doesn't
 | |
|  * take into account whether the widget's parent is also visible
 | |
|  * or the widget is obscured in any way.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * See gtk_widget_set_visible().
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: %TRUE if the widget is visible
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.18
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| gboolean
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_visible (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return widget->priv->visible;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_set_has_window:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @has_window: whether or not @widget has a window.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Specifies whether @widget has a #GdkWindow of its own. Note that
 | |
|  * all realized widgets have a non-%NULL "window" pointer
 | |
|  * (gtk_widget_get_window() never returns a %NULL window when a widget
 | |
|  * is realized), but for many of them it's actually the #GdkWindow of
 | |
|  * one of its parent widgets. Widgets that do not create a %window for
 | |
|  * themselves in #GtkWidget::realize must announce this by
 | |
|  * calling this function with @has_window = %FALSE.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * This function should only be called by widget implementations,
 | |
|  * and they should call it in their init() function.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.18
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_set_has_window (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                            gboolean   has_window)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   widget->priv->no_window = !has_window;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_has_window:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Determines whether @widget has a #GdkWindow of its own. See
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_set_has_window().
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: %TRUE if @widget has a window, %FALSE otherwise
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.18
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| gboolean
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_has_window (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return ! widget->priv->no_window;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_is_toplevel:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Determines whether @widget is a toplevel widget.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Currently only #GtkWindow and #GtkInvisible (and out-of-process
 | |
|  * #GtkPlugs) are toplevel widgets. Toplevel widgets have no parent
 | |
|  * widget.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: %TRUE if @widget is a toplevel, %FALSE otherwise
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.18
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| gboolean
 | |
| gtk_widget_is_toplevel (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return widget->priv->toplevel;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void
 | |
| _gtk_widget_set_is_toplevel (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                              gboolean   is_toplevel)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   widget->priv->toplevel = is_toplevel;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_is_drawable:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Determines whether @widget can be drawn to. A widget can be drawn
 | |
|  * to if it is mapped and visible.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: %TRUE if @widget is drawable, %FALSE otherwise
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.18
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| gboolean
 | |
| gtk_widget_is_drawable (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return (gtk_widget_get_visible (widget) &&
 | |
|           gtk_widget_get_mapped (widget));
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_realized:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Determines whether @widget is realized.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: %TRUE if @widget is realized, %FALSE otherwise
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.20
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| gboolean
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_realized (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return widget->priv->realized;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_set_realized:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @realized: %TRUE to mark the widget as realized
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Marks the widget as being realized.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * This function should only ever be called in a derived widget's
 | |
|  * "realize" or "unrealize" implementation.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.20
 | |
|  */
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_set_realized (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                          gboolean   realized)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   widget->priv->realized = realized;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_mapped:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Whether the widget is mapped.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: %TRUE if the widget is mapped, %FALSE otherwise.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.20
 | |
|  */
 | |
| gboolean
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_mapped (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return widget->priv->mapped;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_set_mapped:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @mapped: %TRUE to mark the widget as mapped
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Marks the widget as being realized.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * This function should only ever be called in a derived widget's
 | |
|  * "map" or "unmap" implementation.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.20
 | |
|  */
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_set_mapped (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                        gboolean   mapped)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   widget->priv->mapped = mapped;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_set_app_paintable:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @app_paintable: %TRUE if the application will paint on the widget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Sets whether the application intends to draw on the widget in
 | |
|  * an #GtkWidget::draw handler.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * This is a hint to the widget and does not affect the behavior of
 | |
|  * the GTK+ core; many widgets ignore this flag entirely. For widgets
 | |
|  * that do pay attention to the flag, such as #GtkEventBox and #GtkWindow,
 | |
|  * the effect is to suppress default themed drawing of the widget's
 | |
|  * background. (Children of the widget will still be drawn.) The application
 | |
|  * is then entirely responsible for drawing the widget background.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Note that the background is still drawn when the widget is mapped.
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_set_app_paintable (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
| 			      gboolean   app_paintable)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   app_paintable = (app_paintable != FALSE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (widget->priv->app_paintable != app_paintable)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       widget->priv->app_paintable = app_paintable;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (gtk_widget_is_drawable (widget))
 | |
| 	gtk_widget_queue_draw (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), "app-paintable");
 | |
|     }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_app_paintable:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Determines whether the application intends to draw on the widget in
 | |
|  * an #GtkWidget::draw handler.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * See gtk_widget_set_app_paintable()
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: %TRUE if the widget is app paintable
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.18
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| gboolean
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_app_paintable (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return widget->priv->app_paintable;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_set_double_buffered:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @double_buffered: %TRUE to double-buffer a widget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Widgets are double buffered by default; you can use this function
 | |
|  * to turn off the buffering. "Double buffered" simply means that
 | |
|  * gdk_window_begin_paint_region() and gdk_window_end_paint() are called
 | |
|  * automatically around expose events sent to the
 | |
|  * widget. gdk_window_begin_paint() diverts all drawing to a widget's
 | |
|  * window to an offscreen buffer, and gdk_window_end_paint() draws the
 | |
|  * buffer to the screen. The result is that users see the window
 | |
|  * update in one smooth step, and don't see individual graphics
 | |
|  * primitives being rendered.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * In very simple terms, double buffered widgets don't flicker,
 | |
|  * so you would only use this function to turn off double buffering
 | |
|  * if you had special needs and really knew what you were doing.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Note: if you turn off double-buffering, you have to handle
 | |
|  * expose events, since even the clearing to the background color or
 | |
|  * pixmap will not happen automatically (as it is done in
 | |
|  * gdk_window_begin_paint()).
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_set_double_buffered (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
| 				gboolean   double_buffered)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   double_buffered = (double_buffered != FALSE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (widget->priv->double_buffered != double_buffered)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       widget->priv->double_buffered = double_buffered;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), "double-buffered");
 | |
|     }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_double_buffered:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Determines whether the widget is double buffered.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * See gtk_widget_set_double_buffered()
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: %TRUE if the widget is double buffered
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.18
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| gboolean
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_double_buffered (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return widget->priv->double_buffered;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_set_redraw_on_allocate:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @redraw_on_allocate: if %TRUE, the entire widget will be redrawn
 | |
|  *   when it is allocated to a new size. Otherwise, only the
 | |
|  *   new portion of the widget will be redrawn.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Sets whether the entire widget is queued for drawing when its size
 | |
|  * allocation changes. By default, this setting is %TRUE and
 | |
|  * the entire widget is redrawn on every size change. If your widget
 | |
|  * leaves the upper left unchanged when made bigger, turning this
 | |
|  * setting off will improve performance.
 | |
| 
 | |
|  * Note that for %NO_WINDOW widgets setting this flag to %FALSE turns
 | |
|  * off all allocation on resizing: the widget will not even redraw if
 | |
|  * its position changes; this is to allow containers that don't draw
 | |
|  * anything to avoid excess invalidations. If you set this flag on a
 | |
|  * %NO_WINDOW widget that <emphasis>does</emphasis> draw on @widget->window,
 | |
|  * you are responsible for invalidating both the old and new allocation
 | |
|  * of the widget when the widget is moved and responsible for invalidating
 | |
|  * regions newly when the widget increases size.
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_set_redraw_on_allocate (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
| 				   gboolean   redraw_on_allocate)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   widget->priv->redraw_on_alloc = redraw_on_allocate;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_set_sensitive:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @sensitive: %TRUE to make the widget sensitive
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Sets the sensitivity of a widget. A widget is sensitive if the user
 | |
|  * can interact with it. Insensitive widgets are "grayed out" and the
 | |
|  * user can't interact with them. Insensitive widgets are known as
 | |
|  * "inactive", "disabled", or "ghosted" in some other toolkits.
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_set_sensitive (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
| 			  gboolean   sensitive)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetPrivate *priv;
 | |
|   GtkStateData data;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   priv = widget->priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   sensitive = (sensitive != FALSE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (priv->sensitive == sensitive)
 | |
|     return;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   data.flags = GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (sensitive)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       priv->sensitive = TRUE;
 | |
|       data.operation = STATE_CHANGE_UNSET;
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   else
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       priv->sensitive = FALSE;
 | |
|       data.operation = STATE_CHANGE_SET;
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   data.use_forall = TRUE;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gtk_widget_propagate_state (widget, &data);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gtk_widget_queue_resize (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), "sensitive");
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_sensitive:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns the widget's sensitivity (in the sense of returning
 | |
|  * the value that has been set using gtk_widget_set_sensitive()).
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * The effective sensitivity of a widget is however determined by both its
 | |
|  * own and its parent widget's sensitivity. See gtk_widget_is_sensitive().
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns: %TRUE if the widget is sensitive
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.18
 | |
|  */
 | |
| gboolean
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_sensitive (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return widget->priv->sensitive;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_is_sensitive:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns the widget's effective sensitivity, which means
 | |
|  * it is sensitive itself and also its parent widget is sensitive
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns: %TRUE if the widget is effectively sensitive
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.18
 | |
|  */
 | |
| gboolean
 | |
| gtk_widget_is_sensitive (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return !(widget->priv->state_flags & GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| _gtk_widget_update_path (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   if (widget->priv->path)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       gtk_widget_path_free (widget->priv->path);
 | |
|       widget->priv->path = NULL;
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gtk_widget_get_path (widget);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_set_parent:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @parent: parent container
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * This function is useful only when implementing subclasses of
 | |
|  * #GtkContainer.
 | |
|  * Sets the container as the parent of @widget, and takes care of
 | |
|  * some details such as updating the state and style of the child
 | |
|  * to reflect its new location. The opposite function is
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_unparent().
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_set_parent (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
| 		       GtkWidget *parent)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkStateFlags parent_flags;
 | |
|   GtkWidgetPrivate *priv;
 | |
|   GtkStateData data;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (parent));
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (widget != parent);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   priv = widget->priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (priv->parent != NULL)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       g_warning ("Can't set a parent on widget which has a parent\n");
 | |
|       return;
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   if (gtk_widget_is_toplevel (widget))
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       g_warning ("Can't set a parent on a toplevel widget\n");
 | |
|       return;
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /* keep this function in sync with gtk_menu_attach_to_widget()
 | |
|    */
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_object_ref_sink (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gtk_widget_push_verify_invariants (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   priv->parent = parent;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   parent_flags = gtk_widget_get_state_flags (parent);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /* Merge both old state and current parent state,
 | |
|    * making sure to only propagate the right states */
 | |
|   data.flags = parent_flags & GTK_STATE_FLAGS_DO_PROPAGATE;
 | |
|   data.flags |= priv->state_flags;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   data.operation = STATE_CHANGE_REPLACE;
 | |
|   data.use_forall = gtk_widget_is_sensitive (parent) != gtk_widget_is_sensitive (widget);
 | |
|   gtk_widget_propagate_state (widget, &data);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gtk_widget_reset_style (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[PARENT_SET], 0, NULL);
 | |
|   if (priv->parent->priv->anchored)
 | |
|     _gtk_widget_propagate_hierarchy_changed (widget, NULL);
 | |
|   g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), "parent");
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /* Enforce realized/mapped invariants
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   if (gtk_widget_get_realized (priv->parent))
 | |
|     gtk_widget_realize (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (gtk_widget_get_visible (priv->parent) &&
 | |
|       gtk_widget_get_visible (widget))
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       if (gtk_widget_get_child_visible (widget) &&
 | |
| 	  gtk_widget_get_mapped (priv->parent))
 | |
| 	gtk_widget_map (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       gtk_widget_queue_resize (widget);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /* child may cause parent's expand to change, if the child is
 | |
|    * expanded. If child is not expanded, then it can't modify the
 | |
|    * parent's expand. If the child becomes expanded later then it will
 | |
|    * queue compute_expand then. This optimization plus defaulting
 | |
|    * newly-constructed widgets to need_compute_expand=FALSE should
 | |
|    * mean that initially building a widget tree doesn't have to keep
 | |
|    * walking up setting need_compute_expand on parents over and over.
 | |
|    *
 | |
|    * We can't change a parent to need to expand unless we're visible.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   if (gtk_widget_get_visible (widget) &&
 | |
|       (priv->need_compute_expand ||
 | |
|        priv->computed_hexpand ||
 | |
|        priv->computed_vexpand))
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       gtk_widget_queue_compute_expand (parent);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gtk_widget_pop_verify_invariants (widget);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_parent:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns the parent container of @widget.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: (transfer none): the parent container of @widget, or %NULL
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| GtkWidget *
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_parent (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return widget->priv->parent;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /*****************************************
 | |
|  * Widget styles
 | |
|  * see docs/styles.txt
 | |
|  *****************************************/
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_style_attach:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * This function attaches the widget's #GtkStyle to the widget's
 | |
|  * #GdkWindow. It is a replacement for
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * <programlisting>
 | |
|  * widget->style = gtk_style_attach (widget->style, widget->window);
 | |
|  * </programlisting>
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * and should only ever be called in a derived widget's "realize"
 | |
|  * implementation which does not chain up to its parent class'
 | |
|  * "realize" implementation, because one of the parent classes
 | |
|  * (finally #GtkWidget) would attach the style itself.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.20
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Deprecated: 3.0. This step is unnecessary with #GtkStyleContext.
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_style_attach (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (gtk_widget_get_realized (widget));
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_has_rc_style:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Determines if the widget style has been looked up through the rc mechanism.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns: %TRUE if the widget has been looked up through the rc
 | |
|  *   mechanism, %FALSE otherwise.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.20
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Deprecated:3.0: Use #GtkStyleContext instead
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| gboolean
 | |
| gtk_widget_has_rc_style (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return widget->priv->rc_style;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_set_style:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @style: (allow-none): a #GtkStyle, or %NULL to remove the effect
 | |
|  *     of a previous call to gtk_widget_set_style() and go back to
 | |
|  *     the default style
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Used to set the #GtkStyle for a widget (@widget->style). Since
 | |
|  * GTK 3, this function does nothing, the passed in style is ignored.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Deprecated:3.0: Use #GtkStyleContext instead
 | |
|  */
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_set_style (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                       GtkStyle  *style)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_ensure_style:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Ensures that @widget has a style (@widget->style).
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Not a very useful function; most of the time, if you
 | |
|  * want the style, the widget is realized, and realized
 | |
|  * widgets are guaranteed to have a style already.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Deprecated:3.0: Use #GtkStyleContext instead
 | |
|  */
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_ensure_style (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetPrivate *priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   priv = widget->priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (priv->style == gtk_widget_get_default_style ())
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       g_object_unref (priv->style);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       priv->style = NULL;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       g_signal_emit (widget,
 | |
|                      widget_signals[STYLE_SET],
 | |
|                      0, NULL);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_style:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Simply an accessor function that returns @widget->style.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: (transfer none): the widget's #GtkStyle
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Deprecated:3.0: Use #GtkStyleContext instead
 | |
|  */
 | |
| GtkStyle*
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_style (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetPrivate *priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   priv = widget->priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (priv->style == NULL)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       priv->style = g_object_new (GTK_TYPE_STYLE,
 | |
|                                   "context", gtk_widget_get_style_context (widget),
 | |
|                                   NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return priv->style;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_modify_style:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @style: the #GtkRcStyle holding the style modifications
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Modifies style values on the widget.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Modifications made using this technique take precedence over
 | |
|  * style values set via an RC file, however, they will be overridden
 | |
|  * if a style is explicitely set on the widget using gtk_widget_set_style().
 | |
|  * The #GtkRcStyle structure is designed so each field can either be
 | |
|  * set or unset, so it is possible, using this function, to modify some
 | |
|  * style values and leave the others unchanged.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Note that modifications made with this function are not cumulative
 | |
|  * with previous calls to gtk_widget_modify_style() or with such
 | |
|  * functions as gtk_widget_modify_fg(). If you wish to retain
 | |
|  * previous values, you must first call gtk_widget_get_modifier_style(),
 | |
|  * make your modifications to the returned style, then call
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_modify_style() with that style. On the other hand,
 | |
|  * if you first call gtk_widget_modify_style(), subsequent calls
 | |
|  * to such functions gtk_widget_modify_fg() will have a cumulative
 | |
|  * effect with the initial modifications.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Deprecated:3.0: Use #GtkStyleContext with a custom #GtkStyleProvider instead
 | |
|  */
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_modify_style (GtkWidget      *widget,
 | |
|                          GtkRcStyle     *style)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_RC_STYLE (style));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (widget),
 | |
|                            quark_rc_style,
 | |
|                            gtk_rc_style_copy (style),
 | |
|                            (GDestroyNotify) g_object_unref);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_modifier_style:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns the current modifier style for the widget. (As set by
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_modify_style().) If no style has previously set, a new
 | |
|  * #GtkRcStyle will be created with all values unset, and set as the
 | |
|  * modifier style for the widget. If you make changes to this rc
 | |
|  * style, you must call gtk_widget_modify_style(), passing in the
 | |
|  * returned rc style, to make sure that your changes take effect.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Caution: passing the style back to gtk_widget_modify_style() will
 | |
|  * normally end up destroying it, because gtk_widget_modify_style() copies
 | |
|  * the passed-in style and sets the copy as the new modifier style,
 | |
|  * thus dropping any reference to the old modifier style. Add a reference
 | |
|  * to the modifier style if you want to keep it alive.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: (transfer none): the modifier style for the widget.
 | |
|  *     This rc style is owned by the widget. If you want to keep a
 | |
|  *     pointer to value this around, you must add a refcount using
 | |
|  *     g_object_ref().
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Deprecated:3.0: Use #GtkStyleContext with a custom #GtkStyleProvider instead
 | |
|  */
 | |
| GtkRcStyle *
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_modifier_style (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkRcStyle *rc_style;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   rc_style = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_rc_style);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (!rc_style)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       rc_style = gtk_rc_style_new ();
 | |
|       g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (widget),
 | |
|                                quark_rc_style,
 | |
|                                rc_style,
 | |
|                                (GDestroyNotify) g_object_unref);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return rc_style;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_modify_color_component (GtkWidget      *widget,
 | |
|                                    GtkRcFlags      component,
 | |
|                                    GtkStateType    state,
 | |
|                                    const GdkColor *color)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkRcStyle *rc_style = gtk_widget_get_modifier_style (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (color)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       switch (component)
 | |
|         {
 | |
|         case GTK_RC_FG:
 | |
|           rc_style->fg[state] = *color;
 | |
|           break;
 | |
|         case GTK_RC_BG:
 | |
|           rc_style->bg[state] = *color;
 | |
|           break;
 | |
|         case GTK_RC_TEXT:
 | |
|           rc_style->text[state] = *color;
 | |
|           break;
 | |
|         case GTK_RC_BASE:
 | |
|           rc_style->base[state] = *color;
 | |
|           break;
 | |
|         default:
 | |
|           g_assert_not_reached();
 | |
|         }
 | |
| 
 | |
|       rc_style->color_flags[state] |= component;
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   else
 | |
|     rc_style->color_flags[state] &= ~component;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gtk_widget_modify_style (widget, rc_style);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| modifier_style_changed (GtkModifierStyle *style,
 | |
|                         GtkWidget        *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkStyleContext *context;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   context = gtk_widget_get_style_context (widget);
 | |
|   gtk_style_context_invalidate (context);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static GtkModifierStyle *
 | |
| _gtk_widget_get_modifier_properties (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkModifierStyle *style;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   style = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_modifier_style);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (G_UNLIKELY (!style))
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       GtkStyleContext *context;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       style = _gtk_modifier_style_new ();
 | |
|       g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (widget),
 | |
|                                quark_modifier_style,
 | |
|                                style,
 | |
|                                (GDestroyNotify) g_object_unref);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       g_signal_connect (style, "changed",
 | |
|                         G_CALLBACK (modifier_style_changed), widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       context = gtk_widget_get_style_context (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       gtk_style_context_add_provider (context,
 | |
|                                       GTK_STYLE_PROVIDER (style),
 | |
|                                       GTK_STYLE_PROVIDER_PRIORITY_APPLICATION);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return style;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_override_color:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @state: the state for which to set the color
 | |
|  * @color: (allow-none): the color to assign, or %NULL to undo the effect
 | |
|  *     of previous calls to gtk_widget_override_color()
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Sets the color to use for a widget.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * All other style values are left untouched.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * <note><para>
 | |
|  * This API is mostly meant as a quick way for applications to
 | |
|  * change a widget appearance. If you are developing a widgets
 | |
|  * library and intend this change to be themeable, it is better
 | |
|  * done by setting meaningful CSS classes and regions in your
 | |
|  * widget/container implementation through gtk_style_context_add_class()
 | |
|  * and gtk_style_context_add_region().
 | |
|  * </para><para>
 | |
|  * This way, your widget library can install a #GtkCssProvider
 | |
|  * with the %GTK_STYLE_PROVIDER_PRIORITY_FALLBACK priority in order
 | |
|  * to provide a default styling for those widgets that need so, and
 | |
|  * this theming may fully overridden by the user's theme.
 | |
|  * </para></note>
 | |
|  * <note><para>
 | |
|  * Note that for complex widgets this may bring in undesired
 | |
|  * results (such as uniform background color everywhere), in
 | |
|  * these cases it is better to fully style such widgets through a
 | |
|  * #GtkCssProvider with the %GTK_STYLE_PROVIDER_PRIORITY_APPLICATION
 | |
|  * priority.
 | |
|  * </para></note>
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 3.0
 | |
|  */
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_override_color (GtkWidget     *widget,
 | |
|                            GtkStateFlags  state,
 | |
|                            const GdkRGBA *color)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkModifierStyle *style;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   style = _gtk_widget_get_modifier_properties (widget);
 | |
|   _gtk_modifier_style_set_color (style, state, color);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_override_background_color:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @state: the state for which to set the background color
 | |
|  * @color: (allow-none): the color to assign, or %NULL to undo the effect
 | |
|  *     of previous calls to gtk_widget_override_background_color()
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Sets the background color to use for a widget.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * All other style values are left untouched.
 | |
|  * See gtk_widget_override_color().
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 3.0
 | |
|  */
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_override_background_color (GtkWidget     *widget,
 | |
|                                       GtkStateFlags  state,
 | |
|                                       const GdkRGBA *color)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkModifierStyle *style;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   style = _gtk_widget_get_modifier_properties (widget);
 | |
|   _gtk_modifier_style_set_background_color (style, state, color);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_override_font:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @font_desc: (allow-none): the font descriptiong to use, or %NULL to undo
 | |
|  *     the effect of previous calls to gtk_widget_override_font()
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Sets the font to use for a widget. All other style values are
 | |
|  * left untouched. See gtk_widget_override_color().
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 3.0
 | |
|  */
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_override_font (GtkWidget                  *widget,
 | |
|                           const PangoFontDescription *font_desc)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkModifierStyle *style;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   style = _gtk_widget_get_modifier_properties (widget);
 | |
|   _gtk_modifier_style_set_font (style, font_desc);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_override_symbolic_color:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @name: the name of the symbolic color to modify
 | |
|  * @color: (allow-none): the color to assign (does not need
 | |
|  *     to be allocated), or %NULL to undo the effect of previous
 | |
|  *     calls to gtk_widget_override_symbolic_color()
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Sets a symbolic color for a widget.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * All other style values are left untouched.
 | |
|  * See gtk_widget_override_color() for overriding the foreground
 | |
|  * or background color.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 3.0
 | |
|  */
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_override_symbolic_color (GtkWidget     *widget,
 | |
|                                     const gchar   *name,
 | |
|                                     const GdkRGBA *color)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkModifierStyle *style;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   style = _gtk_widget_get_modifier_properties (widget);
 | |
|   _gtk_modifier_style_map_color (style, name, color);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_override_cursor:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @cursor: (allow-none): the color to use for primary cursor (does not need to be
 | |
|  *     allocated), or %NULL to undo the effect of previous calls to
 | |
|  *     of gtk_widget_override_cursor().
 | |
|  * @secondary_cursor: (allow-none): the color to use for secondary cursor (does not
 | |
|  *     need to be allocated), or %NULL to undo the effect of previous
 | |
|  *     calls to of gtk_widget_override_cursor().
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Sets the cursor color to use in a widget, overriding the
 | |
|  * #GtkWidget:cursor-color and #GtkWidget:secondary-cursor-color
 | |
|  * style properties. All other style values are left untouched.
 | |
|  * See also gtk_widget_modify_style().
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Note that the underlying properties have the #GdkColor type,
 | |
|  * so the alpha value in @primary and @secondary will be ignored.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 3.0
 | |
|  */
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_override_cursor (GtkWidget     *widget,
 | |
|                             const GdkRGBA *cursor,
 | |
|                             const GdkRGBA *secondary_cursor)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkModifierStyle *style;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   style = _gtk_widget_get_modifier_properties (widget);
 | |
|   _gtk_modifier_style_set_color_property (style,
 | |
|                                           GTK_TYPE_WIDGET,
 | |
|                                           "cursor-color", cursor);
 | |
|   _gtk_modifier_style_set_color_property (style,
 | |
|                                           GTK_TYPE_WIDGET,
 | |
|                                           "secondary-cursor-color",
 | |
|                                           secondary_cursor);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_modify_fg:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @state: the state for which to set the foreground color
 | |
|  * @color: (allow-none): the color to assign (does not need to be allocated),
 | |
|  *     or %NULL to undo the effect of previous calls to
 | |
|  *     of gtk_widget_modify_fg().
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Sets the foreground color for a widget in a particular state.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * All other style values are left untouched.
 | |
|  * See also gtk_widget_modify_style().
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Deprecated:3.0: Use gtk_widget_override_color() instead
 | |
|  */
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_modify_fg (GtkWidget      *widget,
 | |
|                       GtkStateType    state,
 | |
|                       const GdkColor *color)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkStateFlags flags;
 | |
|   GdkRGBA rgba;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (state >= GTK_STATE_NORMAL && state <= GTK_STATE_INSENSITIVE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   switch (state)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|     case GTK_STATE_ACTIVE:
 | |
|       flags = GTK_STATE_FLAG_ACTIVE;
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case GTK_STATE_PRELIGHT:
 | |
|       flags = GTK_STATE_FLAG_PRELIGHT;
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case GTK_STATE_SELECTED:
 | |
|       flags = GTK_STATE_FLAG_SELECTED;
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case GTK_STATE_INSENSITIVE:
 | |
|       flags = GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE;
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case GTK_STATE_NORMAL:
 | |
|     default:
 | |
|       flags = 0;
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (color)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       rgba.red = color->red / 65535.;
 | |
|       rgba.green = color->green / 65535.;
 | |
|       rgba.blue = color->blue / 65535.;
 | |
|       rgba.alpha = 1;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       gtk_widget_override_color (widget, flags, &rgba);
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   else
 | |
|     gtk_widget_override_color (widget, flags, NULL);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_modify_bg:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @state: the state for which to set the background color
 | |
|  * @color: (allow-none): the color to assign (does not need
 | |
|  *     to be allocated), or %NULL to undo the effect of previous
 | |
|  *     calls to of gtk_widget_modify_bg().
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Sets the background color for a widget in a particular state.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * All other style values are left untouched.
 | |
|  * See also gtk_widget_modify_style().
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * <note><para>
 | |
|  * Note that "no window" widgets (which have the %GTK_NO_WINDOW
 | |
|  * flag set) draw on their parent container's window and thus may
 | |
|  * not draw any background themselves. This is the case for e.g.
 | |
|  * #GtkLabel.
 | |
|  * </para><para>
 | |
|  * To modify the background of such widgets, you have to set the
 | |
|  * background color on their parent; if you want to set the background
 | |
|  * of a rectangular area around a label, try placing the label in
 | |
|  * a #GtkEventBox widget and setting the background color on that.
 | |
|  * </para></note>
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Deprecated:3.0: Use gtk_widget_override_background_color() instead
 | |
|  */
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_modify_bg (GtkWidget      *widget,
 | |
|                       GtkStateType    state,
 | |
|                       const GdkColor *color)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkStateFlags flags;
 | |
|   GdkRGBA rgba;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (state >= GTK_STATE_NORMAL && state <= GTK_STATE_INSENSITIVE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   switch (state)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|     case GTK_STATE_ACTIVE:
 | |
|       flags = GTK_STATE_FLAG_ACTIVE;
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case GTK_STATE_PRELIGHT:
 | |
|       flags = GTK_STATE_FLAG_PRELIGHT;
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case GTK_STATE_SELECTED:
 | |
|       flags = GTK_STATE_FLAG_SELECTED;
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case GTK_STATE_INSENSITIVE:
 | |
|       flags = GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE;
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case GTK_STATE_NORMAL:
 | |
|     default:
 | |
|       flags = 0;
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (color)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       rgba.red = color->red / 65535.;
 | |
|       rgba.green = color->green / 65535.;
 | |
|       rgba.blue = color->blue / 65535.;
 | |
|       rgba.alpha = 1;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       gtk_widget_override_background_color (widget, flags, &rgba);
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   else
 | |
|     gtk_widget_override_background_color (widget, flags, NULL);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_modify_text:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @state: the state for which to set the text color
 | |
|  * @color: (allow-none): the color to assign (does not need to
 | |
|  *     be allocated), or %NULL to undo the effect of previous
 | |
|  *     calls to of gtk_widget_modify_text().
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Sets the text color for a widget in a particular state.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * All other style values are left untouched.
 | |
|  * The text color is the foreground color used along with the
 | |
|  * base color (see gtk_widget_modify_base()) for widgets such
 | |
|  * as #GtkEntry and #GtkTextView.
 | |
|  * See also gtk_widget_modify_style().
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Deprecated:3.0: Use gtk_widget_override_color() instead
 | |
|  */
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_modify_text (GtkWidget      *widget,
 | |
|                         GtkStateType    state,
 | |
|                         const GdkColor *color)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (state >= GTK_STATE_NORMAL && state <= GTK_STATE_INSENSITIVE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gtk_widget_modify_color_component (widget, GTK_RC_TEXT, state, color);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_modify_base:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @state: the state for which to set the base color
 | |
|  * @color: (allow-none): the color to assign (does not need to
 | |
|  *     be allocated), or %NULL to undo the effect of previous
 | |
|  *     calls to of gtk_widget_modify_base().
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Sets the base color for a widget in a particular state.
 | |
|  * All other style values are left untouched. The base color
 | |
|  * is the background color used along with the text color
 | |
|  * (see gtk_widget_modify_text()) for widgets such as #GtkEntry
 | |
|  * and #GtkTextView. See also gtk_widget_modify_style().
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * <note><para>
 | |
|  * Note that "no window" widgets (which have the %GTK_NO_WINDOW
 | |
|  * flag set) draw on their parent container's window and thus may
 | |
|  * not draw any background themselves. This is the case for e.g.
 | |
|  * #GtkLabel.
 | |
|  * </para><para>
 | |
|  * To modify the background of such widgets, you have to set the
 | |
|  * base color on their parent; if you want to set the background
 | |
|  * of a rectangular area around a label, try placing the label in
 | |
|  * a #GtkEventBox widget and setting the base color on that.
 | |
|  * </para></note>
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Deprecated:3.0: Use gtk_widget_override_background_color() instead
 | |
|  */
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_modify_base (GtkWidget      *widget,
 | |
|                         GtkStateType    state,
 | |
|                         const GdkColor *color)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (state >= GTK_STATE_NORMAL && state <= GTK_STATE_INSENSITIVE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gtk_widget_modify_color_component (widget, GTK_RC_BASE, state, color);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_modify_cursor:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @primary: the color to use for primary cursor (does not need to be
 | |
|  *     allocated), or %NULL to undo the effect of previous calls to
 | |
|  *     of gtk_widget_modify_cursor().
 | |
|  * @secondary: the color to use for secondary cursor (does not need to be
 | |
|  *     allocated), or %NULL to undo the effect of previous calls to
 | |
|  *     of gtk_widget_modify_cursor().
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Sets the cursor color to use in a widget, overriding the
 | |
|  * #GtkWidget:cursor-color and #GtkWidget:secondary-cursor-color
 | |
|  * style properties.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * All other style values are left untouched.
 | |
|  * See also gtk_widget_modify_style().
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.12
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Deprecated: 3.0. Use gtk_widget_override_cursor() instead.
 | |
|  */
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_modify_cursor (GtkWidget      *widget,
 | |
|                           const GdkColor *primary,
 | |
|                           const GdkColor *secondary)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GdkRGBA primary_rgba, secondary_rgba;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   primary_rgba.red = primary->red / 65535.;
 | |
|   primary_rgba.green = primary->green / 65535.;
 | |
|   primary_rgba.blue = primary->blue / 65535.;
 | |
|   primary_rgba.alpha = 1;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   secondary_rgba.red = secondary->red / 65535.;
 | |
|   secondary_rgba.green = secondary->green / 65535.;
 | |
|   secondary_rgba.blue = secondary->blue / 65535.;
 | |
|   secondary_rgba.alpha = 1;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gtk_widget_override_cursor (widget, &primary_rgba, &secondary_rgba);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_modify_font:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @font_desc: (allow-none): the font description to use, or %NULL
 | |
|  *     to undo the effect of previous calls to gtk_widget_modify_font()
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Sets the font to use for a widget.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * All other style values are left untouched.
 | |
|  * See also gtk_widget_modify_style().
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Deprecated:3.0: Use gtk_widget_override_font() instead
 | |
|  */
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_modify_font (GtkWidget            *widget,
 | |
|                         PangoFontDescription *font_desc)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gtk_widget_override_font (widget, font_desc);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_real_direction_changed (GtkWidget        *widget,
 | |
|                                    GtkTextDirection  previous_direction)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   gtk_widget_queue_resize (widget);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_real_style_set (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                            GtkStyle  *previous_style)
 | |
| {
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| typedef struct {
 | |
|   GtkWidget *previous_toplevel;
 | |
|   GdkScreen *previous_screen;
 | |
|   GdkScreen *new_screen;
 | |
| } HierarchyChangedInfo;
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| do_screen_change (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
| 		  GdkScreen *old_screen,
 | |
| 		  GdkScreen *new_screen)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   if (old_screen != new_screen)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (old_screen)
 | |
| 	{
 | |
| 	  PangoContext *context = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_pango_context);
 | |
| 	  if (context)
 | |
| 	    g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_pango_context, NULL);
 | |
| 	}
 | |
| 
 | |
|       _gtk_tooltip_hide (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (new_screen && priv->context)
 | |
|         gtk_style_context_set_screen (priv->context, new_screen);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[SCREEN_CHANGED], 0, old_screen);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_propagate_hierarchy_changed_recurse (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
| 						gpointer   client_data)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv;
 | |
|   HierarchyChangedInfo *info = client_data;
 | |
|   gboolean new_anchored = gtk_widget_is_toplevel (widget) ||
 | |
|                  (priv->parent && priv->parent->priv->anchored);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (priv->anchored != new_anchored)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       g_object_ref (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       priv->anchored = new_anchored;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[HIERARCHY_CHANGED], 0, info->previous_toplevel);
 | |
|       do_screen_change (widget, info->previous_screen, info->new_screen);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (GTK_IS_CONTAINER (widget))
 | |
| 	gtk_container_forall (GTK_CONTAINER (widget),
 | |
| 			      gtk_widget_propagate_hierarchy_changed_recurse,
 | |
| 			      client_data);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       g_object_unref (widget);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * _gtk_widget_propagate_hierarchy_changed:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @previous_toplevel: Previous toplevel
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Propagates changes in the anchored state to a widget and all
 | |
|  * children, unsetting or setting the %ANCHORED flag, and
 | |
|  * emitting #GtkWidget::hierarchy-changed.
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| _gtk_widget_propagate_hierarchy_changed (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
| 					 GtkWidget *previous_toplevel)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv;
 | |
|   HierarchyChangedInfo info;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   info.previous_toplevel = previous_toplevel;
 | |
|   info.previous_screen = previous_toplevel ? gtk_widget_get_screen (previous_toplevel) : NULL;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (gtk_widget_is_toplevel (widget) ||
 | |
|       (priv->parent && priv->parent->priv->anchored))
 | |
|     info.new_screen = gtk_widget_get_screen (widget);
 | |
|   else
 | |
|     info.new_screen = NULL;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (info.previous_screen)
 | |
|     g_object_ref (info.previous_screen);
 | |
|   if (previous_toplevel)
 | |
|     g_object_ref (previous_toplevel);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gtk_widget_propagate_hierarchy_changed_recurse (widget, &info);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (previous_toplevel)
 | |
|     g_object_unref (previous_toplevel);
 | |
|   if (info.previous_screen)
 | |
|     g_object_unref (info.previous_screen);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_propagate_screen_changed_recurse (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
| 					     gpointer   client_data)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   HierarchyChangedInfo *info = client_data;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_object_ref (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   do_screen_change (widget, info->previous_screen, info->new_screen);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (GTK_IS_CONTAINER (widget))
 | |
|     gtk_container_forall (GTK_CONTAINER (widget),
 | |
| 			  gtk_widget_propagate_screen_changed_recurse,
 | |
| 			  client_data);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_object_unref (widget);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_is_composited:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Whether @widget can rely on having its alpha channel
 | |
|  * drawn correctly. On X11 this function returns whether a
 | |
|  * compositing manager is running for @widget's screen.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Please note that the semantics of this call will change
 | |
|  * in the future if used on a widget that has a composited
 | |
|  * window in its hierarchy (as set by gdk_window_set_composited()).
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: %TRUE if the widget can rely on its alpha
 | |
|  * channel being drawn correctly.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.10
 | |
|  */
 | |
| gboolean
 | |
| gtk_widget_is_composited (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GdkScreen *screen;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   screen = gtk_widget_get_screen (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return gdk_screen_is_composited (screen);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| propagate_composited_changed (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
| 			      gpointer dummy)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   if (GTK_IS_CONTAINER (widget))
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       gtk_container_forall (GTK_CONTAINER (widget),
 | |
| 			    propagate_composited_changed,
 | |
| 			    NULL);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[COMPOSITED_CHANGED], 0);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void
 | |
| _gtk_widget_propagate_composited_changed (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   propagate_composited_changed (widget, NULL);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * _gtk_widget_propagate_screen_changed:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @previous_screen: Previous screen
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Propagates changes in the screen for a widget to all
 | |
|  * children, emitting #GtkWidget::screen-changed.
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| _gtk_widget_propagate_screen_changed (GtkWidget    *widget,
 | |
| 				      GdkScreen    *previous_screen)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   HierarchyChangedInfo info;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   info.previous_screen = previous_screen;
 | |
|   info.new_screen = gtk_widget_get_screen (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (previous_screen)
 | |
|     g_object_ref (previous_screen);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gtk_widget_propagate_screen_changed_recurse (widget, &info);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (previous_screen)
 | |
|     g_object_unref (previous_screen);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| reset_style_recurse (GtkWidget *widget, gpointer data)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   _gtk_widget_update_path (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (GTK_IS_CONTAINER (widget))
 | |
|     gtk_container_forall (GTK_CONTAINER (widget),
 | |
| 			  reset_style_recurse,
 | |
| 			  NULL);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_reset_style:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Updates the style context of @widget and all descendents
 | |
|  * by updating its widget path. #GtkContainer<!-- -->s may want
 | |
|  * to use this on a child when reordering it in a way that a different
 | |
|  * style might apply to it. See also gtk_container_get_path_for_child().
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 3.0
 | |
|  */
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_reset_style (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   reset_style_recurse (widget, NULL);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_reset_rc_styles:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Reset the styles of @widget and all descendents, so when
 | |
|  * they are looked up again, they get the correct values
 | |
|  * for the currently loaded RC file settings.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * This function is not useful for applications.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Deprecated:3.0: Use #GtkStyleContext instead, and gtk_widget_reset_style()
 | |
|  */
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_reset_rc_styles (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   reset_style_recurse (widget, NULL);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_default_style:
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns the default style used by all widgets initially.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns: (transfer none): the default style. This #GtkStyle
 | |
|  *     object is owned by GTK+ and should not be modified or freed.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Deprecated:3.0: Use #GtkStyleContext instead, and
 | |
|  *     gtk_css_provider_get_default() to obtain a #GtkStyleProvider
 | |
|  *     with the default widget style information.
 | |
|  */
 | |
| GtkStyle*
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_default_style (void)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   if (!gtk_default_style)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       gtk_default_style = gtk_style_new ();
 | |
|       g_object_ref (gtk_default_style);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return gtk_default_style;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| #ifdef G_ENABLE_DEBUG
 | |
| 
 | |
| /* Verify invariants, see docs/widget_system.txt for notes on much of
 | |
|  * this.  Invariants may be temporarily broken while we're in the
 | |
|  * process of updating state, of course, so you can only
 | |
|  * verify_invariants() after a given operation is complete.
 | |
|  * Use push/pop_verify_invariants to help with that.
 | |
|  */
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_verify_invariants (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidget *parent;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (widget->priv->verifying_invariants_count > 0)
 | |
|     return;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   parent = widget->priv->parent;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (widget->priv->mapped)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       /* Mapped implies ... */
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (!widget->priv->realized)
 | |
|         g_warning ("%s %p is mapped but not realized",
 | |
|                    G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (!widget->priv->visible)
 | |
|         g_warning ("%s %p is mapped but not visible",
 | |
|                    G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (!widget->priv->toplevel)
 | |
|         {
 | |
|           if (!widget->priv->child_visible)
 | |
|             g_warning ("%s %p is mapped but not child_visible",
 | |
|                        G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget);
 | |
|         }
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   else
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       /* Not mapped implies... */
 | |
| 
 | |
| #if 0
 | |
|   /* This check makes sense for normal toplevels, but for
 | |
|    * something like a toplevel that is embedded within a clutter
 | |
|    * state, mapping may depend on external factors.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|       if (widget->priv->toplevel)
 | |
|         {
 | |
|           if (widget->priv->visible)
 | |
|             g_warning ("%s %p toplevel is visible but not mapped",
 | |
|                        G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget);
 | |
|         }
 | |
| #endif
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /* Parent related checks aren't possible if parent has
 | |
|    * verifying_invariants_count > 0 because parent needs to recurse
 | |
|    * children first before the invariants will hold.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   if (parent == NULL || parent->priv->verifying_invariants_count == 0)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       if (parent &&
 | |
|           parent->priv->realized)
 | |
|         {
 | |
|           /* Parent realized implies... */
 | |
| 
 | |
| #if 0
 | |
|           /* This is in widget_system.txt but appears to fail
 | |
|            * because there's no gtk_container_realize() that
 | |
|            * realizes all children... instead we just lazily
 | |
|            * wait for map to fix things up.
 | |
|            */
 | |
|           if (!widget->priv->realized)
 | |
|             g_warning ("%s %p is realized but child %s %p is not realized",
 | |
|                        G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (parent), parent,
 | |
|                        G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget);
 | |
| #endif
 | |
|         }
 | |
|       else if (!widget->priv->toplevel)
 | |
|         {
 | |
|           /* No parent or parent not realized on non-toplevel implies... */
 | |
| 
 | |
|           if (widget->priv->realized && !widget->priv->in_reparent)
 | |
|             g_warning ("%s %p is not realized but child %s %p is realized",
 | |
|                        parent ? G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (parent) : "no parent", parent,
 | |
|                        G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget);
 | |
|         }
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (parent &&
 | |
|           parent->priv->mapped &&
 | |
|           widget->priv->visible &&
 | |
|           widget->priv->child_visible)
 | |
|         {
 | |
|           /* Parent mapped and we are visible implies... */
 | |
| 
 | |
|           if (!widget->priv->mapped)
 | |
|             g_warning ("%s %p is mapped but visible child %s %p is not mapped",
 | |
|                        G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (parent), parent,
 | |
|                        G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget);
 | |
|         }
 | |
|       else if (!widget->priv->toplevel)
 | |
|         {
 | |
|           /* No parent or parent not mapped on non-toplevel implies... */
 | |
| 
 | |
|           if (widget->priv->mapped && !widget->priv->in_reparent)
 | |
|             g_warning ("%s %p is mapped but visible=%d child_visible=%d parent %s %p mapped=%d",
 | |
|                        G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget,
 | |
|                        widget->priv->visible,
 | |
|                        widget->priv->child_visible,
 | |
|                        parent ? G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (parent) : "no parent", parent,
 | |
|                        parent ? parent->priv->mapped : FALSE);
 | |
|         }
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (!widget->priv->realized)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       /* Not realized implies... */
 | |
| 
 | |
| #if 0
 | |
|       /* widget_system.txt says these hold, but they don't. */
 | |
|       if (widget->priv->resize_pending)
 | |
|         g_warning ("%s %p resize pending but not realized",
 | |
|                    G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (widget->priv->alloc_needed)
 | |
|         g_warning ("%s %p alloc needed but not realized",
 | |
|                    G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (widget->priv->width_request_needed)
 | |
|         g_warning ("%s %p width request needed but not realized",
 | |
|                    G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (widget->priv->height_request_needed)
 | |
|         g_warning ("%s %p height request needed but not realized",
 | |
|                    G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget);
 | |
| #endif
 | |
|     }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /* The point of this push/pop is that invariants may not hold while
 | |
|  * we're busy making changes. So we only check at the outermost call
 | |
|  * on the call stack, after we finish updating everything.
 | |
|  */
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_push_verify_invariants (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   widget->priv->verifying_invariants_count += 1;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_verify_child_invariants (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                                     gpointer   client_data)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   /* We don't recurse further; this is a one-level check. */
 | |
|   gtk_widget_verify_invariants (widget);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_pop_verify_invariants (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_assert (widget->priv->verifying_invariants_count > 0);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   widget->priv->verifying_invariants_count -= 1;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (widget->priv->verifying_invariants_count == 0)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       gtk_widget_verify_invariants (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (GTK_IS_CONTAINER (widget))
 | |
|         {
 | |
|           /* Check one level of children, because our
 | |
|            * push_verify_invariants() will have prevented some of the
 | |
|            * checks. This does not recurse because if recursion is
 | |
|            * needed, it will happen naturally as each child has a
 | |
|            * push/pop on that child. For example if we're recursively
 | |
|            * mapping children, we'll push/pop on each child as we map
 | |
|            * it.
 | |
|            */
 | |
|           gtk_container_forall (GTK_CONTAINER (widget),
 | |
|                                 gtk_widget_verify_child_invariants,
 | |
|                                 NULL);
 | |
|         }
 | |
|     }
 | |
| }
 | |
| #endif /* G_ENABLE_DEBUG */
 | |
| 
 | |
| static PangoContext *
 | |
| gtk_widget_peek_pango_context (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   return g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_pango_context);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_pango_context:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Gets a #PangoContext with the appropriate font map, font description,
 | |
|  * and base direction for this widget. Unlike the context returned
 | |
|  * by gtk_widget_create_pango_context(), this context is owned by
 | |
|  * the widget (it can be used until the screen for the widget changes
 | |
|  * or the widget is removed from its toplevel), and will be updated to
 | |
|  * match any changes to the widget's attributes.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * If you create and keep a #PangoLayout using this context, you must
 | |
|  * deal with changes to the context by calling pango_layout_context_changed()
 | |
|  * on the layout in response to the #GtkWidget::style-updated and
 | |
|  * #GtkWidget::direction-changed signals for the widget.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: (transfer none): the #PangoContext for the widget.
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| PangoContext *
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_pango_context (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   PangoContext *context;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   context = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_pango_context);
 | |
|   if (!context)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       context = gtk_widget_create_pango_context (GTK_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
|       g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (widget),
 | |
| 			       quark_pango_context,
 | |
| 			       context,
 | |
| 			       g_object_unref);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return context;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| update_pango_context (GtkWidget    *widget,
 | |
| 		      PangoContext *context)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   const PangoFontDescription *font_desc;
 | |
|   GtkStyleContext *style_context;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   style_context = gtk_widget_get_style_context (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   font_desc = gtk_style_context_get_font (style_context,
 | |
|                                           gtk_widget_get_state_flags (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   pango_context_set_font_description (context, font_desc);
 | |
|   pango_context_set_base_dir (context,
 | |
| 			      gtk_widget_get_direction (widget) == GTK_TEXT_DIR_LTR ?
 | |
| 			      PANGO_DIRECTION_LTR : PANGO_DIRECTION_RTL);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_update_pango_context (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   PangoContext *context = gtk_widget_peek_pango_context (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (context)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       GdkScreen *screen;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       update_pango_context (widget, context);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       screen = gtk_widget_get_screen_unchecked (widget);
 | |
|       if (screen)
 | |
| 	{
 | |
| 	  pango_cairo_context_set_resolution (context,
 | |
| 					      gdk_screen_get_resolution (screen));
 | |
| 	  pango_cairo_context_set_font_options (context,
 | |
| 						gdk_screen_get_font_options (screen));
 | |
| 	}
 | |
|     }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_create_pango_context:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Creates a new #PangoContext with the appropriate font map,
 | |
|  * font description, and base direction for drawing text for
 | |
|  * this widget. See also gtk_widget_get_pango_context().
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: (transfer full): the new #PangoContext
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| PangoContext *
 | |
| gtk_widget_create_pango_context (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GdkScreen *screen;
 | |
|   PangoContext *context;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   screen = gtk_widget_get_screen_unchecked (widget);
 | |
|   if (!screen)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       GTK_NOTE (MULTIHEAD,
 | |
| 		g_warning ("gtk_widget_create_pango_context ()) called without screen"));
 | |
| 
 | |
|       screen = gdk_screen_get_default ();
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   context = gdk_pango_context_get_for_screen (screen);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   update_pango_context (widget, context);
 | |
|   pango_context_set_language (context, gtk_get_default_language ());
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return context;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_create_pango_layout:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @text: text to set on the layout (can be %NULL)
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Creates a new #PangoLayout with the appropriate font map,
 | |
|  * font description, and base direction for drawing text for
 | |
|  * this widget.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * If you keep a #PangoLayout created in this way around, in order to
 | |
|  * notify the layout of changes to the base direction or font of this
 | |
|  * widget, you must call pango_layout_context_changed() in response to
 | |
|  * the #GtkWidget::style-updated and #GtkWidget::direction-changed signals
 | |
|  * for the widget.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: (transfer full): the new #PangoLayout
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| PangoLayout *
 | |
| gtk_widget_create_pango_layout (GtkWidget   *widget,
 | |
| 				const gchar *text)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   PangoLayout *layout;
 | |
|   PangoContext *context;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   context = gtk_widget_get_pango_context (widget);
 | |
|   layout = pango_layout_new (context);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (text)
 | |
|     pango_layout_set_text (layout, text, -1);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return layout;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_render_icon_pixbuf:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @stock_id: a stock ID
 | |
|  * @size: (type int): a stock size. A size of (GtkIconSize)-1 means
 | |
|  *     render at the size of the source and don't scale (if there are
 | |
|  *     multiple source sizes, GTK+ picks one of the available sizes).
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * A convenience function that uses the theme engine and style
 | |
|  * settings for @widget to look up @stock_id and render it to
 | |
|  * a pixbuf. @stock_id should be a stock icon ID such as
 | |
|  * #GTK_STOCK_OPEN or #GTK_STOCK_OK. @size should be a size
 | |
|  * such as #GTK_ICON_SIZE_MENU.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * The pixels in the returned #GdkPixbuf are shared with the rest of
 | |
|  * the application and should not be modified. The pixbuf should be freed
 | |
|  * after use with g_object_unref().
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: (transfer full): a new pixbuf, or %NULL if the
 | |
|  *     stock ID wasn't known
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 3.0
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| GdkPixbuf*
 | |
| gtk_widget_render_icon_pixbuf (GtkWidget   *widget,
 | |
|                                const gchar *stock_id,
 | |
|                                GtkIconSize  size)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkStyleContext *context;
 | |
|   GtkIconSet *icon_set;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL);
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (stock_id != NULL, NULL);
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (size > GTK_ICON_SIZE_INVALID || size == -1, NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   context = gtk_widget_get_style_context (widget);
 | |
|   icon_set = gtk_style_context_lookup_icon_set (context, stock_id);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (icon_set == NULL)
 | |
|     return NULL;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return gtk_icon_set_render_icon_pixbuf (icon_set, context, size);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_render_icon:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @stock_id: a stock ID
 | |
|  * @size: (type int): a stock size. A size of (GtkIconSize)-1 means
 | |
|  *     render at the size of the source and don't scale (if there are
 | |
|  *     multiple source sizes, GTK+ picks one of the available sizes).
 | |
|  * @detail: (allow-none): render detail to pass to theme engine
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * A convenience function that uses the theme settings for @widget
 | |
|  * to look up @stock_id and render it to a pixbuf. @stock_id should
 | |
|  * be a stock icon ID such as #GTK_STOCK_OPEN or #GTK_STOCK_OK. @size
 | |
|  * should be a size such as #GTK_ICON_SIZE_MENU. @detail should be a
 | |
|  * string that identifies the widget or code doing the rendering, so
 | |
|  * that theme engines can special-case rendering for that widget or
 | |
|  * code.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * The pixels in the returned #GdkPixbuf are shared with the rest of
 | |
|  * the application and should not be modified. The pixbuf should be
 | |
|  * freed after use with g_object_unref().
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: (transfer full): a new pixbuf, or %NULL if the
 | |
|  *     stock ID wasn't known
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Deprecated: 3.0: Use gtk_widget_render_icon_pixbuf() instead.
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| GdkPixbuf*
 | |
| gtk_widget_render_icon (GtkWidget      *widget,
 | |
|                         const gchar    *stock_id,
 | |
|                         GtkIconSize     size,
 | |
|                         const gchar    *detail)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   gtk_widget_ensure_style (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return gtk_widget_render_icon_pixbuf (widget, stock_id, size);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_set_parent_window:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget.
 | |
|  * @parent_window: the new parent window.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Sets a non default parent window for @widget.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * For GtkWindow classes, setting a @parent_window effects whether
 | |
|  * the window is a toplevel window or can be embedded into other
 | |
|  * widgets.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * <note><para>
 | |
|  * For GtkWindow classes, this needs to be called before the
 | |
|  * window is realized.
 | |
|  * </para></note>
 | |
|  * 
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_set_parent_window   (GtkWidget           *widget,
 | |
| 				GdkWindow           *parent_window)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GdkWindow *old_parent_window;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   old_parent_window = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget),
 | |
| 					  quark_parent_window);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (parent_window != old_parent_window)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       gboolean is_plug;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_parent_window,
 | |
| 			  parent_window);
 | |
|       if (old_parent_window)
 | |
| 	g_object_unref (old_parent_window);
 | |
|       if (parent_window)
 | |
| 	g_object_ref (parent_window);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       /* Unset toplevel flag when adding a parent window to a widget,
 | |
|        * this is the primary entry point to allow toplevels to be
 | |
|        * embeddable.
 | |
|        */
 | |
| #ifdef GDK_WINDOWING_X11
 | |
|       is_plug = GTK_IS_PLUG (widget);
 | |
| #else
 | |
|       is_plug = FALSE;
 | |
| #endif
 | |
|       if (GTK_IS_WINDOW (widget) && !is_plug)
 | |
| 	_gtk_window_set_is_toplevel (GTK_WINDOW (widget), parent_window == NULL);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_parent_window:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Gets @widget's parent window.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns: (transfer none): the parent window of @widget.
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| GdkWindow *
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_parent_window (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetPrivate *priv;
 | |
|   GdkWindow *parent_window;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   priv = widget->priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   parent_window = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_parent_window);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return (parent_window != NULL) ? parent_window :
 | |
| 	 (priv->parent != NULL) ? priv->parent->priv->window : NULL;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_set_child_visible:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @is_visible: if %TRUE, @widget should be mapped along with its parent.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Sets whether @widget should be mapped along with its when its parent
 | |
|  * is mapped and @widget has been shown with gtk_widget_show().
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * The child visibility can be set for widget before it is added to
 | |
|  * a container with gtk_widget_set_parent(), to avoid mapping
 | |
|  * children unnecessary before immediately unmapping them. However
 | |
|  * it will be reset to its default state of %TRUE when the widget
 | |
|  * is removed from a container.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Note that changing the child visibility of a widget does not
 | |
|  * queue a resize on the widget. Most of the time, the size of
 | |
|  * a widget is computed from all visible children, whether or
 | |
|  * not they are mapped. If this is not the case, the container
 | |
|  * can queue a resize itself.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * This function is only useful for container implementations and
 | |
|  * never should be called by an application.
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_set_child_visible (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
| 			      gboolean   is_visible)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetPrivate *priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (!gtk_widget_is_toplevel (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   priv = widget->priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_object_ref (widget);
 | |
|   gtk_widget_verify_invariants (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (is_visible)
 | |
|     priv->child_visible = TRUE;
 | |
|   else
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       GtkWidget *toplevel;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       priv->child_visible = FALSE;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       toplevel = gtk_widget_get_toplevel (widget);
 | |
|       if (toplevel != widget && gtk_widget_is_toplevel (toplevel))
 | |
| 	_gtk_window_unset_focus_and_default (GTK_WINDOW (toplevel), widget);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (priv->parent && gtk_widget_get_realized (priv->parent))
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       if (gtk_widget_get_mapped (priv->parent) &&
 | |
| 	  priv->child_visible &&
 | |
| 	  gtk_widget_get_visible (widget))
 | |
| 	gtk_widget_map (widget);
 | |
|       else
 | |
| 	gtk_widget_unmap (widget);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gtk_widget_verify_invariants (widget);
 | |
|   g_object_unref (widget);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_child_visible:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Gets the value set with gtk_widget_set_child_visible().
 | |
|  * If you feel a need to use this function, your code probably
 | |
|  * needs reorganization.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * This function is only useful for container implementations and
 | |
|  * never should be called by an application.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: %TRUE if the widget is mapped with the parent.
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| gboolean
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_child_visible (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return widget->priv->child_visible;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static GdkScreen *
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_screen_unchecked (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidget *toplevel;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   toplevel = gtk_widget_get_toplevel (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (gtk_widget_is_toplevel (toplevel))
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       if (GTK_IS_WINDOW (toplevel))
 | |
| 	return gtk_window_get_screen (GTK_WINDOW (toplevel));
 | |
|       else if (GTK_IS_INVISIBLE (toplevel))
 | |
| 	return gtk_invisible_get_screen (GTK_INVISIBLE (widget));
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return NULL;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_screen:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Get the #GdkScreen from the toplevel window associated with
 | |
|  * this widget. This function can only be called after the widget
 | |
|  * has been added to a widget hierarchy with a #GtkWindow
 | |
|  * at the top.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * In general, you should only create screen specific
 | |
|  * resources when a widget has been realized, and you should
 | |
|  * free those resources when the widget is unrealized.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: (transfer none): the #GdkScreen for the toplevel for this widget.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.2
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| GdkScreen*
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_screen (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GdkScreen *screen;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   screen = gtk_widget_get_screen_unchecked (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (screen)
 | |
|     return screen;
 | |
|   else
 | |
|     {
 | |
| #if 0
 | |
|       g_warning (G_STRLOC ": Can't get associated screen"
 | |
| 		 " for a widget unless it is inside a toplevel GtkWindow\n"
 | |
| 		 " widget type is %s associated top level type is %s",
 | |
| 		 g_type_name (G_OBJECT_TYPE(G_OBJECT (widget))),
 | |
| 		 g_type_name (G_OBJECT_TYPE(G_OBJECT (toplevel))));
 | |
| #endif
 | |
|       return gdk_screen_get_default ();
 | |
|     }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_has_screen:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Checks whether there is a #GdkScreen is associated with
 | |
|  * this widget. All toplevel widgets have an associated
 | |
|  * screen, and all widgets added into a hierarchy with a toplevel
 | |
|  * window at the top.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: %TRUE if there is a #GdkScreen associcated
 | |
|  *   with the widget.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.2
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| gboolean
 | |
| gtk_widget_has_screen (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return (gtk_widget_get_screen_unchecked (widget) != NULL);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_display:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Get the #GdkDisplay for the toplevel window associated with
 | |
|  * this widget. This function can only be called after the widget
 | |
|  * has been added to a widget hierarchy with a #GtkWindow at the top.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * In general, you should only create display specific
 | |
|  * resources when a widget has been realized, and you should
 | |
|  * free those resources when the widget is unrealized.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: (transfer none): the #GdkDisplay for the toplevel for this widget.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.2
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| GdkDisplay*
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_display (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return gdk_screen_get_display (gtk_widget_get_screen (widget));
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_root_window:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Get the root window where this widget is located. This function can
 | |
|  * only be called after the widget has been added to a widget
 | |
|  * hierarchy with #GtkWindow at the top.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * The root window is useful for such purposes as creating a popup
 | |
|  * #GdkWindow associated with the window. In general, you should only
 | |
|  * create display specific resources when a widget has been realized,
 | |
|  * and you should free those resources when the widget is unrealized.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: (transfer none): the #GdkWindow root window for the toplevel for this widget.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.2
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| GdkWindow*
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_root_window (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return gdk_screen_get_root_window (gtk_widget_get_screen (widget));
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_child_focus:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @direction: direction of focus movement
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * This function is used by custom widget implementations; if you're
 | |
|  * writing an app, you'd use gtk_widget_grab_focus() to move the focus
 | |
|  * to a particular widget, and gtk_container_set_focus_chain() to
 | |
|  * change the focus tab order. So you may want to investigate those
 | |
|  * functions instead.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_child_focus() is called by containers as the user moves
 | |
|  * around the window using keyboard shortcuts. @direction indicates
 | |
|  * what kind of motion is taking place (up, down, left, right, tab
 | |
|  * forward, tab backward). gtk_widget_child_focus() emits the
 | |
|  * #GtkWidget::focus signal; widgets override the default handler
 | |
|  * for this signal in order to implement appropriate focus behavior.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * The default ::focus handler for a widget should return %TRUE if
 | |
|  * moving in @direction left the focus on a focusable location inside
 | |
|  * that widget, and %FALSE if moving in @direction moved the focus
 | |
|  * outside the widget. If returning %TRUE, widgets normally
 | |
|  * call gtk_widget_grab_focus() to place the focus accordingly;
 | |
|  * if returning %FALSE, they don't modify the current focus location.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: %TRUE if focus ended up inside @widget
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| gboolean
 | |
| gtk_widget_child_focus (GtkWidget       *widget,
 | |
|                         GtkDirectionType direction)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   gboolean return_val;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (!gtk_widget_get_visible (widget) ||
 | |
|       !gtk_widget_is_sensitive (widget))
 | |
|     return FALSE;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /* child widgets must set CAN_FOCUS, containers
 | |
|    * don't have to though.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   if (!GTK_IS_CONTAINER (widget) &&
 | |
|       !gtk_widget_get_can_focus (widget))
 | |
|     return FALSE;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_signal_emit (widget,
 | |
| 		 widget_signals[FOCUS],
 | |
| 		 0,
 | |
| 		 direction, &return_val);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return return_val;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_keynav_failed:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @direction: direction of focus movement
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * This function should be called whenever keyboard navigation within
 | |
|  * a single widget hits a boundary. The function emits the
 | |
|  * #GtkWidget::keynav-failed signal on the widget and its return
 | |
|  * value should be interpreted in a way similar to the return value of
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_child_focus():
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * When %TRUE is returned, stay in the widget, the failed keyboard
 | |
|  * navigation is Ok and/or there is nowhere we can/should move the
 | |
|  * focus to.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * When %FALSE is returned, the caller should continue with keyboard
 | |
|  * navigation outside the widget, e.g. by calling
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_child_focus() on the widget's toplevel.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * The default ::keynav-failed handler returns %TRUE for
 | |
|  * %GTK_DIR_TAB_FORWARD and %GTK_DIR_TAB_BACKWARD. For the other
 | |
|  * values of #GtkDirectionType, it looks at the
 | |
|  * #GtkSettings:gtk-keynav-cursor-only setting and returns %FALSE
 | |
|  * if the setting is %TRUE. This way the entire user interface
 | |
|  * becomes cursor-navigatable on input devices such as mobile phones
 | |
|  * which only have cursor keys but no tab key.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Whenever the default handler returns %TRUE, it also calls
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_error_bell() to notify the user of the failed keyboard
 | |
|  * navigation.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * A use case for providing an own implementation of ::keynav-failed
 | |
|  * (either by connecting to it or by overriding it) would be a row of
 | |
|  * #GtkEntry widgets where the user should be able to navigate the
 | |
|  * entire row with the cursor keys, as e.g. known from user interfaces
 | |
|  * that require entering license keys.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: %TRUE if stopping keyboard navigation is fine, %FALSE
 | |
|  *               if the emitting widget should try to handle the keyboard
 | |
|  *               navigation attempt in its parent container(s).
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.12
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| gboolean
 | |
| gtk_widget_keynav_failed (GtkWidget        *widget,
 | |
|                           GtkDirectionType  direction)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   gboolean return_val;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[KEYNAV_FAILED], 0,
 | |
| 		 direction, &return_val);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return return_val;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_error_bell:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Notifies the user about an input-related error on this widget.
 | |
|  * If the #GtkSettings:gtk-error-bell setting is %TRUE, it calls
 | |
|  * gdk_window_beep(), otherwise it does nothing.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Note that the effect of gdk_window_beep() can be configured in many
 | |
|  * ways, depending on the windowing backend and the desktop environment
 | |
|  * or window manager that is used.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.12
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_error_bell (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetPrivate *priv;
 | |
|   GtkSettings* settings;
 | |
|   gboolean beep;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   priv = widget->priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   settings = gtk_widget_get_settings (widget);
 | |
|   if (!settings)
 | |
|     return;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_object_get (settings,
 | |
|                 "gtk-error-bell", &beep,
 | |
|                 NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (beep && priv->window)
 | |
|     gdk_window_beep (priv->window);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_set_usize_internal (GtkWidget          *widget,
 | |
| 			       gint                width,
 | |
| 			       gint                height,
 | |
| 			       GtkQueueResizeFlags flags)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetAuxInfo *aux_info;
 | |
|   gboolean changed = FALSE;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_object_freeze_notify (G_OBJECT (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   aux_info = gtk_widget_get_aux_info (widget, TRUE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (width > -2 && aux_info->width != width)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       if ((flags & GTK_QUEUE_RESIZE_INVALIDATE_ONLY) == 0)
 | |
| 	g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), "width-request");
 | |
|       aux_info->width = width;
 | |
|       changed = TRUE;
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   if (height > -2 && aux_info->height != height)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       if ((flags & GTK_QUEUE_RESIZE_INVALIDATE_ONLY) == 0)
 | |
| 	g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), "height-request");
 | |
|       aux_info->height = height;
 | |
|       changed = TRUE;
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (gtk_widget_get_visible (widget) && changed)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       if ((flags & GTK_QUEUE_RESIZE_INVALIDATE_ONLY) == 0)
 | |
| 	gtk_widget_queue_resize (widget);
 | |
|       else
 | |
| 	_gtk_size_group_queue_resize (widget, GTK_QUEUE_RESIZE_INVALIDATE_ONLY);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_object_thaw_notify (G_OBJECT (widget));
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_set_size_request:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @width: width @widget should request, or -1 to unset
 | |
|  * @height: height @widget should request, or -1 to unset
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Sets the minimum size of a widget; that is, the widget's size
 | |
|  * request will be @width by @height. You can use this function to
 | |
|  * force a widget to be either larger or smaller than it normally
 | |
|  * would be.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * In most cases, gtk_window_set_default_size() is a better choice for
 | |
|  * toplevel windows than this function; setting the default size will
 | |
|  * still allow users to shrink the window. Setting the size request
 | |
|  * will force them to leave the window at least as large as the size
 | |
|  * request. When dealing with window sizes,
 | |
|  * gtk_window_set_geometry_hints() can be a useful function as well.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Note the inherent danger of setting any fixed size - themes,
 | |
|  * translations into other languages, different fonts, and user action
 | |
|  * can all change the appropriate size for a given widget. So, it's
 | |
|  * basically impossible to hardcode a size that will always be
 | |
|  * correct.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * The size request of a widget is the smallest size a widget can
 | |
|  * accept while still functioning well and drawing itself correctly.
 | |
|  * However in some strange cases a widget may be allocated less than
 | |
|  * its requested size, and in many cases a widget may be allocated more
 | |
|  * space than it requested.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * If the size request in a given direction is -1 (unset), then
 | |
|  * the "natural" size request of the widget will be used instead.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Widgets can't actually be allocated a size less than 1 by 1, but
 | |
|  * you can pass 0,0 to this function to mean "as small as possible."
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * The size request set here does not include any margin from the
 | |
|  * #GtkWidget properties margin-left, margin-right, margin-top, and
 | |
|  * margin-bottom, but it does include pretty much all other padding
 | |
|  * or border properties set by any subclass of #GtkWidget.
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_set_size_request (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                              gint       width,
 | |
|                              gint       height)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (width >= -1);
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (height >= -1);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (width == 0)
 | |
|     width = 1;
 | |
|   if (height == 0)
 | |
|     height = 1;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gtk_widget_set_usize_internal (widget, width, height, 0);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_size_request:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @width: (out) (allow-none): return location for width, or %NULL
 | |
|  * @height: (out) (allow-none): return location for height, or %NULL
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Gets the size request that was explicitly set for the widget using
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_set_size_request(). A value of -1 stored in @width or
 | |
|  * @height indicates that that dimension has not been set explicitly
 | |
|  * and the natural requisition of the widget will be used intead. See
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_set_size_request(). To get the size a widget will
 | |
|  * actually request, call gtk_widget_get_preferred_size() instead of
 | |
|  * this function.
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_size_request (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                              gint      *width,
 | |
|                              gint      *height)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   const GtkWidgetAuxInfo *aux_info;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   aux_info = _gtk_widget_get_aux_info_or_defaults (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (width)
 | |
|     *width = aux_info->width;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (height)
 | |
|     *height = aux_info->height;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * _gtk_widget_override_size_request:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @width: new forced minimum width
 | |
|  * @height: new forced minimum height
 | |
|  * @old_width: location to store previous forced minimum width
 | |
|  * @old_width: location to store previous forced minumum height
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Temporarily establishes a forced minimum size for a widget; this
 | |
|  * is used by GtkWindow when calculating the size to add to the
 | |
|  * window's geometry widget. Cached sizes for the widget and its
 | |
|  * parents are invalidated, so that subsequent calls to the size
 | |
|  * negotiation machinery produce the overriden result, but the
 | |
|  * widget is not queued for relayout or redraw. The old size must
 | |
|  * be restored with _gtk_widget_restore_size_request() or things
 | |
|  * will go screwy.
 | |
|  */
 | |
| void
 | |
| _gtk_widget_override_size_request (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
| 				   int        width,
 | |
| 				   int        height,
 | |
| 				   int       *old_width,
 | |
| 				   int       *old_height)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   gtk_widget_get_size_request (widget, old_width, old_height);
 | |
|   gtk_widget_set_usize_internal (widget, width, height,
 | |
| 				 GTK_QUEUE_RESIZE_INVALIDATE_ONLY);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * _gtk_widget_restore_size_request:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @old_width: saved forced minimum size
 | |
|  * @old_height: saved forced minimum size
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Undoes the operation of_gtk_widget_override_size_request().
 | |
|  */
 | |
| void
 | |
| _gtk_widget_restore_size_request (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
| 				  int        old_width,
 | |
| 				  int        old_height)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   gtk_widget_set_usize_internal (widget, old_width, old_height,
 | |
| 				 GTK_QUEUE_RESIZE_INVALIDATE_ONLY);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_set_events:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @events: event mask
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Sets the event mask (see #GdkEventMask) for a widget. The event
 | |
|  * mask determines which events a widget will receive. Keep in mind
 | |
|  * that different widgets have different default event masks, and by
 | |
|  * changing the event mask you may disrupt a widget's functionality,
 | |
|  * so be careful. This function must be called while a widget is
 | |
|  * unrealized. Consider gtk_widget_add_events() for widgets that are
 | |
|  * already realized, or if you want to preserve the existing event
 | |
|  * mask. This function can't be used with #GTK_NO_WINDOW widgets;
 | |
|  * to get events on those widgets, place them inside a #GtkEventBox
 | |
|  * and receive events on the event box.
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_set_events (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
| 		       gint	  events)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (!gtk_widget_get_realized (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_event_mask,
 | |
|                       GINT_TO_POINTER (events));
 | |
|   g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), "events");
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_set_device_events:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @device: a #GdkDevice
 | |
|  * @events: event mask
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Sets the device event mask (see #GdkEventMask) for a widget. The event
 | |
|  * mask determines which events a widget will receive from @device. Keep
 | |
|  * in mind that different widgets have different default event masks, and by
 | |
|  * changing the event mask you may disrupt a widget's functionality,
 | |
|  * so be careful. This function must be called while a widget is
 | |
|  * unrealized. Consider gtk_widget_add_device_events() for widgets that are
 | |
|  * already realized, or if you want to preserve the existing event
 | |
|  * mask. This function can't be used with #GTK_NO_WINDOW widgets;
 | |
|  * to get events on those widgets, place them inside a #GtkEventBox
 | |
|  * and receive events on the event box.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 3.0
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_set_device_events (GtkWidget    *widget,
 | |
|                               GdkDevice    *device,
 | |
|                               GdkEventMask  events)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GHashTable *device_events;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GDK_IS_DEVICE (device));
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (!gtk_widget_get_realized (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   device_events = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_device_event_mask);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (G_UNLIKELY (!device_events))
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       device_events = g_hash_table_new (NULL, NULL);
 | |
|       g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_device_event_mask, device_events,
 | |
|                                (GDestroyNotify) g_hash_table_unref);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_hash_table_insert (device_events, device, GUINT_TO_POINTER (events));
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_set_device_enabled:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @device: a #GdkDevice
 | |
|  * @enabled: whether to enable the device
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Enables or disables a #GdkDevice to interact with @widget
 | |
|  * and all its children.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * It does so by descending through the #GdkWindow hierarchy
 | |
|  * and enabling the same mask that is has for core events
 | |
|  * (i.e. the one that gdk_window_get_events() returns).
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 3.0
 | |
|  */
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_set_device_enabled (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                                GdkDevice *device,
 | |
|                                gboolean   enabled)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GList *enabled_devices;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GDK_IS_DEVICE (device));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   enabled_devices = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_enabled_devices);
 | |
|   enabled_devices = g_list_append (enabled_devices, device);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_enabled_devices,
 | |
|                            enabled_devices, (GDestroyNotify) g_list_free);;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (gtk_widget_get_realized (widget))
 | |
|     gtk_widget_set_device_enabled_internal (widget, device, TRUE, enabled);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_device_enabled:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @device: a #GdkDevice
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns whether @device can interact with @widget and its
 | |
|  * children. See gtk_widget_set_device_enabled().
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: %TRUE is @device is enabled for @widget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 3.0
 | |
|  */
 | |
| gboolean
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_device_enabled (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                                GdkDevice *device)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GList *enabled_devices;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE);
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GDK_IS_DEVICE (device), FALSE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   enabled_devices = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_enabled_devices);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return g_list_find (enabled_devices, device) != NULL;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_add_events_internal_list (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                                      GdkDevice *device,
 | |
|                                      gint       events,
 | |
|                                      GList     *window_list)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GList *l;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   for (l = window_list; l != NULL; l = l->next)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       GdkWindow *window = l->data;
 | |
|       gpointer user_data;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       gdk_window_get_user_data (window, &user_data);
 | |
|       if (user_data == widget)
 | |
|         {
 | |
|           GList *children;
 | |
| 
 | |
|           if (device)
 | |
|             gdk_window_set_device_events (window, device, gdk_window_get_events (window) | events);
 | |
|           else
 | |
|             gdk_window_set_events (window, gdk_window_get_events (window) | events);
 | |
| 
 | |
|           children = gdk_window_get_children (window);
 | |
|           gtk_widget_add_events_internal_list (widget, device, events, children);
 | |
|           g_list_free (children);
 | |
|         }
 | |
|     }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_add_events_internal (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                                 GdkDevice *device,
 | |
|                                 gint       events)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv;
 | |
|   GList *window_list;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (!gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget))
 | |
|     window_list = gdk_window_get_children (priv->window);
 | |
|   else
 | |
|     window_list = g_list_prepend (NULL, priv->window);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gtk_widget_add_events_internal_list (widget, device, events, window_list);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_list_free (window_list);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_add_events:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @events: an event mask, see #GdkEventMask
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Adds the events in the bitfield @events to the event mask for
 | |
|  * @widget. See gtk_widget_set_events() for details.
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_add_events (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
| 		       gint	  events)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   gint old_events;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   old_events = GPOINTER_TO_INT (g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_event_mask));
 | |
|   g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_event_mask,
 | |
|                       GINT_TO_POINTER (old_events | events));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (gtk_widget_get_realized (widget))
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       gtk_widget_add_events_internal (widget, NULL, events);
 | |
|       gtk_widget_update_devices_mask (widget, FALSE);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), "events");
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_add_device_events:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @device: a #GdkDevice
 | |
|  * @events: an event mask, see #GdkEventMask
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Adds the device events in the bitfield @events to the event mask for
 | |
|  * @widget. See gtk_widget_set_device_events() for details.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 3.0
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_add_device_events (GtkWidget    *widget,
 | |
|                               GdkDevice    *device,
 | |
|                               GdkEventMask  events)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GdkEventMask old_events;
 | |
|   GHashTable *device_events;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GDK_IS_DEVICE (device));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   old_events = gtk_widget_get_device_events (widget, device);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   device_events = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_device_event_mask);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (G_UNLIKELY (!device_events))
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       device_events = g_hash_table_new (NULL, NULL);
 | |
|       g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_device_event_mask, device_events,
 | |
|                                (GDestroyNotify) g_hash_table_unref);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_hash_table_insert (device_events, device,
 | |
|                        GUINT_TO_POINTER (old_events | events));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (gtk_widget_get_realized (widget))
 | |
|     gtk_widget_add_events_internal (widget, device, events);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), "events");
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_toplevel:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * This function returns the topmost widget in the container hierarchy
 | |
|  * @widget is a part of. If @widget has no parent widgets, it will be
 | |
|  * returned as the topmost widget. No reference will be added to the
 | |
|  * returned widget; it should not be unreferenced.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Note the difference in behavior vs. gtk_widget_get_ancestor();
 | |
|  * <literal>gtk_widget_get_ancestor (widget, GTK_TYPE_WINDOW)</literal>
 | |
|  * would return
 | |
|  * %NULL if @widget wasn't inside a toplevel window, and if the
 | |
|  * window was inside a #GtkWindow-derived widget which was in turn
 | |
|  * inside the toplevel #GtkWindow. While the second case may
 | |
|  * seem unlikely, it actually happens when a #GtkPlug is embedded
 | |
|  * inside a #GtkSocket within the same application.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * To reliably find the toplevel #GtkWindow, use
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_toplevel() and check if the %TOPLEVEL flags
 | |
|  * is set on the result.
 | |
|  * |[
 | |
|  *  GtkWidget *toplevel = gtk_widget_get_toplevel (widget);
 | |
|  *  if (gtk_widget_is_toplevel (toplevel))
 | |
|  *    {
 | |
|  *      /* Perform action on toplevel. */
 | |
|  *    }
 | |
|  * ]|
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: (transfer none): the topmost ancestor of @widget, or @widget itself
 | |
|  *    if there's no ancestor.
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| GtkWidget*
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_toplevel (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   while (widget->priv->parent)
 | |
|     widget = widget->priv->parent;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return widget;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_ancestor:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @widget_type: ancestor type
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Gets the first ancestor of @widget with type @widget_type. For example,
 | |
|  * <literal>gtk_widget_get_ancestor (widget, GTK_TYPE_BOX)</literal> gets
 | |
|  * the first #GtkBox that's an ancestor of @widget. No reference will be
 | |
|  * added to the returned widget; it should not be unreferenced. See note
 | |
|  * about checking for a toplevel #GtkWindow in the docs for
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_toplevel().
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Note that unlike gtk_widget_is_ancestor(), gtk_widget_get_ancestor()
 | |
|  * considers @widget to be an ancestor of itself.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: (transfer none): the ancestor widget, or %NULL if not found
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| GtkWidget*
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_ancestor (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
| 			 GType      widget_type)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   while (widget && !g_type_is_a (G_OBJECT_TYPE (widget), widget_type))
 | |
|     widget = widget->priv->parent;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (!(widget && g_type_is_a (G_OBJECT_TYPE (widget), widget_type)))
 | |
|     return NULL;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return widget;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_set_visual:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @visual: visual to be used or %NULL to unset a previous one
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Sets the visual that should be used for by widget and its children for
 | |
|  * creating #GdkWindows. The visual must be on the same #GdkScreen as
 | |
|  * returned by gdk_widget_get_screen(), so handling the
 | |
|  * #GtkWidget::screen-changed signal is necessary.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Setting a new @visual will not cause @widget to recreate its windows,
 | |
|  * so you should call this function before @widget is realized.
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_set_visual (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                        GdkVisual *visual)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (visual == NULL || GDK_IS_VISUAL (visual));
 | |
|   if (visual)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       g_return_if_fail (gtk_widget_get_screen (widget) == gdk_visual_get_screen (visual));
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (widget),
 | |
|                            quark_visual,
 | |
|                            g_object_ref (visual),
 | |
|                            g_object_unref);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_visual:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Gets the visual that will be used to render @widget.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: (transfer none): the visual for @widget
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| GdkVisual*
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_visual (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidget *w;
 | |
|   GdkVisual *visual;
 | |
|   GdkScreen *screen;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget) &&
 | |
|       widget->priv->window)
 | |
|     return gdk_window_get_visual (widget->priv->window);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   screen = gtk_widget_get_screen (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   for (w = widget; w != NULL; w = w->priv->parent)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       visual = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (w), quark_visual);
 | |
|       if (visual)
 | |
|         {
 | |
|           if (gdk_visual_get_screen (visual) == screen)
 | |
|             return visual;
 | |
| 
 | |
|           g_warning ("Ignoring visual set on widget `%s' that is not on the correct screen.",
 | |
|                      gtk_widget_get_name (widget));
 | |
|         }
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return gdk_screen_get_system_visual (screen);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_settings:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Gets the settings object holding the settings used for this widget.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Note that this function can only be called when the #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * is attached to a toplevel, since the settings object is specific
 | |
|  * to a particular #GdkScreen.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: (transfer none): the relevant #GtkSettings object
 | |
|  */
 | |
| GtkSettings*
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_settings (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return gtk_settings_get_for_screen (gtk_widget_get_screen (widget));
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_events:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns the event mask for the widget (a bitfield containing flags
 | |
|  * from the #GdkEventMask enumeration). These are the events that the widget
 | |
|  * will receive.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: event mask for @widget
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| gint
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_events (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), 0);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return GPOINTER_TO_INT (g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_event_mask));
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_device_events:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @device: a #GdkDevice
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns the events mask for the widget corresponding to an specific device. These
 | |
|  * are the events that the widget will receive when @device operates on it.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns: device event mask for @widget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 3.0
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| GdkEventMask
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_device_events (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                               GdkDevice *device)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GHashTable *device_events;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), 0);
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GDK_IS_DEVICE (device), 0);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   device_events = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_device_event_mask);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (!device_events)
 | |
|     return 0;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return GPOINTER_TO_UINT (g_hash_table_lookup (device_events, device));
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_pointer:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @x: (out) (allow-none): return location for the X coordinate, or %NULL
 | |
|  * @y: (out) (allow-none): return location for the Y coordinate, or %NULL
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Obtains the location of the mouse pointer in widget coordinates.
 | |
|  * Widget coordinates are a bit odd; for historical reasons, they are
 | |
|  * defined as @widget->window coordinates for widgets that are not
 | |
|  * #GTK_NO_WINDOW widgets, and are relative to @widget->allocation.x,
 | |
|  * @widget->allocation.y for widgets that are #GTK_NO_WINDOW widgets.
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_pointer (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
| 			gint	  *x,
 | |
| 			gint	  *y)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetPrivate *priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   priv = widget->priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (x)
 | |
|     *x = -1;
 | |
|   if (y)
 | |
|     *y = -1;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (gtk_widget_get_realized (widget))
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       gdk_window_get_pointer (priv->window, x, y, NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (!gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget))
 | |
| 	{
 | |
| 	  if (x)
 | |
| 	    *x -= priv->allocation.x;
 | |
| 	  if (y)
 | |
| 	    *y -= priv->allocation.y;
 | |
| 	}
 | |
|     }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_is_ancestor:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @ancestor: another #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Determines whether @widget is somewhere inside @ancestor, possibly with
 | |
|  * intermediate containers.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: %TRUE if @ancestor contains @widget as a child,
 | |
|  *    grandchild, great grandchild, etc.
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| gboolean
 | |
| gtk_widget_is_ancestor (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
| 			GtkWidget *ancestor)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE);
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (ancestor != NULL, FALSE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   while (widget)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       if (widget->priv->parent == ancestor)
 | |
| 	return TRUE;
 | |
|       widget = widget->priv->parent;
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return FALSE;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static GQuark quark_composite_name = 0;
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_set_composite_name:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget.
 | |
|  * @name: the name to set
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Sets a widgets composite name. The widget must be
 | |
|  * a composite child of its parent; see gtk_widget_push_composite_child().
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_set_composite_name (GtkWidget   *widget,
 | |
| 			       const gchar *name)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (widget->priv->composite_child);
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (name != NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (!quark_composite_name)
 | |
|     quark_composite_name = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-composite-name");
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (widget),
 | |
| 			   quark_composite_name,
 | |
| 			   g_strdup (name),
 | |
| 			   g_free);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_composite_name:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Obtains the composite name of a widget.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns: the composite name of @widget, or %NULL if @widget is not
 | |
|  *   a composite child. The string should be freed when it is no
 | |
|  *   longer needed.
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| gchar*
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_composite_name (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetPrivate *priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   priv = widget->priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (widget->priv->composite_child && priv->parent)
 | |
|     return _gtk_container_child_composite_name (GTK_CONTAINER (priv->parent),
 | |
| 					       widget);
 | |
|   else
 | |
|     return NULL;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_push_composite_child:
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Makes all newly-created widgets as composite children until
 | |
|  * the corresponding gtk_widget_pop_composite_child() call.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * A composite child is a child that's an implementation detail of the
 | |
|  * container it's inside and should not be visible to people using the
 | |
|  * container. Composite children aren't treated differently by GTK (but
 | |
|  * see gtk_container_foreach() vs. gtk_container_forall()), but e.g. GUI
 | |
|  * builders might want to treat them in a different way.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Here is a simple example:
 | |
|  * |[
 | |
|  *   gtk_widget_push_composite_child ();
 | |
|  *   scrolled_window->hscrollbar = gtk_scrollbar_new (GTK_ORIENTATION_HORIZONTAL, hadjustment);
 | |
|  *   gtk_widget_set_composite_name (scrolled_window->hscrollbar, "hscrollbar");
 | |
|  *   gtk_widget_pop_composite_child ();
 | |
|  *   gtk_widget_set_parent (scrolled_window->hscrollbar,
 | |
|  *                          GTK_WIDGET (scrolled_window));
 | |
|  *   g_object_ref (scrolled_window->hscrollbar);
 | |
|  * ]|
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_push_composite_child (void)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   composite_child_stack++;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_pop_composite_child:
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Cancels the effect of a previous call to gtk_widget_push_composite_child().
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_pop_composite_child (void)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   if (composite_child_stack)
 | |
|     composite_child_stack--;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_emit_direction_changed (GtkWidget        *widget,
 | |
|                                    GtkTextDirection  old_dir)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   gtk_widget_update_pango_context (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (widget->priv->context)
 | |
|     gtk_style_context_set_direction (widget->priv->context,
 | |
|                                      gtk_widget_get_direction (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[DIRECTION_CHANGED], 0, old_dir);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_set_direction:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @dir:    the new direction
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Sets the reading direction on a particular widget. This direction
 | |
|  * controls the primary direction for widgets containing text,
 | |
|  * and also the direction in which the children of a container are
 | |
|  * packed. The ability to set the direction is present in order
 | |
|  * so that correct localization into languages with right-to-left
 | |
|  * reading directions can be done. Generally, applications will
 | |
|  * let the default reading direction present, except for containers
 | |
|  * where the containers are arranged in an order that is explicitely
 | |
|  * visual rather than logical (such as buttons for text justification).
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * If the direction is set to %GTK_TEXT_DIR_NONE, then the value
 | |
|  * set by gtk_widget_set_default_direction() will be used.
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_set_direction (GtkWidget        *widget,
 | |
|                           GtkTextDirection  dir)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkTextDirection old_dir;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (dir >= GTK_TEXT_DIR_NONE && dir <= GTK_TEXT_DIR_RTL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   old_dir = gtk_widget_get_direction (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   widget->priv->direction = dir;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (old_dir != gtk_widget_get_direction (widget))
 | |
|     gtk_widget_emit_direction_changed (widget, old_dir);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_direction:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Gets the reading direction for a particular widget. See
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_set_direction().
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: the reading direction for the widget.
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| GtkTextDirection
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_direction (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), GTK_TEXT_DIR_LTR);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (widget->priv->direction == GTK_TEXT_DIR_NONE)
 | |
|     return gtk_default_direction;
 | |
|   else
 | |
|     return widget->priv->direction;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_set_default_direction_recurse (GtkWidget *widget, gpointer data)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkTextDirection old_dir = GPOINTER_TO_UINT (data);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_object_ref (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (widget->priv->direction == GTK_TEXT_DIR_NONE)
 | |
|     gtk_widget_emit_direction_changed (widget, old_dir);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (GTK_IS_CONTAINER (widget))
 | |
|     gtk_container_forall (GTK_CONTAINER (widget),
 | |
| 			  gtk_widget_set_default_direction_recurse,
 | |
| 			  data);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_object_unref (widget);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_set_default_direction:
 | |
|  * @dir: the new default direction. This cannot be
 | |
|  *        %GTK_TEXT_DIR_NONE.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Sets the default reading direction for widgets where the
 | |
|  * direction has not been explicitly set by gtk_widget_set_direction().
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_set_default_direction (GtkTextDirection dir)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (dir == GTK_TEXT_DIR_RTL || dir == GTK_TEXT_DIR_LTR);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (dir != gtk_default_direction)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       GList *toplevels, *tmp_list;
 | |
|       GtkTextDirection old_dir = gtk_default_direction;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       gtk_default_direction = dir;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       tmp_list = toplevels = gtk_window_list_toplevels ();
 | |
|       g_list_foreach (toplevels, (GFunc)g_object_ref, NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       while (tmp_list)
 | |
| 	{
 | |
| 	  gtk_widget_set_default_direction_recurse (tmp_list->data,
 | |
| 						    GUINT_TO_POINTER (old_dir));
 | |
| 	  g_object_unref (tmp_list->data);
 | |
| 	  tmp_list = tmp_list->next;
 | |
| 	}
 | |
| 
 | |
|       g_list_free (toplevels);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_default_direction:
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Obtains the current default reading direction. See
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_set_default_direction().
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: the current default direction.
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| GtkTextDirection
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_default_direction (void)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   return gtk_default_direction;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_dispose (GObject *object)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidget *widget = GTK_WIDGET (object);
 | |
|   GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (priv->parent)
 | |
|     gtk_container_remove (GTK_CONTAINER (priv->parent), widget);
 | |
|   else if (gtk_widget_get_visible (widget))
 | |
|     gtk_widget_hide (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   priv->visible = FALSE;
 | |
|   if (gtk_widget_get_realized (widget))
 | |
|     gtk_widget_unrealize (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (!priv->in_destruction)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       priv->in_destruction = TRUE;
 | |
|       g_signal_emit (object, widget_signals[DESTROY], 0);
 | |
|       priv->in_destruction = FALSE;
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   G_OBJECT_CLASS (gtk_widget_parent_class)->dispose (object);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_real_destroy (GtkWidget *object)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   /* gtk_object_destroy() will already hold a refcount on object */
 | |
|   GtkWidget *widget = GTK_WIDGET (object);
 | |
|   GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /* wipe accelerator closures (keep order) */
 | |
|   g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_accel_path, NULL);
 | |
|   g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_accel_closures, NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /* Callers of add_mnemonic_label() should disconnect on ::destroy */
 | |
|   g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_mnemonic_labels, NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gtk_grab_remove (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (priv->style)
 | |
|     g_object_unref (priv->style);
 | |
|   priv->style = gtk_widget_get_default_style ();
 | |
|   g_object_ref (priv->style);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_finalize (GObject *object)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidget *widget = GTK_WIDGET (object);
 | |
|   GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv;
 | |
|   GtkWidgetAuxInfo *aux_info;
 | |
|   GtkAccessible *accessible;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gtk_grab_remove (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_object_unref (priv->style);
 | |
|   priv->style = NULL;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_free (priv->name);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   aux_info = gtk_widget_get_aux_info (widget, FALSE);
 | |
|   if (aux_info)
 | |
|     gtk_widget_aux_info_destroy (aux_info);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   accessible = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_accessible_object);
 | |
|   if (accessible)
 | |
|     g_object_unref (accessible);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (priv->path)
 | |
|     gtk_widget_path_free (priv->path);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (priv->context)
 | |
|     g_object_unref (priv->context);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   _gtk_widget_free_cached_sizes (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (g_object_is_floating (object))
 | |
|     g_warning ("A floating object was finalized. This means that someone\n"
 | |
|                "called g_object_unref() on an object that had only a floating\n"
 | |
|                "reference; the initial floating reference is not owned by anyone\n"
 | |
|                "and must be removed with g_object_ref_sink().");
 | |
| 
 | |
|   G_OBJECT_CLASS (gtk_widget_parent_class)->finalize (object);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /*****************************************
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_real_map:
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  *   arguments:
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  *   results:
 | |
|  *****************************************/
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_real_map (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_assert (gtk_widget_get_realized (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (!gtk_widget_get_mapped (widget))
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       gtk_widget_set_mapped (widget, TRUE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget))
 | |
| 	gdk_window_show (priv->window);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /*****************************************
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_real_unmap:
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  *   arguments:
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  *   results:
 | |
|  *****************************************/
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_real_unmap (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (gtk_widget_get_mapped (widget))
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       gtk_widget_set_mapped (widget, FALSE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget))
 | |
| 	gdk_window_hide (priv->window);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /*****************************************
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_real_realize:
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  *   arguments:
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  *   results:
 | |
|  *****************************************/
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_real_realize (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_assert (!gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gtk_widget_set_realized (widget, TRUE);
 | |
|   if (priv->parent)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       priv->window = gtk_widget_get_parent_window (widget);
 | |
|       g_object_ref (priv->window);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /*****************************************
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_real_unrealize:
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  *   arguments:
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  *   results:
 | |
|  *****************************************/
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_real_unrealize (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_assert (!widget->priv->mapped);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /* printf ("unrealizing %s\n", g_type_name (G_TYPE_FROM_INSTANCE (widget)));
 | |
|    */
 | |
| 
 | |
|    /* We must do unrealize child widget BEFORE container widget.
 | |
|     * gdk_window_destroy() destroys specified xwindow and its sub-xwindows.
 | |
|     * So, unrealizing container widget bofore its children causes the problem
 | |
|     * (for example, gdk_ic_destroy () with destroyed window causes crash. )
 | |
|     */
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (GTK_IS_CONTAINER (widget))
 | |
|     gtk_container_forall (GTK_CONTAINER (widget),
 | |
| 			  (GtkCallback) gtk_widget_unrealize,
 | |
| 			  NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget))
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       gdk_window_set_user_data (priv->window, NULL);
 | |
|       gdk_window_destroy (priv->window);
 | |
|       priv->window = NULL;
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   else
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       g_object_unref (priv->window);
 | |
|       priv->window = NULL;
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gtk_selection_remove_all (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gtk_widget_set_realized (widget, FALSE);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_real_adjust_size_request (GtkWidget         *widget,
 | |
|                                      GtkOrientation     orientation,
 | |
|                                      gint              *minimum_size,
 | |
|                                      gint              *natural_size)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   const GtkWidgetAuxInfo *aux_info;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   aux_info =_gtk_widget_get_aux_info_or_defaults (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (orientation == GTK_ORIENTATION_HORIZONTAL &&
 | |
|       aux_info->width > 0)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       *minimum_size = MAX (*minimum_size, aux_info->width);
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   else if (orientation == GTK_ORIENTATION_VERTICAL &&
 | |
|            aux_info->height > 0)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       *minimum_size = MAX (*minimum_size, aux_info->height);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /* Fix it if set_size_request made natural size smaller than min size.
 | |
|    * This would also silently fix broken widgets, but we warn about them
 | |
|    * in gtksizerequest.c when calling their size request vfuncs.
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   *natural_size = MAX (*natural_size, *minimum_size);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (orientation == GTK_ORIENTATION_HORIZONTAL)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       *minimum_size += (aux_info->margin.left + aux_info->margin.right);
 | |
|       *natural_size += (aux_info->margin.left + aux_info->margin.right);
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   else
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       *minimum_size += (aux_info->margin.top + aux_info->margin.bottom);
 | |
|       *natural_size += (aux_info->margin.top + aux_info->margin.bottom);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * _gtk_widget_peek_request_cache:
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns the address of the widget's request cache (strictly for
 | |
|  * internal use in gtksizerequest.c)
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: the address of @widget's size request cache.
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| gpointer
 | |
| _gtk_widget_peek_request_cache (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   /* Don't bother slowing things down with the return_if_fail guards here */
 | |
|   return &widget->priv->requests;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /*
 | |
|  * _gtk_widget_set_device_window:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @device: a #GdkDevice
 | |
|  * @window: the new device window
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Sets pointer window for @widget and @device.
 | |
|  * Does not ref @window.
 | |
|  */
 | |
| void
 | |
| _gtk_widget_set_device_window (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                                GdkDevice *device,
 | |
|                                GdkWindow *window)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GHashTable *device_window;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GDK_IS_DEVICE (device));
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (window == NULL || GDK_IS_WINDOW (window));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (!gtk_widget_get_mapped (widget))
 | |
|     return;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   device_window = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_pointer_window);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (!device_window && window)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       device_window = g_hash_table_new (NULL, NULL);
 | |
|       g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (widget),
 | |
|                                quark_pointer_window,
 | |
|                                device_window,
 | |
|                                (GDestroyNotify) g_hash_table_destroy);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (window)
 | |
|     g_hash_table_insert (device_window, device, window);
 | |
|   else if (device_window)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       g_hash_table_remove (device_window, device);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (g_hash_table_size (device_window) == 0)
 | |
|         g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_pointer_window, NULL);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /*
 | |
|  * _gtk_widget_get_device_window:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @device: a #GdkDevice
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: the device window set on @widget, or %NULL
 | |
|  */
 | |
| GdkWindow *
 | |
| _gtk_widget_get_device_window (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                                GdkDevice *device)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GHashTable *device_window;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL);
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GDK_IS_DEVICE (device), NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (!gtk_widget_get_mapped (widget))
 | |
|     return NULL;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   device_window = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_pointer_window);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (!device_window)
 | |
|     return NULL;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return g_hash_table_lookup (device_window, device);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /*
 | |
|  * _gtk_widget_list_devices:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns the list of #GdkDevices that is currently on top
 | |
|  * of any window belonging to @widget.
 | |
|  * Free the list with g_list_free(), the elements are owned
 | |
|  * by GTK+ and must not be freed.
 | |
|  */
 | |
| GList *
 | |
| _gtk_widget_list_devices (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GHashTableIter iter;
 | |
|   GHashTable *device_window;
 | |
|   GList *devices = NULL;
 | |
|   gpointer key, value;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (!gtk_widget_get_mapped (widget))
 | |
|     return NULL;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   device_window = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_pointer_window);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (G_UNLIKELY (!device_window))
 | |
|     return NULL;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_hash_table_iter_init (&iter, device_window);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   while (g_hash_table_iter_next (&iter, &key, &value))
 | |
|     devices = g_list_prepend (devices, key);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return devices;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| synth_crossing (GtkWidget       *widget,
 | |
|                 GdkEventType     type,
 | |
|                 GdkWindow       *window,
 | |
|                 GdkDevice       *device,
 | |
|                 GdkCrossingMode  mode,
 | |
|                 GdkNotifyType    detail)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GdkEvent *event;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   event = gdk_event_new (type);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   event->crossing.window = g_object_ref (window);
 | |
|   event->crossing.send_event = TRUE;
 | |
|   event->crossing.subwindow = g_object_ref (window);
 | |
|   event->crossing.time = GDK_CURRENT_TIME;
 | |
|   event->crossing.x = event->crossing.y = 0;
 | |
|   event->crossing.x_root = event->crossing.y_root = 0;
 | |
|   event->crossing.mode = mode;
 | |
|   event->crossing.detail = detail;
 | |
|   event->crossing.focus = FALSE;
 | |
|   event->crossing.state = 0;
 | |
|   gdk_event_set_device (event, device);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (!widget)
 | |
|     widget = gtk_get_event_widget (event);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (widget)
 | |
|     gtk_widget_event_internal (widget, event);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gdk_event_free (event);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /*
 | |
|  * _gtk_widget_synthesize_crossing:
 | |
|  * @from: the #GtkWidget the virtual pointer is leaving.
 | |
|  * @to: the #GtkWidget the virtual pointer is moving to.
 | |
|  * @mode: the #GdkCrossingMode to place on the synthesized events.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Generate crossing event(s) on widget state (sensitivity) or GTK+ grab change.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * The real pointer window is the window that most recently received an enter notify
 | |
|  * event.  Windows that don't select for crossing events can't become the real
 | |
|  * poiner window.  The real pointer widget that owns the real pointer window.  The
 | |
|  * effective pointer window is the same as the real pointer window unless the real
 | |
|  * pointer widget is either insensitive or there is a grab on a widget that is not
 | |
|  * an ancestor of the real pointer widget (in which case the effective pointer
 | |
|  * window should be the root window).
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * When the effective pointer window is the same as the real poiner window, we
 | |
|  * receive crossing events from the windowing system.  When the effective pointer
 | |
|  * window changes to become different from the real pointer window we synthesize
 | |
|  * crossing events, attempting to follow X protocol rules:
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * When the root window becomes the effective pointer window:
 | |
|  *   - leave notify on real pointer window, detail Ancestor
 | |
|  *   - leave notify on all of its ancestors, detail Virtual
 | |
|  *   - enter notify on root window, detail Inferior
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * When the root window ceases to be the effective pointer window:
 | |
|  *   - leave notify on root window, detail Inferior
 | |
|  *   - enter notify on all ancestors of real pointer window, detail Virtual
 | |
|  *   - enter notify on real pointer window, detail Ancestor
 | |
|  */
 | |
| void
 | |
| _gtk_widget_synthesize_crossing (GtkWidget       *from,
 | |
| 				 GtkWidget       *to,
 | |
|                                  GdkDevice       *device,
 | |
| 				 GdkCrossingMode  mode)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GdkWindow *from_window = NULL, *to_window = NULL;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (from != NULL || to != NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (from != NULL)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       from_window = _gtk_widget_get_device_window (from, device);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (!from_window)
 | |
|         from_window = from->priv->window;
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (to != NULL)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       to_window = _gtk_widget_get_device_window (to, device);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (!to_window)
 | |
|         to_window = to->priv->window;
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (from_window == NULL && to_window == NULL)
 | |
|     ;
 | |
|   else if (from_window != NULL && to_window == NULL)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       GList *from_ancestors = NULL, *list;
 | |
|       GdkWindow *from_ancestor = from_window;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       while (from_ancestor != NULL)
 | |
| 	{
 | |
| 	  from_ancestor = gdk_window_get_effective_parent (from_ancestor);
 | |
|           if (from_ancestor == NULL)
 | |
|             break;
 | |
|           from_ancestors = g_list_prepend (from_ancestors, from_ancestor);
 | |
| 	}
 | |
| 
 | |
|       synth_crossing (from, GDK_LEAVE_NOTIFY, from_window,
 | |
| 		      device, mode, GDK_NOTIFY_ANCESTOR);
 | |
|       for (list = g_list_last (from_ancestors); list; list = list->prev)
 | |
| 	{
 | |
| 	  synth_crossing (NULL, GDK_LEAVE_NOTIFY, (GdkWindow *) list->data,
 | |
| 			  device, mode, GDK_NOTIFY_VIRTUAL);
 | |
| 	}
 | |
| 
 | |
|       /* XXX: enter/inferior on root window? */
 | |
| 
 | |
|       g_list_free (from_ancestors);
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   else if (from_window == NULL && to_window != NULL)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       GList *to_ancestors = NULL, *list;
 | |
|       GdkWindow *to_ancestor = to_window;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       while (to_ancestor != NULL)
 | |
| 	{
 | |
| 	  to_ancestor = gdk_window_get_effective_parent (to_ancestor);
 | |
| 	  if (to_ancestor == NULL)
 | |
|             break;
 | |
|           to_ancestors = g_list_prepend (to_ancestors, to_ancestor);
 | |
|         }
 | |
| 
 | |
|       /* XXX: leave/inferior on root window? */
 | |
| 
 | |
|       for (list = to_ancestors; list; list = list->next)
 | |
| 	{
 | |
| 	  synth_crossing (NULL, GDK_ENTER_NOTIFY, (GdkWindow *) list->data,
 | |
| 			  device, mode, GDK_NOTIFY_VIRTUAL);
 | |
| 	}
 | |
|       synth_crossing (to, GDK_ENTER_NOTIFY, to_window,
 | |
| 		      device, mode, GDK_NOTIFY_ANCESTOR);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       g_list_free (to_ancestors);
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   else if (from_window == to_window)
 | |
|     ;
 | |
|   else
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       GList *from_ancestors = NULL, *to_ancestors = NULL, *list;
 | |
|       GdkWindow *from_ancestor = from_window, *to_ancestor = to_window;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       while (from_ancestor != NULL || to_ancestor != NULL)
 | |
| 	{
 | |
| 	  if (from_ancestor != NULL)
 | |
| 	    {
 | |
| 	      from_ancestor = gdk_window_get_effective_parent (from_ancestor);
 | |
| 	      if (from_ancestor == to_window)
 | |
| 		break;
 | |
|               if (from_ancestor)
 | |
| 	        from_ancestors = g_list_prepend (from_ancestors, from_ancestor);
 | |
| 	    }
 | |
| 	  if (to_ancestor != NULL)
 | |
| 	    {
 | |
| 	      to_ancestor = gdk_window_get_effective_parent (to_ancestor);
 | |
| 	      if (to_ancestor == from_window)
 | |
| 		break;
 | |
|               if (to_ancestor)
 | |
| 	        to_ancestors = g_list_prepend (to_ancestors, to_ancestor);
 | |
| 	    }
 | |
| 	}
 | |
|       if (to_ancestor == from_window)
 | |
| 	{
 | |
| 	  if (mode != GDK_CROSSING_GTK_UNGRAB)
 | |
| 	    synth_crossing (from, GDK_LEAVE_NOTIFY, from_window,
 | |
| 			    device, mode, GDK_NOTIFY_INFERIOR);
 | |
| 	  for (list = to_ancestors; list; list = list->next)
 | |
| 	    synth_crossing (NULL, GDK_ENTER_NOTIFY, (GdkWindow *) list->data,
 | |
| 			    device, mode, GDK_NOTIFY_VIRTUAL);
 | |
| 	  synth_crossing (to, GDK_ENTER_NOTIFY, to_window,
 | |
| 			  device, mode, GDK_NOTIFY_ANCESTOR);
 | |
| 	}
 | |
|       else if (from_ancestor == to_window)
 | |
| 	{
 | |
| 	  synth_crossing (from, GDK_LEAVE_NOTIFY, from_window,
 | |
| 			  device, mode, GDK_NOTIFY_ANCESTOR);
 | |
| 	  for (list = g_list_last (from_ancestors); list; list = list->prev)
 | |
| 	    {
 | |
| 	      synth_crossing (NULL, GDK_LEAVE_NOTIFY, (GdkWindow *) list->data,
 | |
| 			      device, mode, GDK_NOTIFY_VIRTUAL);
 | |
| 	    }
 | |
| 	  if (mode != GDK_CROSSING_GTK_GRAB)
 | |
| 	    synth_crossing (to, GDK_ENTER_NOTIFY, to_window,
 | |
| 			    device, mode, GDK_NOTIFY_INFERIOR);
 | |
| 	}
 | |
|       else
 | |
| 	{
 | |
| 	  while (from_ancestors != NULL && to_ancestors != NULL
 | |
| 		 && from_ancestors->data == to_ancestors->data)
 | |
| 	    {
 | |
| 	      from_ancestors = g_list_delete_link (from_ancestors,
 | |
| 						   from_ancestors);
 | |
| 	      to_ancestors = g_list_delete_link (to_ancestors, to_ancestors);
 | |
| 	    }
 | |
| 
 | |
| 	  synth_crossing (from, GDK_LEAVE_NOTIFY, from_window,
 | |
| 			  device, mode, GDK_NOTIFY_NONLINEAR);
 | |
| 
 | |
| 	  for (list = g_list_last (from_ancestors); list; list = list->prev)
 | |
| 	    {
 | |
| 	      synth_crossing (NULL, GDK_LEAVE_NOTIFY, (GdkWindow *) list->data,
 | |
| 			      device, mode, GDK_NOTIFY_NONLINEAR_VIRTUAL);
 | |
| 	    }
 | |
| 	  for (list = to_ancestors; list; list = list->next)
 | |
| 	    {
 | |
| 	      synth_crossing (NULL, GDK_ENTER_NOTIFY, (GdkWindow *) list->data,
 | |
| 			      device, mode, GDK_NOTIFY_NONLINEAR_VIRTUAL);
 | |
| 	    }
 | |
| 	  synth_crossing (to, GDK_ENTER_NOTIFY, to_window,
 | |
| 			  device, mode, GDK_NOTIFY_NONLINEAR);
 | |
| 	}
 | |
|       g_list_free (from_ancestors);
 | |
|       g_list_free (to_ancestors);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_propagate_state (GtkWidget    *widget,
 | |
|                             GtkStateData *data)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv;
 | |
|   GtkStateFlags new_flags, old_flags = priv->state_flags;
 | |
|   GtkStateType old_state;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   old_state = gtk_widget_get_state (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   switch (data->operation)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|     case STATE_CHANGE_REPLACE:
 | |
|       priv->state_flags = data->flags;
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case STATE_CHANGE_SET:
 | |
|       priv->state_flags |= data->flags;
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     case STATE_CHANGE_UNSET:
 | |
|       priv->state_flags &= ~(data->flags);
 | |
|       break;
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /* make insensitivity unoverridable */
 | |
|   if (!priv->sensitive)
 | |
|     priv->state_flags |= GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (gtk_widget_is_focus (widget) && !gtk_widget_is_sensitive (widget))
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       GtkWidget *window;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       window = gtk_widget_get_toplevel (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (window && gtk_widget_is_toplevel (window))
 | |
|         gtk_window_set_focus (GTK_WINDOW (window), NULL);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   new_flags = priv->state_flags;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (old_flags != new_flags)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       g_object_ref (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (!gtk_widget_is_sensitive (widget) && gtk_widget_has_grab (widget))
 | |
|         gtk_grab_remove (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[STATE_CHANGED], 0, old_state);
 | |
|       g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[STATE_FLAGS_CHANGED], 0, old_flags);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (!priv->shadowed)
 | |
|         {
 | |
|           GList *event_windows = NULL;
 | |
|           GList *devices, *d;
 | |
| 
 | |
|           devices = _gtk_widget_list_devices (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|           for (d = devices; d; d = d->next)
 | |
|             {
 | |
|               GdkWindow *window;
 | |
|               GdkDevice *device;
 | |
| 
 | |
|               device = d->data;
 | |
|               window = _gtk_widget_get_device_window (widget, device);
 | |
| 
 | |
|               /* Do not propagate more than once to the
 | |
|                * same window if non-multidevice aware.
 | |
|                */
 | |
|               if (!gdk_window_get_support_multidevice (window) &&
 | |
|                   g_list_find (event_windows, window))
 | |
|                 continue;
 | |
| 
 | |
|               if (!gtk_widget_is_sensitive (widget))
 | |
|                 _gtk_widget_synthesize_crossing (widget, NULL, d->data,
 | |
|                                                  GDK_CROSSING_STATE_CHANGED);
 | |
|               else if (old_flags & GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE)
 | |
|                 _gtk_widget_synthesize_crossing (NULL, widget, d->data,
 | |
|                                                  GDK_CROSSING_STATE_CHANGED);
 | |
| 
 | |
|               event_windows = g_list_prepend (event_windows, window);
 | |
|             }
 | |
| 
 | |
|           g_list_free (event_windows);
 | |
|           g_list_free (devices);
 | |
|         }
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (GTK_IS_CONTAINER (widget))
 | |
|         {
 | |
|           GtkStateData child_data = *data;
 | |
| 
 | |
|           /* Make sure to only propate the right states further */
 | |
|           child_data.flags &= GTK_STATE_FLAGS_DO_PROPAGATE;
 | |
| 
 | |
|           if (child_data.use_forall)
 | |
|             gtk_container_forall (GTK_CONTAINER (widget),
 | |
|                                   (GtkCallback) gtk_widget_propagate_state,
 | |
|                                   &child_data);
 | |
|           else
 | |
|             gtk_container_foreach (GTK_CONTAINER (widget),
 | |
|                                    (GtkCallback) gtk_widget_propagate_state,
 | |
|                                    &child_data);
 | |
|         }
 | |
| 
 | |
|       /* Trigger state change transitions for the widget */
 | |
|       if (priv->context &&
 | |
|           gtk_widget_get_mapped (widget))
 | |
|         {
 | |
|           gint diff, flag = 1;
 | |
| 
 | |
|           diff = old_flags ^ new_flags;
 | |
| 
 | |
|           while (diff != 0)
 | |
|             {
 | |
|               if ((diff & flag) != 0)
 | |
|                 {
 | |
|                   gboolean target;
 | |
| 
 | |
|                   target = ((new_flags & flag) != 0);
 | |
|                   _gtk_widget_notify_state_change (widget, flag, target);
 | |
| 
 | |
|                   diff &= ~flag;
 | |
|                 }
 | |
| 
 | |
|               flag <<= 1;
 | |
|             }
 | |
|         }
 | |
| 
 | |
|       g_object_unref (widget);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static const GtkWidgetAuxInfo default_aux_info = {
 | |
|   -1, -1,
 | |
|   GTK_ALIGN_FILL,
 | |
|   GTK_ALIGN_FILL,
 | |
|   { 0, 0, 0, 0 }
 | |
| };
 | |
| 
 | |
| /*
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_aux_info:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @create: if %TRUE, create the structure if it doesn't exist
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Get the #GtkWidgetAuxInfo structure for the widget.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: the #GtkAuxInfo structure for the widget, or
 | |
|  *    %NULL if @create is %FALSE and one doesn't already exist.
 | |
|  */
 | |
| static GtkWidgetAuxInfo *
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_aux_info (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
| 			 gboolean   create)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetAuxInfo *aux_info;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   aux_info = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_aux_info);
 | |
|   if (!aux_info && create)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       aux_info = g_slice_new0 (GtkWidgetAuxInfo);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       *aux_info = default_aux_info;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_aux_info, aux_info);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return aux_info;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static const GtkWidgetAuxInfo*
 | |
| _gtk_widget_get_aux_info_or_defaults (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetAuxInfo *aux_info;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   aux_info = gtk_widget_get_aux_info (widget, FALSE);
 | |
|   if (aux_info == NULL)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       return &default_aux_info;
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   else
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       return aux_info;
 | |
|     }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /*****************************************
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_aux_info_destroy:
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  *   arguments:
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  *   results:
 | |
|  *****************************************/
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_aux_info_destroy (GtkWidgetAuxInfo *aux_info)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_slice_free (GtkWidgetAuxInfo, aux_info);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_shape_combine_region:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @region: (allow-none): shape to be added, or %NULL to remove an existing shape
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Sets a shape for this widget's GDK window. This allows for
 | |
|  * transparent windows etc., see gdk_window_shape_combine_region()
 | |
|  * for more information.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 3.0
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_shape_combine_region (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                                  cairo_region_t *region)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetPrivate *priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
|   /*  set_shape doesn't work on widgets without gdk window */
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   priv = widget->priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (region == NULL)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       priv->has_shape_mask = FALSE;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (priv->window)
 | |
| 	gdk_window_shape_combine_region (priv->window, NULL, 0, 0);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_shape_info, NULL);
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   else
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       priv->has_shape_mask = TRUE;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_shape_info,
 | |
|                                cairo_region_copy (region),
 | |
| 			       (GDestroyNotify) cairo_region_destroy);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       /* set shape if widget has a gdk window already.
 | |
|        * otherwise the shape is scheduled to be set by gtk_widget_realize().
 | |
|        */
 | |
|       if (priv->window)
 | |
| 	gdk_window_shape_combine_region (priv->window, region, 0, 0);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_input_shape_combine_region:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @region: (allow-none): shape to be added, or %NULL to remove an existing shape
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Sets an input shape for this widget's GDK window. This allows for
 | |
|  * windows which react to mouse click in a nonrectangular region, see
 | |
|  * gdk_window_input_shape_combine_region() for more information.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 3.0
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_input_shape_combine_region (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                                        cairo_region_t *region)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetPrivate *priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
|   /*  set_shape doesn't work on widgets without gdk window */
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   priv = widget->priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (region == NULL)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       if (priv->window)
 | |
| 	gdk_window_input_shape_combine_region (priv->window, NULL, 0, 0);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_input_shape_info, NULL);
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   else
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_input_shape_info,
 | |
| 			       cairo_region_copy (region),
 | |
| 			       (GDestroyNotify) cairo_region_destroy);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       /* set shape if widget has a gdk window already.
 | |
|        * otherwise the shape is scheduled to be set by gtk_widget_realize().
 | |
|        */
 | |
|       if (priv->window)
 | |
| 	gdk_window_input_shape_combine_region (priv->window, region, 0, 0);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| /* style properties
 | |
|  */
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_class_install_style_property_parser: (skip)
 | |
|  * @klass: a #GtkWidgetClass
 | |
|  * @pspec: the #GParamSpec for the style property
 | |
|  * @parser: the parser for the style property
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Installs a style property on a widget class.
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_class_install_style_property_parser (GtkWidgetClass     *klass,
 | |
| 						GParamSpec         *pspec,
 | |
| 						GtkRcPropertyParser parser)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET_CLASS (klass));
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (G_IS_PARAM_SPEC (pspec));
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (pspec->flags & G_PARAM_READABLE);
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (!(pspec->flags & (G_PARAM_CONSTRUCT_ONLY | G_PARAM_CONSTRUCT)));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (g_param_spec_pool_lookup (style_property_spec_pool, pspec->name, G_OBJECT_CLASS_TYPE (klass), FALSE))
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       g_warning (G_STRLOC ": class `%s' already contains a style property named `%s'",
 | |
| 		 G_OBJECT_CLASS_NAME (klass),
 | |
| 		 pspec->name);
 | |
|       return;
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_param_spec_ref_sink (pspec);
 | |
|   g_param_spec_set_qdata (pspec, quark_property_parser, (gpointer) parser);
 | |
|   g_param_spec_pool_insert (style_property_spec_pool, pspec, G_OBJECT_CLASS_TYPE (klass));
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_class_install_style_property:
 | |
|  * @klass: a #GtkWidgetClass
 | |
|  * @pspec: the #GParamSpec for the property
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Installs a style property on a widget class. The parser for the
 | |
|  * style property is determined by the value type of @pspec.
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_class_install_style_property (GtkWidgetClass *klass,
 | |
| 					 GParamSpec     *pspec)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkRcPropertyParser parser;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET_CLASS (klass));
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (G_IS_PARAM_SPEC (pspec));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   parser = _gtk_rc_property_parser_from_type (G_PARAM_SPEC_VALUE_TYPE (pspec));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gtk_widget_class_install_style_property_parser (klass, pspec, parser);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_class_find_style_property:
 | |
|  * @klass: a #GtkWidgetClass
 | |
|  * @property_name: the name of the style property to find
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Finds a style property of a widget class by name.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns: (transfer none): the #GParamSpec of the style property or
 | |
|  *   %NULL if @class has no style property with that name.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.2
 | |
|  */
 | |
| GParamSpec*
 | |
| gtk_widget_class_find_style_property (GtkWidgetClass *klass,
 | |
| 				      const gchar    *property_name)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (property_name != NULL, NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return g_param_spec_pool_lookup (style_property_spec_pool,
 | |
| 				   property_name,
 | |
| 				   G_OBJECT_CLASS_TYPE (klass),
 | |
| 				   TRUE);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_class_list_style_properties:
 | |
|  * @klass: a #GtkWidgetClass
 | |
|  * @n_properties: location to return the number of style properties found
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns all style properties of a widget class.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns: (array length=n_properties) (transfer container): a
 | |
|  *     newly allocated array of #GParamSpec*. The array must be
 | |
|  *     freed with g_free().
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.2
 | |
|  */
 | |
| GParamSpec**
 | |
| gtk_widget_class_list_style_properties (GtkWidgetClass *klass,
 | |
| 					guint          *n_properties)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GParamSpec **pspecs;
 | |
|   guint n;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   pspecs = g_param_spec_pool_list (style_property_spec_pool,
 | |
| 				   G_OBJECT_CLASS_TYPE (klass),
 | |
| 				   &n);
 | |
|   if (n_properties)
 | |
|     *n_properties = n;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return pspecs;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_style_get_property:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @property_name: the name of a style property
 | |
|  * @value: location to return the property value
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Gets the value of a style property of @widget.
 | |
|  */
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_style_get_property (GtkWidget   *widget,
 | |
| 			       const gchar *property_name,
 | |
| 			       GValue      *value)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GParamSpec *pspec;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (property_name != NULL);
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (G_IS_VALUE (value));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_object_ref (widget);
 | |
|   pspec = g_param_spec_pool_lookup (style_property_spec_pool,
 | |
| 				    property_name,
 | |
| 				    G_OBJECT_TYPE (widget),
 | |
| 				    TRUE);
 | |
|   if (!pspec)
 | |
|     g_warning ("%s: widget class `%s' has no property named `%s'",
 | |
| 	       G_STRLOC,
 | |
| 	       G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget),
 | |
| 	       property_name);
 | |
|   else
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       GtkStyleContext *context;
 | |
|       const GValue *peek_value;
 | |
|       GtkStateFlags state;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       context = gtk_widget_get_style_context (widget);
 | |
|       state = gtk_widget_get_state_flags (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       peek_value = _gtk_style_context_peek_style_property (context,
 | |
|                                                            G_OBJECT_TYPE (widget),
 | |
|                                                            state, pspec);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       /* auto-conversion of the caller's value type
 | |
|        */
 | |
|       if (G_VALUE_TYPE (value) == G_PARAM_SPEC_VALUE_TYPE (pspec))
 | |
| 	g_value_copy (peek_value, value);
 | |
|       else if (g_value_type_transformable (G_PARAM_SPEC_VALUE_TYPE (pspec), G_VALUE_TYPE (value)))
 | |
| 	g_value_transform (peek_value, value);
 | |
|       else
 | |
| 	g_warning ("can't retrieve style property `%s' of type `%s' as value of type `%s'",
 | |
| 		   pspec->name,
 | |
| 		   g_type_name (G_PARAM_SPEC_VALUE_TYPE (pspec)),
 | |
| 		   G_VALUE_TYPE_NAME (value));
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   g_object_unref (widget);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_style_get_valist:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @first_property_name: the name of the first property to get
 | |
|  * @var_args: a <type>va_list</type> of pairs of property names and
 | |
|  *     locations to return the property values, starting with the location
 | |
|  *     for @first_property_name.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Non-vararg variant of gtk_widget_style_get(). Used primarily by language
 | |
|  * bindings.
 | |
|  */
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_style_get_valist (GtkWidget   *widget,
 | |
| 			     const gchar *first_property_name,
 | |
| 			     va_list      var_args)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkStyleContext *context;
 | |
|   GtkStateFlags state;
 | |
|   const gchar *name;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_object_ref (widget);
 | |
|   context = gtk_widget_get_style_context (widget);
 | |
|   state = gtk_widget_get_state_flags (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   name = first_property_name;
 | |
|   while (name)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       const GValue *peek_value;
 | |
|       GParamSpec *pspec;
 | |
|       gchar *error;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       pspec = g_param_spec_pool_lookup (style_property_spec_pool,
 | |
| 					name,
 | |
| 					G_OBJECT_TYPE (widget),
 | |
| 					TRUE);
 | |
|       if (!pspec)
 | |
| 	{
 | |
| 	  g_warning ("%s: widget class `%s' has no property named `%s'",
 | |
| 		     G_STRLOC,
 | |
| 		     G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget),
 | |
| 		     name);
 | |
| 	  break;
 | |
| 	}
 | |
|       /* style pspecs are always readable so we can spare that check here */
 | |
| 
 | |
|       peek_value = _gtk_style_context_peek_style_property (context,
 | |
|                                                            G_OBJECT_TYPE (widget),
 | |
|                                                            state, pspec);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       G_VALUE_LCOPY (peek_value, var_args, 0, &error);
 | |
|       if (error)
 | |
| 	{
 | |
| 	  g_warning ("%s: %s", G_STRLOC, error);
 | |
| 	  g_free (error);
 | |
| 	  break;
 | |
| 	}
 | |
| 
 | |
|       name = va_arg (var_args, gchar*);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_object_unref (widget);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_style_get:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @first_property_name: the name of the first property to get
 | |
|  * @...: pairs of property names and locations to return the
 | |
|  *     property values, starting with the location for
 | |
|  *     @first_property_name, terminated by %NULL.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Gets the values of a multiple style properties of @widget.
 | |
|  */
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_style_get (GtkWidget   *widget,
 | |
| 		      const gchar *first_property_name,
 | |
| 		      ...)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   va_list var_args;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   va_start (var_args, first_property_name);
 | |
|   gtk_widget_style_get_valist (widget, first_property_name, var_args);
 | |
|   va_end (var_args);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_path:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @path_length: (out) (allow-none): location to store length of the path,
 | |
|  *     or %NULL
 | |
|  * @path: (out) (allow-none): location to store allocated path string,
 | |
|  *     or %NULL
 | |
|  * @path_reversed: (out) (allow-none): location to store allocated reverse
 | |
|  *     path string, or %NULL
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Obtains the full path to @widget. The path is simply the name of a
 | |
|  * widget and all its parents in the container hierarchy, separated by
 | |
|  * periods. The name of a widget comes from
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_name(). Paths are used to apply styles to a widget
 | |
|  * in gtkrc configuration files. Widget names are the type of the
 | |
|  * widget by default (e.g. "GtkButton") or can be set to an
 | |
|  * application-specific value with gtk_widget_set_name(). By setting
 | |
|  * the name of a widget, you allow users or theme authors to apply
 | |
|  * styles to that specific widget in their gtkrc
 | |
|  * file. @path_reversed_p fills in the path in reverse order,
 | |
|  * i.e. starting with @widget's name instead of starting with the name
 | |
|  * of @widget's outermost ancestor.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Deprecated:3.0: Use gtk_widget_get_path() instead
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_path (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
| 		 guint     *path_length,
 | |
| 		 gchar    **path,
 | |
| 		 gchar    **path_reversed)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   static gchar *rev_path = NULL;
 | |
|   static guint tmp_path_len = 0;
 | |
|   guint len;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   len = 0;
 | |
|   do
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       const gchar *string;
 | |
|       const gchar *s;
 | |
|       gchar *d;
 | |
|       guint l;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       string = gtk_widget_get_name (widget);
 | |
|       l = strlen (string);
 | |
|       while (tmp_path_len <= len + l + 1)
 | |
| 	{
 | |
| 	  tmp_path_len += INIT_PATH_SIZE;
 | |
| 	  rev_path = g_realloc (rev_path, tmp_path_len);
 | |
| 	}
 | |
|       s = string + l - 1;
 | |
|       d = rev_path + len;
 | |
|       while (s >= string)
 | |
| 	*(d++) = *(s--);
 | |
|       len += l;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       widget = widget->priv->parent;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (widget)
 | |
| 	rev_path[len++] = '.';
 | |
|       else
 | |
| 	rev_path[len++] = 0;
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   while (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (path_length)
 | |
|     *path_length = len - 1;
 | |
|   if (path_reversed)
 | |
|     *path_reversed = g_strdup (rev_path);
 | |
|   if (path)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       *path = g_strdup (rev_path);
 | |
|       g_strreverse (*path);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_class_path:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @path_length: (out) (allow-none): location to store the length of the
 | |
|  *     class path, or %NULL
 | |
|  * @path: (out) (allow-none): location to store the class path as an
 | |
|  *     allocated string, or %NULL
 | |
|  * @path_reversed: (out) (allow-none): location to store the reverse
 | |
|  *     class path as an allocated string, or %NULL
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Same as gtk_widget_path(), but always uses the name of a widget's type,
 | |
|  * never uses a custom name set with gtk_widget_set_name().
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Deprecated:3.0: Use gtk_widget_get_path() instead
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_class_path (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
| 		       guint     *path_length,
 | |
| 		       gchar    **path,
 | |
| 		       gchar    **path_reversed)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   static gchar *rev_path = NULL;
 | |
|   static guint tmp_path_len = 0;
 | |
|   guint len;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   len = 0;
 | |
|   do
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       const gchar *string;
 | |
|       const gchar *s;
 | |
|       gchar *d;
 | |
|       guint l;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       string = g_type_name (G_OBJECT_TYPE (widget));
 | |
|       l = strlen (string);
 | |
|       while (tmp_path_len <= len + l + 1)
 | |
| 	{
 | |
| 	  tmp_path_len += INIT_PATH_SIZE;
 | |
| 	  rev_path = g_realloc (rev_path, tmp_path_len);
 | |
| 	}
 | |
|       s = string + l - 1;
 | |
|       d = rev_path + len;
 | |
|       while (s >= string)
 | |
| 	*(d++) = *(s--);
 | |
|       len += l;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       widget = widget->priv->parent;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (widget)
 | |
| 	rev_path[len++] = '.';
 | |
|       else
 | |
| 	rev_path[len++] = 0;
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   while (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (path_length)
 | |
|     *path_length = len - 1;
 | |
|   if (path_reversed)
 | |
|     *path_reversed = g_strdup (rev_path);
 | |
|   if (path)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       *path = g_strdup (rev_path);
 | |
|       g_strreverse (*path);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_requisition_new:
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Allocates a new #GtkRequisition structure and initializes its elements to zero.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns: a new empty #GtkRequisition. The newly allocated #GtkRequisition should
 | |
|  *   be freed with gtk_requisition_free().
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 3.0
 | |
|  */
 | |
| GtkRequisition *
 | |
| gtk_requisition_new (void)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   return g_slice_new0 (GtkRequisition);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_requisition_copy:
 | |
|  * @requisition: a #GtkRequisition
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Copies a #GtkRequisition.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns: a copy of @requisition
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| GtkRequisition *
 | |
| gtk_requisition_copy (const GtkRequisition *requisition)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   return g_slice_dup (GtkRequisition, requisition);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_requisition_free:
 | |
|  * @requisition: a #GtkRequisition
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Frees a #GtkRequisition.
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_requisition_free (GtkRequisition *requisition)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_slice_free (GtkRequisition, requisition);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| G_DEFINE_BOXED_TYPE (GtkRequisition, gtk_requisition,
 | |
|                      gtk_requisition_copy,
 | |
|                      gtk_requisition_free)
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_class_set_accessible_type:
 | |
|  * @widget_class: class to set the accessible type for
 | |
|  * @type: The object type that implements the accessible for @widget_class
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Sets the type to be used for creating accessibles for widgets of
 | |
|  * @widget_class. The given @type must be a subtype of the type used for
 | |
|  * accessibles of the parent class.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * This function should only be called from class init functions of widgets.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 3.2
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_class_set_accessible_type (GtkWidgetClass *widget_class,
 | |
|                                       GType           type)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetClassPrivate *priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET_CLASS (widget_class));
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (g_type_is_a (type, widget_class->priv->accessible_type));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   priv = widget_class->priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   priv->accessible_type = type;
 | |
|   /* reset this - honoring the type's role is better. */
 | |
|   priv->accessible_role = ATK_ROLE_INVALID;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_class_set_accessible_role:
 | |
|  * @widget_class: class to set the accessible role for
 | |
|  * @role: The role to use for accessibles created for @widget_class
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Sets the default #AtkRole to be set on accessibles created for
 | |
|  * widgets of @widget_class. Accessibles may decide to not honor this
 | |
|  * setting if their role reporting is more refined. Calls to 
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_class_set_accessible_type() will reset this value.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * In cases where you want more fine-grained control over the role of
 | |
|  * accessibles created for @widget_class, you should provide your own
 | |
|  * accessible type and use gtk_widget_class_set_accessible_type()
 | |
|  * instead.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * If @role is #ATK_ROLE_INVALID, the default role will not be changed
 | |
|  * and the accessible's default role will be used instead.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * This function should only be called from class init functions of widgets.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 3.2
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_class_set_accessible_role (GtkWidgetClass *widget_class,
 | |
|                                       AtkRole         role)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetClassPrivate *priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET_CLASS (widget_class));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   priv = widget_class->priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   priv->accessible_role = role;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_accessible:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns the accessible object that describes the widget to an
 | |
|  * assistive technology.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * If accessibility support is not available, this #AtkObject
 | |
|  * instance may be a no-op. Likewise, if no class-specific #AtkObject
 | |
|  * implementation is available for the widget instance in question,
 | |
|  * it will inherit an #AtkObject implementation from the first ancestor
 | |
|  * class for which such an implementation is defined.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * The documentation of the
 | |
|  * <ulink url="http://library.gnome.org/devel/atk/stable/">ATK</ulink>
 | |
|  * library contains more information about accessible objects and their uses.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns: (transfer none): the #AtkObject associated with @widget
 | |
|  */
 | |
| AtkObject*
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_accessible (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetClass *klass;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   klass = GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (klass->get_accessible != NULL, NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return klass->get_accessible (widget);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static AtkObject*
 | |
| gtk_widget_real_get_accessible (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   AtkObject* accessible;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   accessible = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget),
 | |
|                                    quark_accessible_object);
 | |
|   if (!accessible)
 | |
|   {
 | |
|     GtkWidgetClass *widget_class;
 | |
|     GtkWidgetClassPrivate *priv;
 | |
|     AtkObjectFactory *factory;
 | |
|     AtkRegistry *default_registry;
 | |
| 
 | |
|     widget_class = GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget);
 | |
|     priv = widget_class->priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|     if (priv->accessible_type == GTK_TYPE_ACCESSIBLE)
 | |
|       {
 | |
|         default_registry = atk_get_default_registry ();
 | |
|         factory = atk_registry_get_factory (default_registry,
 | |
|                                             G_TYPE_FROM_INSTANCE (widget));
 | |
|         accessible =
 | |
|           atk_object_factory_create_accessible (factory,
 | |
|                                                 G_OBJECT (widget));
 | |
|       }
 | |
|     else
 | |
|       {
 | |
|         accessible = g_object_new (priv->accessible_type, NULL);
 | |
|         atk_object_initialize (accessible, widget);
 | |
|       }
 | |
| 
 | |
|     if (priv->accessible_role != ATK_ROLE_INVALID)
 | |
|       atk_object_set_role (accessible, priv->accessible_role);
 | |
| 
 | |
|     g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget),
 | |
|                         quark_accessible_object,
 | |
|                         accessible);
 | |
|   }
 | |
|   return accessible;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /*
 | |
|  * Initialize a AtkImplementorIface instance's virtual pointers as
 | |
|  * appropriate to this implementor's class (GtkWidget).
 | |
|  */
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_accessible_interface_init (AtkImplementorIface *iface)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   iface->ref_accessible = gtk_widget_ref_accessible;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static AtkObject*
 | |
| gtk_widget_ref_accessible (AtkImplementor *implementor)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   AtkObject *accessible;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   accessible = gtk_widget_get_accessible (GTK_WIDGET (implementor));
 | |
|   if (accessible)
 | |
|     g_object_ref (accessible);
 | |
|   return accessible;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /*
 | |
|  * Expand flag management
 | |
|  */
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_update_computed_expand (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetPrivate *priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   priv = widget->priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (priv->need_compute_expand)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       gboolean h, v;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (priv->hexpand_set)
 | |
|         h = priv->hexpand;
 | |
|       else
 | |
|         h = FALSE;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (priv->vexpand_set)
 | |
|         v = priv->vexpand;
 | |
|       else
 | |
|         v = FALSE;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       /* we don't need to use compute_expand if both expands are
 | |
|        * forced by the app
 | |
|        */
 | |
|       if (!(priv->hexpand_set && priv->vexpand_set))
 | |
|         {
 | |
|           if (GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget)->compute_expand != NULL)
 | |
|             {
 | |
|               gboolean ignored;
 | |
| 
 | |
|               GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget)->compute_expand (widget,
 | |
|                                                              priv->hexpand_set ? &ignored : &h,
 | |
|                                                              priv->vexpand_set ? &ignored : &v);
 | |
|             }
 | |
|         }
 | |
| 
 | |
|       priv->need_compute_expand = FALSE;
 | |
|       priv->computed_hexpand = h != FALSE;
 | |
|       priv->computed_vexpand = v != FALSE;
 | |
|     }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_queue_compute_expand:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Mark @widget as needing to recompute its expand flags. Call
 | |
|  * this function when setting legacy expand child properties
 | |
|  * on the child of a container.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * See gtk_widget_compute_expand().
 | |
|  */
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_queue_compute_expand (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidget *parent;
 | |
|   gboolean changed_anything;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (widget->priv->need_compute_expand)
 | |
|     return;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   changed_anything = FALSE;
 | |
|   parent = widget;
 | |
|   while (parent != NULL)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       if (!parent->priv->need_compute_expand)
 | |
|         {
 | |
|           parent->priv->need_compute_expand = TRUE;
 | |
|           changed_anything = TRUE;
 | |
|         }
 | |
| 
 | |
|       /* Note: if we had an invariant that "if a child needs to
 | |
|        * compute expand, its parents also do" then we could stop going
 | |
|        * up when we got to a parent that already needed to
 | |
|        * compute. However, in general we compute expand lazily (as
 | |
|        * soon as we see something in a subtree that is expand, we know
 | |
|        * we're expanding) and so this invariant does not hold and we
 | |
|        * have to always walk all the way up in case some ancestor
 | |
|        * is not currently need_compute_expand.
 | |
|        */
 | |
| 
 | |
|       parent = parent->priv->parent;
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /* recomputing expand always requires
 | |
|    * a relayout as well
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   if (changed_anything)
 | |
|     gtk_widget_queue_resize (widget);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_compute_expand:
 | |
|  * @widget: the widget
 | |
|  * @orientation: expand direction
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Computes whether a container should give this widget extra space
 | |
|  * when possible. Containers should check this, rather than
 | |
|  * looking at gtk_widget_get_hexpand() or gtk_widget_get_vexpand().
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * This function already checks whether the widget is visible, so
 | |
|  * visibility does not need to be checked separately. Non-visible
 | |
|  * widgets are not expanded.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * The computed expand value uses either the expand setting explicitly
 | |
|  * set on the widget itself, or, if none has been explicitly set,
 | |
|  * the widget may expand if some of its children do.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: whether widget tree rooted here should be expanded
 | |
|  */
 | |
| gboolean
 | |
| gtk_widget_compute_expand (GtkWidget     *widget,
 | |
|                            GtkOrientation orientation)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /* We never make a widget expand if not even showing. */
 | |
|   if (!gtk_widget_get_visible (widget))
 | |
|     return FALSE;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gtk_widget_update_computed_expand (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (orientation == GTK_ORIENTATION_HORIZONTAL)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       return widget->priv->computed_hexpand;
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   else
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       return widget->priv->computed_vexpand;
 | |
|     }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_set_expand (GtkWidget     *widget,
 | |
|                        GtkOrientation orientation,
 | |
|                        gboolean       expand)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   const char *expand_prop;
 | |
|   const char *expand_set_prop;
 | |
|   gboolean was_both;
 | |
|   GtkWidgetPrivate *priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   priv = widget->priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   expand = expand != FALSE;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   was_both = priv->hexpand && priv->vexpand;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (orientation == GTK_ORIENTATION_HORIZONTAL)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       if (priv->hexpand_set &&
 | |
|           priv->hexpand == expand)
 | |
|         return;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       priv->hexpand_set = TRUE;
 | |
|       priv->hexpand = expand;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       expand_prop = "hexpand";
 | |
|       expand_set_prop = "hexpand-set";
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   else
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       if (priv->vexpand_set &&
 | |
|           priv->vexpand == expand)
 | |
|         return;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       priv->vexpand_set = TRUE;
 | |
|       priv->vexpand = expand;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       expand_prop = "vexpand";
 | |
|       expand_set_prop = "vexpand-set";
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gtk_widget_queue_compute_expand (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_object_freeze_notify (G_OBJECT (widget));
 | |
|   g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), expand_prop);
 | |
|   g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), expand_set_prop);
 | |
|   if (was_both != (priv->hexpand && priv->vexpand))
 | |
|     g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), "expand");
 | |
|   g_object_thaw_notify (G_OBJECT (widget));
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_set_expand_set (GtkWidget      *widget,
 | |
|                            GtkOrientation  orientation,
 | |
|                            gboolean        set)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetPrivate *priv;
 | |
|   const char *prop;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   priv = widget->priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   set = set != FALSE;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (orientation == GTK_ORIENTATION_HORIZONTAL)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       if (set == priv->hexpand_set)
 | |
|         return;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       priv->hexpand_set = set;
 | |
|       prop = "hexpand-set";
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   else
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       if (set == priv->vexpand_set)
 | |
|         return;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       priv->vexpand_set = set;
 | |
|       prop = "vexpand-set";
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gtk_widget_queue_compute_expand (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), prop);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_hexpand:
 | |
|  * @widget: the widget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Gets whether the widget would like any available extra horizontal
 | |
|  * space. When a user resizes a #GtkWindow, widgets with expand=TRUE
 | |
|  * generally receive the extra space. For example, a list or
 | |
|  * scrollable area or document in your window would often be set to
 | |
|  * expand.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Containers should use gtk_widget_compute_expand() rather than
 | |
|  * this function, to see whether a widget, or any of its children,
 | |
|  * has the expand flag set. If any child of a widget wants to
 | |
|  * expand, the parent may ask to expand also.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * This function only looks at the widget's own hexpand flag, rather
 | |
|  * than computing whether the entire widget tree rooted at this widget
 | |
|  * wants to expand.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: whether hexpand flag is set
 | |
|  */
 | |
| gboolean
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_hexpand (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return widget->priv->hexpand;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_set_hexpand:
 | |
|  * @widget: the widget
 | |
|  * @expand: whether to expand
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Sets whether the widget would like any available extra horizontal
 | |
|  * space. When a user resizes a #GtkWindow, widgets with expand=TRUE
 | |
|  * generally receive the extra space. For example, a list or
 | |
|  * scrollable area or document in your window would often be set to
 | |
|  * expand.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Call this function to set the expand flag if you would like your
 | |
|  * widget to become larger horizontally when the window has extra
 | |
|  * room.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * By default, widgets automatically expand if any of their children
 | |
|  * want to expand. (To see if a widget will automatically expand given
 | |
|  * its current children and state, call gtk_widget_compute_expand(). A
 | |
|  * container can decide how the expandability of children affects the
 | |
|  * expansion of the container by overriding the compute_expand virtual
 | |
|  * method on #GtkWidget.).
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Setting hexpand explicitly with this function will override the
 | |
|  * automatic expand behavior.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * This function forces the widget to expand or not to expand,
 | |
|  * regardless of children.  The override occurs because
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_set_hexpand() sets the hexpand-set property (see
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_set_hexpand_set()) which causes the widget's hexpand
 | |
|  * value to be used, rather than looking at children and widget state.
 | |
|  */
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_set_hexpand (GtkWidget      *widget,
 | |
|                         gboolean        expand)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gtk_widget_set_expand (widget, GTK_ORIENTATION_HORIZONTAL, expand);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_hexpand_set:
 | |
|  * @widget: the widget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Gets whether gtk_widget_set_hexpand() has been used to
 | |
|  * explicitly set the expand flag on this widget.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * If hexpand is set, then it overrides any computed
 | |
|  * expand value based on child widgets. If hexpand is not
 | |
|  * set, then the expand value depends on whether any
 | |
|  * children of the widget would like to expand.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * There are few reasons to use this function, but it's here
 | |
|  * for completeness and consistency.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: whether hexpand has been explicitly set
 | |
|  */
 | |
| gboolean
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_hexpand_set (GtkWidget      *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return widget->priv->hexpand_set;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_set_hexpand_set:
 | |
|  * @widget: the widget
 | |
|  * @set: value for hexpand-set property
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Sets whether the hexpand flag (see gtk_widget_get_hexpand()) will
 | |
|  * be used.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * The hexpand-set property will be set automatically when you call
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_set_hexpand() to set hexpand, so the most likely
 | |
|  * reason to use this function would be to unset an explicit expand
 | |
|  * flag.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * If hexpand is set, then it overrides any computed
 | |
|  * expand value based on child widgets. If hexpand is not
 | |
|  * set, then the expand value depends on whether any
 | |
|  * children of the widget would like to expand.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * There are few reasons to use this function, but it's here
 | |
|  * for completeness and consistency.
 | |
|  */
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_set_hexpand_set (GtkWidget      *widget,
 | |
|                             gboolean        set)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gtk_widget_set_expand_set (widget, GTK_ORIENTATION_HORIZONTAL, set);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_vexpand:
 | |
|  * @widget: the widget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Gets whether the widget would like any available extra vertical
 | |
|  * space.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * See gtk_widget_get_hexpand() for more detail.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: whether vexpand flag is set
 | |
|  */
 | |
| gboolean
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_vexpand (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return widget->priv->vexpand;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_set_vexpand:
 | |
|  * @widget: the widget
 | |
|  * @expand: whether to expand
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Sets whether the widget would like any available extra vertical
 | |
|  * space.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * See gtk_widget_set_hexpand() for more detail.
 | |
|  */
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_set_vexpand (GtkWidget      *widget,
 | |
|                         gboolean        expand)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gtk_widget_set_expand (widget, GTK_ORIENTATION_VERTICAL, expand);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_vexpand_set:
 | |
|  * @widget: the widget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Gets whether gtk_widget_set_vexpand() has been used to
 | |
|  * explicitly set the expand flag on this widget.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * See gtk_widget_get_hexpand_set() for more detail.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: whether vexpand has been explicitly set
 | |
|  */
 | |
| gboolean
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_vexpand_set (GtkWidget      *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return widget->priv->vexpand_set;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_set_vexpand_set:
 | |
|  * @widget: the widget
 | |
|  * @set: value for vexpand-set property
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Sets whether the vexpand flag (see gtk_widget_get_vexpand()) will
 | |
|  * be used.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * See gtk_widget_set_hexpand_set() for more detail.
 | |
|  */
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_set_vexpand_set (GtkWidget      *widget,
 | |
|                             gboolean        set)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gtk_widget_set_expand_set (widget, GTK_ORIENTATION_VERTICAL, set);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /*
 | |
|  * GtkBuildable implementation
 | |
|  */
 | |
| static GQuark		 quark_builder_has_default = 0;
 | |
| static GQuark		 quark_builder_has_focus = 0;
 | |
| static GQuark		 quark_builder_atk_relations = 0;
 | |
| static GQuark            quark_builder_set_name = 0;
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_buildable_interface_init (GtkBuildableIface *iface)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   quark_builder_has_default = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-builder-has-default");
 | |
|   quark_builder_has_focus = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-builder-has-focus");
 | |
|   quark_builder_atk_relations = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-builder-atk-relations");
 | |
|   quark_builder_set_name = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-builder-set-name");
 | |
| 
 | |
|   iface->set_name = gtk_widget_buildable_set_name;
 | |
|   iface->get_name = gtk_widget_buildable_get_name;
 | |
|   iface->get_internal_child = gtk_widget_buildable_get_internal_child;
 | |
|   iface->set_buildable_property = gtk_widget_buildable_set_buildable_property;
 | |
|   iface->parser_finished = gtk_widget_buildable_parser_finished;
 | |
|   iface->custom_tag_start = gtk_widget_buildable_custom_tag_start;
 | |
|   iface->custom_finished = gtk_widget_buildable_custom_finished;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_buildable_set_name (GtkBuildable *buildable,
 | |
| 			       const gchar  *name)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (buildable), quark_builder_set_name,
 | |
|                            g_strdup (name), g_free);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static const gchar *
 | |
| gtk_widget_buildable_get_name (GtkBuildable *buildable)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   return g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (buildable), quark_builder_set_name);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static GObject *
 | |
| gtk_widget_buildable_get_internal_child (GtkBuildable *buildable,
 | |
| 					 GtkBuilder   *builder,
 | |
| 					 const gchar  *childname)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   if (strcmp (childname, "accessible") == 0)
 | |
|     return G_OBJECT (gtk_widget_get_accessible (GTK_WIDGET (buildable)));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return NULL;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_buildable_set_buildable_property (GtkBuildable *buildable,
 | |
| 					     GtkBuilder   *builder,
 | |
| 					     const gchar  *name,
 | |
| 					     const GValue *value)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   if (strcmp (name, "has-default") == 0 && g_value_get_boolean (value))
 | |
|       g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (buildable), quark_builder_has_default,
 | |
| 			  GINT_TO_POINTER (TRUE));
 | |
|   else if (strcmp (name, "has-focus") == 0 && g_value_get_boolean (value))
 | |
|       g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (buildable), quark_builder_has_focus,
 | |
| 			  GINT_TO_POINTER (TRUE));
 | |
|   else
 | |
|     g_object_set_property (G_OBJECT (buildable), name, value);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| typedef struct
 | |
| {
 | |
|   gchar *action_name;
 | |
|   GString *description;
 | |
|   gchar *context;
 | |
|   gboolean translatable;
 | |
| } AtkActionData;
 | |
| 
 | |
| typedef struct
 | |
| {
 | |
|   gchar *target;
 | |
|   gchar *type;
 | |
| } AtkRelationData;
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| free_action (AtkActionData *data, gpointer user_data)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_free (data->action_name);
 | |
|   g_string_free (data->description, TRUE);
 | |
|   g_free (data->context);
 | |
|   g_slice_free (AtkActionData, data);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| free_relation (AtkRelationData *data, gpointer user_data)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_free (data->target);
 | |
|   g_free (data->type);
 | |
|   g_slice_free (AtkRelationData, data);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_buildable_parser_finished (GtkBuildable *buildable,
 | |
| 				      GtkBuilder   *builder)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GSList *atk_relations;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (buildable), quark_builder_has_default))
 | |
|     gtk_widget_grab_default (GTK_WIDGET (buildable));
 | |
|   if (g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (buildable), quark_builder_has_focus))
 | |
|     gtk_widget_grab_focus (GTK_WIDGET (buildable));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   atk_relations = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (buildable),
 | |
| 				      quark_builder_atk_relations);
 | |
|   if (atk_relations)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       AtkObject *accessible;
 | |
|       AtkRelationSet *relation_set;
 | |
|       GSList *l;
 | |
|       GObject *target;
 | |
|       AtkRelationType relation_type;
 | |
|       AtkObject *target_accessible;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       accessible = gtk_widget_get_accessible (GTK_WIDGET (buildable));
 | |
|       relation_set = atk_object_ref_relation_set (accessible);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       for (l = atk_relations; l; l = l->next)
 | |
| 	{
 | |
| 	  AtkRelationData *relation = (AtkRelationData*)l->data;
 | |
| 
 | |
| 	  target = gtk_builder_get_object (builder, relation->target);
 | |
| 	  if (!target)
 | |
| 	    {
 | |
| 	      g_warning ("Target object %s in <relation> does not exist",
 | |
| 			 relation->target);
 | |
| 	      continue;
 | |
| 	    }
 | |
| 	  target_accessible = gtk_widget_get_accessible (GTK_WIDGET (target));
 | |
| 	  g_assert (target_accessible != NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
| 	  relation_type = atk_relation_type_for_name (relation->type);
 | |
| 	  if (relation_type == ATK_RELATION_NULL)
 | |
| 	    {
 | |
| 	      g_warning ("<relation> type %s not found",
 | |
| 			 relation->type);
 | |
| 	      continue;
 | |
| 	    }
 | |
| 	  atk_relation_set_add_relation_by_type (relation_set, relation_type,
 | |
| 						 target_accessible);
 | |
| 	}
 | |
|       g_object_unref (relation_set);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       g_slist_foreach (atk_relations, (GFunc)free_relation, NULL);
 | |
|       g_slist_free (atk_relations);
 | |
|       g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (buildable), quark_builder_atk_relations,
 | |
| 			  NULL);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| typedef struct
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GSList *actions;
 | |
|   GSList *relations;
 | |
| } AccessibilitySubParserData;
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| accessibility_start_element (GMarkupParseContext  *context,
 | |
| 			     const gchar          *element_name,
 | |
| 			     const gchar         **names,
 | |
| 			     const gchar         **values,
 | |
| 			     gpointer              user_data,
 | |
| 			     GError              **error)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   AccessibilitySubParserData *data = (AccessibilitySubParserData*)user_data;
 | |
|   guint i;
 | |
|   gint line_number, char_number;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (strcmp (element_name, "relation") == 0)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       gchar *target = NULL;
 | |
|       gchar *type = NULL;
 | |
|       AtkRelationData *relation;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       for (i = 0; names[i]; i++)
 | |
| 	{
 | |
| 	  if (strcmp (names[i], "target") == 0)
 | |
| 	    target = g_strdup (values[i]);
 | |
| 	  else if (strcmp (names[i], "type") == 0)
 | |
| 	    type = g_strdup (values[i]);
 | |
| 	  else
 | |
| 	    {
 | |
| 	      g_markup_parse_context_get_position (context,
 | |
| 						   &line_number,
 | |
| 						   &char_number);
 | |
| 	      g_set_error (error,
 | |
| 			   GTK_BUILDER_ERROR,
 | |
| 			   GTK_BUILDER_ERROR_INVALID_ATTRIBUTE,
 | |
| 			   "%s:%d:%d '%s' is not a valid attribute of <%s>",
 | |
| 			   "<input>",
 | |
| 			   line_number, char_number, names[i], "relation");
 | |
| 	      g_free (target);
 | |
| 	      g_free (type);
 | |
| 	      return;
 | |
| 	    }
 | |
| 	}
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (!target || !type)
 | |
| 	{
 | |
| 	  g_markup_parse_context_get_position (context,
 | |
| 					       &line_number,
 | |
| 					       &char_number);
 | |
| 	  g_set_error (error,
 | |
| 		       GTK_BUILDER_ERROR,
 | |
| 		       GTK_BUILDER_ERROR_MISSING_ATTRIBUTE,
 | |
| 		       "%s:%d:%d <%s> requires attribute \"%s\"",
 | |
| 		       "<input>",
 | |
| 		       line_number, char_number, "relation",
 | |
| 		       type ? "target" : "type");
 | |
| 	  g_free (target);
 | |
| 	  g_free (type);
 | |
| 	  return;
 | |
| 	}
 | |
| 
 | |
|       relation = g_slice_new (AtkRelationData);
 | |
|       relation->target = target;
 | |
|       relation->type = type;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       data->relations = g_slist_prepend (data->relations, relation);
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   else if (strcmp (element_name, "action") == 0)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       const gchar *action_name = NULL;
 | |
|       const gchar *description = NULL;
 | |
|       const gchar *msg_context = NULL;
 | |
|       gboolean translatable = FALSE;
 | |
|       AtkActionData *action;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       for (i = 0; names[i]; i++)
 | |
| 	{
 | |
| 	  if (strcmp (names[i], "action_name") == 0)
 | |
| 	    action_name = values[i];
 | |
| 	  else if (strcmp (names[i], "description") == 0)
 | |
| 	    description = values[i];
 | |
|           else if (strcmp (names[i], "translatable") == 0)
 | |
|             {
 | |
|               if (!_gtk_builder_boolean_from_string (values[i], &translatable, error))
 | |
|                 return;
 | |
|             }
 | |
|           else if (strcmp (names[i], "comments") == 0)
 | |
|             {
 | |
|               /* do nothing, comments are for translators */
 | |
|             }
 | |
|           else if (strcmp (names[i], "context") == 0)
 | |
|             msg_context = values[i];
 | |
| 	  else
 | |
| 	    {
 | |
| 	      g_markup_parse_context_get_position (context,
 | |
| 						   &line_number,
 | |
| 						   &char_number);
 | |
| 	      g_set_error (error,
 | |
| 			   GTK_BUILDER_ERROR,
 | |
| 			   GTK_BUILDER_ERROR_INVALID_ATTRIBUTE,
 | |
| 			   "%s:%d:%d '%s' is not a valid attribute of <%s>",
 | |
| 			   "<input>",
 | |
| 			   line_number, char_number, names[i], "action");
 | |
| 	      return;
 | |
| 	    }
 | |
| 	}
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (!action_name)
 | |
| 	{
 | |
| 	  g_markup_parse_context_get_position (context,
 | |
| 					       &line_number,
 | |
| 					       &char_number);
 | |
| 	  g_set_error (error,
 | |
| 		       GTK_BUILDER_ERROR,
 | |
| 		       GTK_BUILDER_ERROR_MISSING_ATTRIBUTE,
 | |
| 		       "%s:%d:%d <%s> requires attribute \"%s\"",
 | |
| 		       "<input>",
 | |
| 		       line_number, char_number, "action",
 | |
| 		       "action_name");
 | |
| 	  return;
 | |
| 	}
 | |
| 
 | |
|       action = g_slice_new (AtkActionData);
 | |
|       action->action_name = g_strdup (action_name);
 | |
|       action->description = g_string_new (description);
 | |
|       action->context = g_strdup (msg_context);
 | |
|       action->translatable = translatable;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       data->actions = g_slist_prepend (data->actions, action);
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   else if (strcmp (element_name, "accessibility") == 0)
 | |
|     ;
 | |
|   else
 | |
|     g_warning ("Unsupported tag for GtkWidget: %s\n", element_name);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| accessibility_text (GMarkupParseContext  *context,
 | |
|                     const gchar          *text,
 | |
|                     gsize                 text_len,
 | |
|                     gpointer              user_data,
 | |
|                     GError              **error)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   AccessibilitySubParserData *data = (AccessibilitySubParserData*)user_data;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (strcmp (g_markup_parse_context_get_element (context), "action") == 0)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       AtkActionData *action = data->actions->data;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       g_string_append_len (action->description, text, text_len);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static const GMarkupParser accessibility_parser =
 | |
|   {
 | |
|     accessibility_start_element,
 | |
|     NULL,
 | |
|     accessibility_text,
 | |
|   };
 | |
| 
 | |
| typedef struct
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GObject *object;
 | |
|   guint    key;
 | |
|   guint    modifiers;
 | |
|   gchar   *signal;
 | |
| } AccelGroupParserData;
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| accel_group_start_element (GMarkupParseContext  *context,
 | |
| 			   const gchar          *element_name,
 | |
| 			   const gchar         **names,
 | |
| 			   const gchar         **values,
 | |
| 			   gpointer              user_data,
 | |
| 			   GError              **error)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   gint i;
 | |
|   guint key = 0;
 | |
|   guint modifiers = 0;
 | |
|   gchar *signal = NULL;
 | |
|   AccelGroupParserData *parser_data = (AccelGroupParserData*)user_data;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   for (i = 0; names[i]; i++)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       if (strcmp (names[i], "key") == 0)
 | |
| 	key = gdk_keyval_from_name (values[i]);
 | |
|       else if (strcmp (names[i], "modifiers") == 0)
 | |
| 	{
 | |
| 	  if (!_gtk_builder_flags_from_string (GDK_TYPE_MODIFIER_TYPE,
 | |
| 					       values[i],
 | |
| 					       &modifiers,
 | |
| 					       error))
 | |
| 	      return;
 | |
| 	}
 | |
|       else if (strcmp (names[i], "signal") == 0)
 | |
| 	signal = g_strdup (values[i]);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (key == 0 || signal == NULL)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       g_warning ("<accelerator> requires key and signal attributes");
 | |
|       return;
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   parser_data->key = key;
 | |
|   parser_data->modifiers = modifiers;
 | |
|   parser_data->signal = signal;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static const GMarkupParser accel_group_parser =
 | |
|   {
 | |
|     accel_group_start_element,
 | |
|   };
 | |
| 
 | |
| typedef struct
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GSList *classes;
 | |
| } StyleParserData;
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| style_start_element (GMarkupParseContext  *context,
 | |
|                      const gchar          *element_name,
 | |
|                      const gchar         **names,
 | |
|                      const gchar         **values,
 | |
|                      gpointer              user_data,
 | |
|                      GError              **error)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   StyleParserData *style_data = (StyleParserData *)user_data;
 | |
|   gchar *class_name;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (strcmp (element_name, "class") == 0)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       if (g_markup_collect_attributes (element_name,
 | |
|                                        names,
 | |
|                                        values,
 | |
|                                        error,
 | |
|                                        G_MARKUP_COLLECT_STRDUP, "name", &class_name,
 | |
|                                        G_MARKUP_COLLECT_INVALID))
 | |
|         {
 | |
|           style_data->classes = g_slist_append (style_data->classes, class_name);
 | |
|         }
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   else if (strcmp (element_name, "style") == 0)
 | |
|     ;
 | |
|   else
 | |
|     g_warning ("Unsupported tag for GtkWidget: %s\n", element_name);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static const GMarkupParser style_parser =
 | |
|   {
 | |
|     style_start_element,
 | |
|   };
 | |
| 
 | |
| static gboolean
 | |
| gtk_widget_buildable_custom_tag_start (GtkBuildable     *buildable,
 | |
| 				       GtkBuilder       *builder,
 | |
| 				       GObject          *child,
 | |
| 				       const gchar      *tagname,
 | |
| 				       GMarkupParser    *parser,
 | |
| 				       gpointer         *data)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_assert (buildable);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (strcmp (tagname, "accelerator") == 0)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       AccelGroupParserData *parser_data;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       parser_data = g_slice_new0 (AccelGroupParserData);
 | |
|       parser_data->object = g_object_ref (buildable);
 | |
|       *parser = accel_group_parser;
 | |
|       *data = parser_data;
 | |
|       return TRUE;
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   if (strcmp (tagname, "accessibility") == 0)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       AccessibilitySubParserData *parser_data;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       parser_data = g_slice_new0 (AccessibilitySubParserData);
 | |
|       *parser = accessibility_parser;
 | |
|       *data = parser_data;
 | |
|       return TRUE;
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   if (strcmp (tagname, "style") == 0)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       StyleParserData *parser_data;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       parser_data = g_slice_new0 (StyleParserData);
 | |
|       *parser = style_parser;
 | |
|       *data = parser_data;
 | |
|       return TRUE;
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return FALSE;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void
 | |
| _gtk_widget_buildable_finish_accelerator (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
| 					  GtkWidget *toplevel,
 | |
| 					  gpointer   user_data)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   AccelGroupParserData *accel_data;
 | |
|   GSList *accel_groups;
 | |
|   GtkAccelGroup *accel_group;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (toplevel));
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (user_data != NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   accel_data = (AccelGroupParserData*)user_data;
 | |
|   accel_groups = gtk_accel_groups_from_object (G_OBJECT (toplevel));
 | |
|   if (g_slist_length (accel_groups) == 0)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       accel_group = gtk_accel_group_new ();
 | |
|       gtk_window_add_accel_group (GTK_WINDOW (toplevel), accel_group);
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   else
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       g_assert (g_slist_length (accel_groups) == 1);
 | |
|       accel_group = g_slist_nth_data (accel_groups, 0);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gtk_widget_add_accelerator (GTK_WIDGET (accel_data->object),
 | |
| 			      accel_data->signal,
 | |
| 			      accel_group,
 | |
| 			      accel_data->key,
 | |
| 			      accel_data->modifiers,
 | |
| 			      GTK_ACCEL_VISIBLE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_object_unref (accel_data->object);
 | |
|   g_free (accel_data->signal);
 | |
|   g_slice_free (AccelGroupParserData, accel_data);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_buildable_custom_finished (GtkBuildable *buildable,
 | |
| 				      GtkBuilder   *builder,
 | |
| 				      GObject      *child,
 | |
| 				      const gchar  *tagname,
 | |
| 				      gpointer      user_data)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   if (strcmp (tagname, "accelerator") == 0)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       AccelGroupParserData *accel_data;
 | |
|       GtkWidget *toplevel;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       accel_data = (AccelGroupParserData*)user_data;
 | |
|       g_assert (accel_data->object);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       toplevel = gtk_widget_get_toplevel (GTK_WIDGET (accel_data->object));
 | |
| 
 | |
|       _gtk_widget_buildable_finish_accelerator (GTK_WIDGET (buildable), toplevel, user_data);
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   else if (strcmp (tagname, "accessibility") == 0)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       AccessibilitySubParserData *a11y_data;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       a11y_data = (AccessibilitySubParserData*)user_data;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (a11y_data->actions)
 | |
| 	{
 | |
| 	  AtkObject *accessible;
 | |
| 	  AtkAction *action;
 | |
| 	  gint i, n_actions;
 | |
| 	  GSList *l;
 | |
| 
 | |
| 	  accessible = gtk_widget_get_accessible (GTK_WIDGET (buildable));
 | |
| 
 | |
|           if (ATK_IS_ACTION (accessible))
 | |
|             {
 | |
| 	      action = ATK_ACTION (accessible);
 | |
| 	      n_actions = atk_action_get_n_actions (action);
 | |
| 
 | |
| 	      for (l = a11y_data->actions; l; l = l->next)
 | |
| 	        {
 | |
| 	          AtkActionData *action_data = (AtkActionData*)l->data;
 | |
| 
 | |
| 	          for (i = 0; i < n_actions; i++)
 | |
| 		    if (strcmp (atk_action_get_name (action, i),
 | |
| 		  	        action_data->action_name) == 0)
 | |
| 		      break;
 | |
| 
 | |
| 	          if (i < n_actions)
 | |
|                     {
 | |
|                       gchar *description;
 | |
| 
 | |
|                       if (action_data->translatable && action_data->description->len)
 | |
|                         description = _gtk_builder_parser_translate (gtk_builder_get_translation_domain (builder),
 | |
|                                                                      action_data->context,
 | |
|                                                                      action_data->description->str);
 | |
|                       else
 | |
|                         description = action_data->description->str;
 | |
| 
 | |
| 		      atk_action_set_description (action, i, description);
 | |
|                     }
 | |
|                 }
 | |
| 	    }
 | |
|           else
 | |
|             g_warning ("accessibility action on a widget that does not implement AtkAction");
 | |
| 
 | |
| 	  g_slist_foreach (a11y_data->actions, (GFunc)free_action, NULL);
 | |
| 	  g_slist_free (a11y_data->actions);
 | |
| 	}
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (a11y_data->relations)
 | |
| 	g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (buildable), quark_builder_atk_relations,
 | |
| 			    a11y_data->relations);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       g_slice_free (AccessibilitySubParserData, a11y_data);
 | |
|     }
 | |
|   else if (strcmp (tagname, "style") == 0)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       StyleParserData *style_data = (StyleParserData *)user_data;
 | |
|       GtkStyleContext *context;
 | |
|       GSList *l;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       context = gtk_widget_get_style_context (GTK_WIDGET (buildable));
 | |
| 
 | |
|       for (l = style_data->classes; l; l = l->next)
 | |
|         gtk_style_context_add_class (context, (const gchar *)l->data);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       gtk_widget_reset_style (GTK_WIDGET (buildable));
 | |
| 
 | |
|       g_slist_free_full (style_data->classes, g_free);
 | |
|       g_slice_free (StyleParserData, style_data);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static GtkSizeRequestMode 
 | |
| gtk_widget_real_get_request_mode (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| { 
 | |
|   /* By default widgets dont trade size at all. */
 | |
|   return GTK_SIZE_REQUEST_CONSTANT_SIZE;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_real_get_width (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
| 			   gint      *minimum_size,
 | |
| 			   gint      *natural_size)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   if (minimum_size)
 | |
|     *minimum_size = 0;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (natural_size)
 | |
|     *natural_size = 0;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_real_get_height (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
| 			    gint      *minimum_size,
 | |
| 			    gint      *natural_size)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   if (minimum_size)
 | |
|     *minimum_size = 0;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (natural_size)
 | |
|     *natural_size = 0;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_real_get_height_for_width (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                                       gint       width,
 | |
|                                       gint      *minimum_height,
 | |
|                                       gint      *natural_height)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget)->get_preferred_height (widget, minimum_height, natural_height);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_real_get_width_for_height (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                                       gint       height,
 | |
|                                       gint      *minimum_width,
 | |
|                                       gint      *natural_width)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget)->get_preferred_width (widget, minimum_width, natural_width);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_halign:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Gets the value of the #GtkWidget:halign property.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns: the horizontal alignment of @widget
 | |
|  */
 | |
| GtkAlign
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_halign (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), GTK_ALIGN_FILL);
 | |
|   return _gtk_widget_get_aux_info_or_defaults (widget)->halign;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_set_halign:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @align: the horizontal alignment
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Sets the horizontal alignment of @widget.
 | |
|  * See the #GtkWidget:halign property.
 | |
|  */
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_set_halign (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                        GtkAlign   align)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetAuxInfo *aux_info;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   aux_info = gtk_widget_get_aux_info (widget, TRUE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (aux_info->halign == align)
 | |
|     return;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   aux_info->halign = align;
 | |
|   gtk_widget_queue_resize (widget);
 | |
|   g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), "halign");
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_valign:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Gets the value of the #GtkWidget:valign property.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns: the vertical alignment of @widget
 | |
|  */
 | |
| GtkAlign
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_valign (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), GTK_ALIGN_FILL);
 | |
|   return _gtk_widget_get_aux_info_or_defaults (widget)->valign;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_set_valign:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @align: the vertical alignment
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Sets the vertical alignment of @widget.
 | |
|  * See the #GtkWidget:valign property.
 | |
|  */
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_set_valign (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                        GtkAlign   align)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetAuxInfo *aux_info;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   aux_info = gtk_widget_get_aux_info (widget, TRUE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (aux_info->valign == align)
 | |
|     return;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   aux_info->valign = align;
 | |
|   gtk_widget_queue_resize (widget);
 | |
|   g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), "valign");
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_margin_left:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Gets the value of the #GtkWidget:margin-left property.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns: The left margin of @widget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 3.0
 | |
|  */
 | |
| gint
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_margin_left (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), 0);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return _gtk_widget_get_aux_info_or_defaults (widget)->margin.left;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_set_margin_left:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @margin: the left margin
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Sets the left margin of @widget.
 | |
|  * See the #GtkWidget:margin-left property.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 3.0
 | |
|  */
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_set_margin_left (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                             gint       margin)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetAuxInfo *aux_info;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (margin <= G_MAXINT16);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   aux_info = gtk_widget_get_aux_info (widget, TRUE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (aux_info->margin.left == margin)
 | |
|     return;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   aux_info->margin.left = margin;
 | |
|   gtk_widget_queue_resize (widget);
 | |
|   g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), "margin-left");
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_margin_right:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Gets the value of the #GtkWidget:margin-right property.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns: The right margin of @widget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 3.0
 | |
|  */
 | |
| gint
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_margin_right (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), 0);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return _gtk_widget_get_aux_info_or_defaults (widget)->margin.right;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_set_margin_right:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @margin: the right margin
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Sets the right margin of @widget.
 | |
|  * See the #GtkWidget:margin-right property.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 3.0
 | |
|  */
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_set_margin_right (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                              gint       margin)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetAuxInfo *aux_info;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (margin <= G_MAXINT16);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   aux_info = gtk_widget_get_aux_info (widget, TRUE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (aux_info->margin.right == margin)
 | |
|     return;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   aux_info->margin.right = margin;
 | |
|   gtk_widget_queue_resize (widget);
 | |
|   g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), "margin-right");
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_margin_top:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Gets the value of the #GtkWidget:margin-top property.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns: The top margin of @widget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 3.0
 | |
|  */
 | |
| gint
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_margin_top (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), 0);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return _gtk_widget_get_aux_info_or_defaults (widget)->margin.top;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_set_margin_top:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @margin: the top margin
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Sets the top margin of @widget.
 | |
|  * See the #GtkWidget:margin-top property.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 3.0
 | |
|  */
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_set_margin_top (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                            gint       margin)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetAuxInfo *aux_info;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (margin <= G_MAXINT16);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   aux_info = gtk_widget_get_aux_info (widget, TRUE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (aux_info->margin.top == margin)
 | |
|     return;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   aux_info->margin.top = margin;
 | |
|   gtk_widget_queue_resize (widget);
 | |
|   g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), "margin-top");
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_margin_bottom:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Gets the value of the #GtkWidget:margin-bottom property.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns: The bottom margin of @widget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 3.0
 | |
|  */
 | |
| gint
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_margin_bottom (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), 0);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return _gtk_widget_get_aux_info_or_defaults (widget)->margin.bottom;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_set_margin_bottom:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @margin: the bottom margin
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Sets the bottom margin of @widget.
 | |
|  * See the #GtkWidget:margin-bottom property.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 3.0
 | |
|  */
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_set_margin_bottom (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                               gint       margin)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetAuxInfo *aux_info;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (margin <= G_MAXINT16);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   aux_info = gtk_widget_get_aux_info (widget, TRUE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (aux_info->margin.bottom == margin)
 | |
|     return;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   aux_info->margin.bottom = margin;
 | |
|   gtk_widget_queue_resize (widget);
 | |
|   g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), "margin-bottom");
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_clipboard:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @selection: a #GdkAtom which identifies the clipboard
 | |
|  *             to use. %GDK_SELECTION_CLIPBOARD gives the
 | |
|  *             default clipboard. Another common value
 | |
|  *             is %GDK_SELECTION_PRIMARY, which gives
 | |
|  *             the primary X selection.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns the clipboard object for the given selection to
 | |
|  * be used with @widget. @widget must have a #GdkDisplay
 | |
|  * associated with it, so must be attached to a toplevel
 | |
|  * window.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: (transfer none): the appropriate clipboard object. If no
 | |
|  *             clipboard already exists, a new one will
 | |
|  *             be created. Once a clipboard object has
 | |
|  *             been created, it is persistent for all time.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.2
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| GtkClipboard *
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_clipboard (GtkWidget *widget, GdkAtom selection)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL);
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (gtk_widget_has_screen (widget), NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return gtk_clipboard_get_for_display (gtk_widget_get_display (widget),
 | |
| 					selection);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_list_mnemonic_labels:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns a newly allocated list of the widgets, normally labels, for
 | |
|  * which this widget is the target of a mnemonic (see for example,
 | |
|  * gtk_label_set_mnemonic_widget()).
 | |
| 
 | |
|  * The widgets in the list are not individually referenced. If you
 | |
|  * want to iterate through the list and perform actions involving
 | |
|  * callbacks that might destroy the widgets, you
 | |
|  * <emphasis>must</emphasis> call <literal>g_list_foreach (result,
 | |
|  * (GFunc)g_object_ref, NULL)</literal> first, and then unref all the
 | |
|  * widgets afterwards.
 | |
| 
 | |
|  * Return value: (element-type GtkWidget) (transfer container): the list of
 | |
|  *  mnemonic labels; free this list
 | |
|  *  with g_list_free() when you are done with it.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.4
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| GList *
 | |
| gtk_widget_list_mnemonic_labels (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GList *list = NULL;
 | |
|   GSList *l;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   for (l = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_mnemonic_labels); l; l = l->next)
 | |
|     list = g_list_prepend (list, l->data);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return list;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_add_mnemonic_label:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @label: a #GtkWidget that acts as a mnemonic label for @widget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Adds a widget to the list of mnemonic labels for
 | |
|  * this widget. (See gtk_widget_list_mnemonic_labels()). Note the
 | |
|  * list of mnemonic labels for the widget is cleared when the
 | |
|  * widget is destroyed, so the caller must make sure to update
 | |
|  * its internal state at this point as well, by using a connection
 | |
|  * to the #GtkWidget::destroy signal or a weak notifier.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.4
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_add_mnemonic_label (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                                GtkWidget *label)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GSList *old_list, *new_list;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (label));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   old_list = g_object_steal_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_mnemonic_labels);
 | |
|   new_list = g_slist_prepend (old_list, label);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_mnemonic_labels,
 | |
| 			   new_list, (GDestroyNotify) g_slist_free);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_remove_mnemonic_label:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @label: a #GtkWidget that was previously set as a mnemnic label for
 | |
|  *         @widget with gtk_widget_add_mnemonic_label().
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Removes a widget from the list of mnemonic labels for
 | |
|  * this widget. (See gtk_widget_list_mnemonic_labels()). The widget
 | |
|  * must have previously been added to the list with
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_add_mnemonic_label().
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.4
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_remove_mnemonic_label (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                                   GtkWidget *label)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GSList *old_list, *new_list;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (label));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   old_list = g_object_steal_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_mnemonic_labels);
 | |
|   new_list = g_slist_remove (old_list, label);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (new_list)
 | |
|     g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_mnemonic_labels,
 | |
| 			     new_list, (GDestroyNotify) g_slist_free);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_no_show_all:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns the current value of the #GtkWidget:no-show-all property,
 | |
|  * which determines whether calls to gtk_widget_show_all()
 | |
|  * will affect this widget.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: the current value of the "no-show-all" property.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.4
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| gboolean
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_no_show_all (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return widget->priv->no_show_all;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_set_no_show_all:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @no_show_all: the new value for the "no-show-all" property
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Sets the #GtkWidget:no-show-all property, which determines whether
 | |
|  * calls to gtk_widget_show_all() will affect this widget.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * This is mostly for use in constructing widget hierarchies with externally
 | |
|  * controlled visibility, see #GtkUIManager.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.4
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_set_no_show_all (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
| 			    gboolean   no_show_all)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   no_show_all = (no_show_all != FALSE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (widget->priv->no_show_all != no_show_all)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       widget->priv->no_show_all = no_show_all;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), "no-show-all");
 | |
|     }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_real_set_has_tooltip (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
| 			         gboolean   has_tooltip,
 | |
| 			         gboolean   force)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv;
 | |
|   gboolean priv_has_tooltip;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   priv_has_tooltip = GPOINTER_TO_UINT (g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget),
 | |
| 				       quark_has_tooltip));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (priv_has_tooltip != has_tooltip || force)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       priv_has_tooltip = has_tooltip;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (priv_has_tooltip)
 | |
|         {
 | |
| 	  if (gtk_widget_get_realized (widget) && !gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget))
 | |
| 	    gdk_window_set_events (priv->window,
 | |
| 				   gdk_window_get_events (priv->window) |
 | |
| 				   GDK_LEAVE_NOTIFY_MASK |
 | |
| 				   GDK_POINTER_MOTION_MASK |
 | |
| 				   GDK_POINTER_MOTION_HINT_MASK);
 | |
| 
 | |
| 	  if (gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget))
 | |
| 	      gtk_widget_add_events (widget,
 | |
| 				     GDK_LEAVE_NOTIFY_MASK |
 | |
| 				     GDK_POINTER_MOTION_MASK |
 | |
| 				     GDK_POINTER_MOTION_HINT_MASK);
 | |
| 	}
 | |
| 
 | |
|       g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_has_tooltip,
 | |
| 			  GUINT_TO_POINTER (priv_has_tooltip));
 | |
|     }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_set_tooltip_window:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @custom_window: (allow-none): a #GtkWindow, or %NULL
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Replaces the default, usually yellow, window used for displaying
 | |
|  * tooltips with @custom_window. GTK+ will take care of showing and
 | |
|  * hiding @custom_window at the right moment, to behave likewise as
 | |
|  * the default tooltip window. If @custom_window is %NULL, the default
 | |
|  * tooltip window will be used.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * If the custom window should have the default theming it needs to
 | |
|  * have the name "gtk-tooltip", see gtk_widget_set_name().
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.12
 | |
|  */
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_set_tooltip_window (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
| 			       GtkWindow *custom_window)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   gboolean has_tooltip;
 | |
|   gchar *tooltip_markup;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (custom_window == NULL || GTK_IS_WINDOW (custom_window));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   tooltip_markup = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_tooltip_markup);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (custom_window)
 | |
|     g_object_ref (custom_window);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_tooltip_window,
 | |
| 			   custom_window, g_object_unref);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   has_tooltip = (custom_window != NULL || tooltip_markup != NULL);
 | |
|   gtk_widget_real_set_has_tooltip (widget, has_tooltip, FALSE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (has_tooltip && gtk_widget_get_visible (widget))
 | |
|     gtk_widget_queue_tooltip_query (widget);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_tooltip_window:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns the #GtkWindow of the current tooltip. This can be the
 | |
|  * GtkWindow created by default, or the custom tooltip window set
 | |
|  * using gtk_widget_set_tooltip_window().
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: (transfer none): The #GtkWindow of the current tooltip.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.12
 | |
|  */
 | |
| GtkWindow *
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_tooltip_window (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_tooltip_window);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_trigger_tooltip_query:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Triggers a tooltip query on the display where the toplevel of @widget
 | |
|  * is located. See gtk_tooltip_trigger_tooltip_query() for more
 | |
|  * information.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.12
 | |
|  */
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_trigger_tooltip_query (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   gtk_tooltip_trigger_tooltip_query (gtk_widget_get_display (widget));
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static guint tooltip_query_id;
 | |
| static GSList *tooltip_query_displays;
 | |
| 
 | |
| static gboolean
 | |
| tooltip_query_idle (gpointer data)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_slist_foreach (tooltip_query_displays, (GFunc)gtk_tooltip_trigger_tooltip_query, NULL);
 | |
|   g_slist_foreach (tooltip_query_displays, (GFunc)g_object_unref, NULL);
 | |
|   g_slist_free (tooltip_query_displays);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   tooltip_query_displays = NULL;
 | |
|   tooltip_query_id = 0;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return FALSE;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| gtk_widget_queue_tooltip_query (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GdkDisplay *display;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   display = gtk_widget_get_display (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (!g_slist_find (tooltip_query_displays, display))
 | |
|     tooltip_query_displays = g_slist_prepend (tooltip_query_displays, g_object_ref (display));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (tooltip_query_id == 0)
 | |
|     tooltip_query_id = gdk_threads_add_idle (tooltip_query_idle, NULL);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_set_tooltip_text:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @text: the contents of the tooltip for @widget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Sets @text as the contents of the tooltip. This function will take
 | |
|  * care of setting #GtkWidget:has-tooltip to %TRUE and of the default
 | |
|  * handler for the #GtkWidget::query-tooltip signal.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * See also the #GtkWidget:tooltip-text property and gtk_tooltip_set_text().
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.12
 | |
|  */
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_set_tooltip_text (GtkWidget   *widget,
 | |
|                              const gchar *text)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_object_set (G_OBJECT (widget), "tooltip-text", text, NULL);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_tooltip_text:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Gets the contents of the tooltip for @widget.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: the tooltip text, or %NULL. You should free the
 | |
|  *   returned string with g_free() when done.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.12
 | |
|  */
 | |
| gchar *
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_tooltip_text (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   gchar *text = NULL;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_object_get (G_OBJECT (widget), "tooltip-text", &text, NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return text;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_set_tooltip_markup:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @markup: (allow-none): the contents of the tooltip for @widget, or %NULL
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Sets @markup as the contents of the tooltip, which is marked up with
 | |
|  *  the <link linkend="PangoMarkupFormat">Pango text markup language</link>.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * This function will take care of setting #GtkWidget:has-tooltip to %TRUE
 | |
|  * and of the default handler for the #GtkWidget::query-tooltip signal.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * See also the #GtkWidget:tooltip-markup property and
 | |
|  * gtk_tooltip_set_markup().
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.12
 | |
|  */
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_set_tooltip_markup (GtkWidget   *widget,
 | |
|                                const gchar *markup)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_object_set (G_OBJECT (widget), "tooltip-markup", markup, NULL);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_tooltip_markup:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Gets the contents of the tooltip for @widget.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: the tooltip text, or %NULL. You should free the
 | |
|  *   returned string with g_free() when done.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.12
 | |
|  */
 | |
| gchar *
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_tooltip_markup (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   gchar *text = NULL;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_object_get (G_OBJECT (widget), "tooltip-markup", &text, NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return text;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_set_has_tooltip:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @has_tooltip: whether or not @widget has a tooltip.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Sets the has-tooltip property on @widget to @has_tooltip.  See
 | |
|  * #GtkWidget:has-tooltip for more information.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.12
 | |
|  */
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_set_has_tooltip (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
| 			    gboolean   has_tooltip)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_object_set (G_OBJECT (widget), "has-tooltip", has_tooltip, NULL);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_has_tooltip:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns the current value of the has-tooltip property.  See
 | |
|  * #GtkWidget:has-tooltip for more information.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: current value of has-tooltip on @widget.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.12
 | |
|  */
 | |
| gboolean
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_has_tooltip (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   gboolean has_tooltip = FALSE;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_object_get (G_OBJECT (widget), "has-tooltip", &has_tooltip, NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return has_tooltip;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_allocation:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @allocation: (out): a pointer to a #GtkAllocation to copy to
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Retrieves the widget's allocation.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Note, when implementing a #GtkContainer: a widget's allocation will
 | |
|  * be its "adjusted" allocation, that is, the widget's parent
 | |
|  * container typically calls gtk_widget_size_allocate() with an
 | |
|  * allocation, and that allocation is then adjusted (to handle margin
 | |
|  * and alignment for example) before assignment to the widget.
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_allocation() returns the adjusted allocation that
 | |
|  * was actually assigned to the widget. The adjusted allocation is
 | |
|  * guaranteed to be completely contained within the
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_size_allocate() allocation, however. So a #GtkContainer
 | |
|  * is guaranteed that its children stay inside the assigned bounds,
 | |
|  * but not that they have exactly the bounds the container assigned.
 | |
|  * There is no way to get the original allocation assigned by
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_size_allocate(), since it isn't stored; if a container
 | |
|  * implementation needs that information it will have to track it itself.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.18
 | |
|  */
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_allocation (GtkWidget     *widget,
 | |
|                            GtkAllocation *allocation)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetPrivate *priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (allocation != NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   priv = widget->priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   *allocation = priv->allocation;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_set_allocation:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @allocation: a pointer to a #GtkAllocation to copy from
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Sets the widget's allocation.  This should not be used
 | |
|  * directly, but from within a widget's size_allocate method.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * The allocation set should be the "adjusted" or actual
 | |
|  * allocation. If you're implementing a #GtkContainer, you want to use
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_size_allocate() instead of gtk_widget_set_allocation().
 | |
|  * The GtkWidgetClass::adjust_size_allocation virtual method adjusts the
 | |
|  * allocation inside gtk_widget_size_allocate() to create an adjusted
 | |
|  * allocation.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.18
 | |
|  */
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_set_allocation (GtkWidget           *widget,
 | |
|                            const GtkAllocation *allocation)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetPrivate *priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (allocation != NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   priv = widget->priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   priv->allocation = *allocation;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_allocated_width:
 | |
|  * @widget: the widget to query
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns the width that has currently been allocated to @widget.
 | |
|  * This function is intended to be used when implementing handlers
 | |
|  * for the #GtkWidget::draw function.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns: the width of the @widget
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| int
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_allocated_width (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), 0);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return widget->priv->allocation.width;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_allocated_height:
 | |
|  * @widget: the widget to query
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns the height that has currently been allocated to @widget.
 | |
|  * This function is intended to be used when implementing handlers
 | |
|  * for the #GtkWidget::draw function.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns: the height of the @widget
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| int
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_allocated_height (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), 0);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return widget->priv->allocation.height;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_requisition:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @requisition: (out): a pointer to a #GtkRequisition to copy to
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Retrieves the widget's requisition.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * This function should only be used by widget implementations in
 | |
|  * order to figure whether the widget's requisition has actually
 | |
|  * changed after some internal state change (so that they can call
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_queue_resize() instead of gtk_widget_queue_draw()).
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Normally, gtk_widget_size_request() should be used.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.20
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Deprecated: 3.0: The #GtkRequisition cache on the widget was
 | |
|  * removed, If you need to cache sizes across requests and allocations,
 | |
|  * add an explicit cache to the widget in question instead.
 | |
|  */
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_requisition (GtkWidget      *widget,
 | |
|                             GtkRequisition *requisition)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (requisition != NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   gtk_widget_get_preferred_size (widget, requisition, NULL);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_set_window:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @window: (transfer full): a #GdkWindow
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Sets a widget's window. This function should only be used in a
 | |
|  * widget's #GtkWidget::realize implementation. The %window passed is
 | |
|  * usually either new window created with gdk_window_new(), or the
 | |
|  * window of its parent widget as returned by
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_parent_window().
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Widgets must indicate whether they will create their own #GdkWindow
 | |
|  * by calling gtk_widget_set_has_window(). This is usually done in the
 | |
|  * widget's init() function.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * <note><para>This function does not add any reference to @window.</para></note>
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.18
 | |
|  */
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_set_window (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                        GdkWindow *window)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetPrivate *priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (window == NULL || GDK_IS_WINDOW (window));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   priv = widget->priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (priv->window != window)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       priv->window = window;
 | |
|       g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), "window");
 | |
|     }
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_window:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns the widget's window if it is realized, %NULL otherwise
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: (transfer none): @widget's window.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.14
 | |
|  */
 | |
| GdkWindow*
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_window (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return widget->priv->window;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_support_multidevice:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns %TRUE if @widget is multiple pointer aware. See
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_set_support_multidevice() for more information.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns: %TRUE if @widget is multidevice aware.
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| gboolean
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_support_multidevice (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return widget->priv->multidevice;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_set_support_multidevice:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @support_multidevice: %TRUE to support input from multiple devices.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Enables or disables multiple pointer awareness. If this setting is %TRUE,
 | |
|  * @widget will start receiving multiple, per device enter/leave events. Note
 | |
|  * that if custom #GdkWindow<!-- -->s are created in #GtkWidget::realize,
 | |
|  * gdk_window_set_support_multidevice() will have to be called manually on them.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 3.0
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| void
 | |
| gtk_widget_set_support_multidevice (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                                     gboolean   support_multidevice)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetPrivate *priv;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   priv = widget->priv;
 | |
|   priv->multidevice = (support_multidevice == TRUE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (gtk_widget_get_realized (widget))
 | |
|     gdk_window_set_support_multidevice (priv->window, support_multidevice);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| _gtk_widget_set_has_focus (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                            gboolean   has_focus)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   widget->priv->has_focus = has_focus;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (has_focus)
 | |
|     gtk_widget_set_state_flags (widget, GTK_STATE_FLAG_FOCUSED, FALSE);
 | |
|   else
 | |
|     gtk_widget_unset_state_flags (widget, GTK_STATE_FLAG_FOCUSED);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_send_focus_change:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @event: a #GdkEvent of type GDK_FOCUS_CHANGE
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Sends the focus change @event to @widget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * This function is not meant to be used by applications. The only time it
 | |
|  * should be used is when it is necessary for a #GtkWidget to assign focus
 | |
|  * to a widget that is semantically owned by the first widget even though
 | |
|  * it's not a direct child - for instance, a search entry in a floating
 | |
|  * window similar to the quick search in #GtkTreeView.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * An example of its usage is:
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * |[
 | |
|  *   GdkEvent *fevent = gdk_event_new (GDK_FOCUS_CHANGE);
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  *   fevent->focus_change.type = GDK_FOCUS_CHANGE;
 | |
|  *   fevent->focus_change.in = TRUE;
 | |
|  *   fevent->focus_change.window = gtk_widget_get_window (widget);
 | |
|  *   if (fevent->focus_change.window != NULL)
 | |
|  *     g_object_ref (fevent->focus_change.window);
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  *   gtk_widget_send_focus_change (widget, fevent);
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  *   gdk_event_free (event);
 | |
|  * ]|
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Return value: the return value from the event signal emission: %TRUE
 | |
|  *   if the event was handled, and %FALSE otherwise
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 2.20
 | |
|  */
 | |
| gboolean
 | |
| gtk_widget_send_focus_change (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                               GdkEvent  *event)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   gboolean res;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE);
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (event != NULL && event->type == GDK_FOCUS_CHANGE, FALSE);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_object_ref (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   _gtk_widget_set_has_focus (widget, event->focus_change.in);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   res = gtk_widget_event (widget, event);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), "has-focus");
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_object_unref (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return res;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_in_destruction:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns whether the widget is currently being destroyed.
 | |
|  * This information can sometimes be used to avoid doing
 | |
|  * unnecessary work.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns: %TRUE if @widget is being destroyed
 | |
|  */
 | |
| gboolean
 | |
| gtk_widget_in_destruction (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   return widget->priv->in_destruction;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| gboolean
 | |
| _gtk_widget_get_resize_pending (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   return widget->priv->resize_pending;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void
 | |
| _gtk_widget_set_resize_pending (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                                 gboolean   resize_pending)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   widget->priv->resize_pending = resize_pending;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| gboolean
 | |
| _gtk_widget_get_in_reparent (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   return widget->priv->in_reparent;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void
 | |
| _gtk_widget_set_in_reparent (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                              gboolean   in_reparent)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   widget->priv->in_reparent = in_reparent;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| gboolean
 | |
| _gtk_widget_get_anchored (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   return widget->priv->anchored;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void
 | |
| _gtk_widget_set_anchored (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                           gboolean   anchored)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   widget->priv->anchored = anchored;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| gboolean
 | |
| _gtk_widget_get_shadowed (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   return widget->priv->shadowed;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void
 | |
| _gtk_widget_set_shadowed (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                           gboolean   shadowed)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   widget->priv->shadowed = shadowed;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| gboolean
 | |
| _gtk_widget_get_alloc_needed (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   return widget->priv->alloc_needed;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void
 | |
| _gtk_widget_set_alloc_needed (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                               gboolean   alloc_needed)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   widget->priv->alloc_needed = alloc_needed;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| gboolean
 | |
| _gtk_widget_get_width_request_needed (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   return widget->priv->width_request_needed;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void
 | |
| _gtk_widget_set_width_request_needed (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                                       gboolean   width_request_needed)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   widget->priv->width_request_needed = width_request_needed;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| gboolean
 | |
| _gtk_widget_get_height_request_needed (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   return widget->priv->height_request_needed;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void
 | |
| _gtk_widget_set_height_request_needed (GtkWidget *widget,
 | |
|                                        gboolean   height_request_needed)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   widget->priv->height_request_needed = height_request_needed;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| gboolean
 | |
| _gtk_widget_get_sizegroup_visited (GtkWidget    *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   return widget->priv->sizegroup_visited;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void
 | |
| _gtk_widget_set_sizegroup_visited (GtkWidget    *widget,
 | |
| 				   gboolean      visited)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   widget->priv->sizegroup_visited = visited;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| gboolean
 | |
| _gtk_widget_get_sizegroup_bumping (GtkWidget    *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   return widget->priv->sizegroup_bumping;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void
 | |
| _gtk_widget_set_sizegroup_bumping (GtkWidget    *widget,
 | |
| 				   gboolean      bumping)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   widget->priv->sizegroup_bumping = bumping;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void
 | |
| _gtk_widget_add_sizegroup (GtkWidget    *widget,
 | |
| 			   gpointer      group)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GSList *groups;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   groups = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_size_groups);
 | |
|   groups = g_slist_prepend (groups, group);
 | |
|   g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_size_groups, groups);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   widget->priv->have_size_groups = TRUE;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| void
 | |
| _gtk_widget_remove_sizegroup (GtkWidget    *widget,
 | |
| 			      gpointer      group)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GSList *groups;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   groups = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_size_groups);
 | |
|   groups = g_slist_remove (groups, group);
 | |
|   g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_size_groups, groups);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   widget->priv->have_size_groups = groups != NULL;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| GSList *
 | |
| _gtk_widget_get_sizegroups (GtkWidget    *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   if (widget->priv->have_size_groups)
 | |
|     return g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_size_groups);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return NULL;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_path_append_for_widget:
 | |
|  * @path: a widget path
 | |
|  * @widget: the widget to append to the widget path
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Appends the data from @widget to the widget hierarchy represented
 | |
|  * by @path. This function is a shortcut for adding information from
 | |
|  * @widget to the given @path. This includes setting the name or
 | |
|  * adding the style classes from @widget.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns: the position where the data was inserted
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 3.2
 | |
|  */
 | |
| gint
 | |
| gtk_widget_path_append_for_widget (GtkWidgetPath *path,
 | |
|                                    GtkWidget     *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   gint pos;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (path != NULL, 0);
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), 0);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   pos = gtk_widget_path_append_type (path, G_OBJECT_TYPE (widget));
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (widget->priv->name)
 | |
|     gtk_widget_path_iter_set_name (path, pos, widget->priv->name);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (widget->priv->context)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       GList *classes, *l;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       /* Also add any persistent classes in
 | |
|        * the style context the widget path
 | |
|        */
 | |
|       classes = gtk_style_context_list_classes (widget->priv->context);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       for (l = classes; l; l = l->next)
 | |
|         gtk_widget_path_iter_add_class (path, pos, l->data);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       g_list_free (classes);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return pos;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_path:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns the #GtkWidgetPath representing @widget, if the widget
 | |
|  * is not connected to a toplevel widget, a partial path will be
 | |
|  * created.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns: (transfer none): The #GtkWidgetPath representing @widget
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| GtkWidgetPath *
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_path (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   /* As strange as it may seem, this may happen on object construction.
 | |
|    * init() implementations of parent types may eventually call this function,
 | |
|    * each with its corresponding GType, which could leave a child
 | |
|    * implementation with a wrong widget type in the widget path
 | |
|    */
 | |
|   if (widget->priv->path &&
 | |
|       G_OBJECT_TYPE (widget) != gtk_widget_path_get_object_type (widget->priv->path))
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       gtk_widget_path_free (widget->priv->path);
 | |
|       widget->priv->path = NULL;
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (!widget->priv->path)
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       GtkWidget *parent;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       parent = widget->priv->parent;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (parent)
 | |
|         widget->priv->path = gtk_container_get_path_for_child (GTK_CONTAINER (parent), widget);
 | |
|       else
 | |
|         {
 | |
|           /* Widget is either toplevel or unparented, treat both
 | |
|            * as toplevels style wise, since there are situations
 | |
|            * where style properties might be retrieved on that
 | |
|            * situation.
 | |
|            */
 | |
|           widget->priv->path = gtk_widget_path_new ();
 | |
|     
 | |
|           gtk_widget_path_append_for_widget (widget->priv->path, widget);
 | |
|         }
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (widget->priv->context)
 | |
|         gtk_style_context_set_path (widget->priv->context,
 | |
|                                     widget->priv->path);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return widget->priv->path;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| static void
 | |
| style_context_changed (GtkStyleContext *context,
 | |
|                        gpointer         user_data)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidget *widget = user_data;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (gtk_widget_get_realized (widget))
 | |
|     g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[STYLE_UPDATED], 0);
 | |
|   else
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       /* Compress all style updates so it
 | |
|        * is only emitted once pre-realize.
 | |
|        */
 | |
|       widget->priv->style_update_pending = TRUE;
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (widget->priv->anchored)
 | |
|     gtk_widget_queue_resize (widget);
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_style_context:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns the style context associated to @widget.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns: (transfer none): a #GtkStyleContext. This memory is owned by @widget and
 | |
|  *          must not be freed.
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| GtkStyleContext *
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_style_context (GtkWidget *widget)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GtkWidgetPrivate *priv;
 | |
|   GtkWidgetPath *path;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   priv = widget->priv;
 | |
|   
 | |
|   /* updates style context if it exists already */
 | |
|   path = gtk_widget_get_path (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   if (G_UNLIKELY (priv->context == NULL))
 | |
|     {
 | |
|       GdkScreen *screen;
 | |
| 
 | |
|       priv->context = g_object_new (GTK_TYPE_STYLE_CONTEXT,
 | |
|                                     "direction", gtk_widget_get_direction (widget),
 | |
|                                     NULL);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       g_signal_connect (widget->priv->context, "changed",
 | |
|                         G_CALLBACK (style_context_changed), widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       screen = gtk_widget_get_screen (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       if (screen)
 | |
|         gtk_style_context_set_screen (priv->context, screen);
 | |
| 
 | |
|       gtk_style_context_set_path (priv->context, path);
 | |
|     }
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return widget->priv->context;
 | |
| }
 | |
| 
 | |
| /**
 | |
|  * gtk_widget_get_modifier_mask:
 | |
|  * @widget: a #GtkWidget
 | |
|  * @intent: the use case for the modifier mask
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns the modifier mask the @widget's windowing system backend
 | |
|  * uses for a particular purpose.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * See gdk_keymap_get_modifier_mask().
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Returns: the modifier mask used for @intent.
 | |
|  *
 | |
|  * Since: 3.4
 | |
|  **/
 | |
| GdkModifierType
 | |
| gtk_widget_get_modifier_mask (GtkWidget         *widget,
 | |
|                               GdkModifierIntent  intent)
 | |
| {
 | |
|   GdkDisplay *display;
 | |
| 
 | |
|   g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), 0);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   display = gtk_widget_get_display (widget);
 | |
| 
 | |
|   return gdk_keymap_get_modifier_mask (gdk_keymap_get_for_display (display),
 | |
|                                        intent);
 | |
| }
 |